changeset 683:c838b3975bc6

Add IDs to paragraphs.
author Bryan O'Sullivan <bos@serpentine.com>
date Thu, 19 Mar 2009 21:18:52 -0700
parents 28b5a5befb08
children 3b062018273a
files en/appA-cmdref.xml en/appB-mq-ref.xml en/appC-srcinstall.xml en/appD-license.xml en/autoid.py en/ch00-preface.xml en/ch01-tour-basic.xml en/ch02-tour-merge.xml en/ch03-concepts.xml en/ch04-daily.xml en/ch05-collab.xml en/ch06-filenames.xml en/ch07-branch.xml en/ch08-undo.xml en/ch09-hook.xml en/ch10-template.xml en/ch11-mq.xml en/ch12-mq-collab.xml en/ch13-hgext.xml
diffstat 19 files changed, 1706 insertions(+), 1659 deletions(-) [+]
line wrap: on
line diff
--- a/en/appA-cmdref.xml	Thu Mar 19 20:54:12 2009 -0700
+++ b/en/appA-cmdref.xml	Thu Mar 19 21:18:52 2009 -0700
@@ -3,113 +3,113 @@
 <appendix id="cmdref">
 <title>Command reference</title>
 
-<para>\cmdref{add}{add files at the next commit}
+<para id="x_653">\cmdref{add}{add files at the next commit}
 \optref{add}{I}{include}
 \optref{add}{X}{exclude}
 \optref{add}{n}{dry-run}</para>
 
-<para>\cmdref{diff}{print changes in history or working directory}</para>
+<para id="x_654">\cmdref{diff}{print changes in history or working directory}</para>
 
-<para>Show differences between revisions for the specified files or
+<para id="x_655">Show differences between revisions for the specified files or
 directories, using the unified diff format.  For a description of the
 unified diff format, see section <xref linkend="sec:mq:patch"/>.</para>
 
-<para>By default, this command does not print diffs for files that Mercurial
+<para id="x_656">By default, this command does not print diffs for files that Mercurial
 considers to contain binary data.  To control this behaviour, see the
 <option role="hg-opt-diff">-a</option> and <option role="hg-opt-diff">--git</option> options.</para>
 
 <sect2>
 <title>Options</title>
 
-<para>\loptref{diff}{nodates}</para>
+<para id="x_657">\loptref{diff}{nodates}</para>
 
-<para>Omit date and time information when printing diff headers.</para>
+<para id="x_658">Omit date and time information when printing diff headers.</para>
 
-<para>\optref{diff}{B}{ignore-blank-lines}</para>
+<para id="x_659">\optref{diff}{B}{ignore-blank-lines}</para>
 
-<para>Do not print changes that only insert or delete blank lines.  A line
+<para id="x_65a">Do not print changes that only insert or delete blank lines.  A line
 that contains only whitespace is not considered blank.
 </para>
 
-<para>\optref{diff}{I}{include}
+<para id="x_65b">\optref{diff}{I}{include}
 </para>
 
-<para>Include files and directories whose names match the given patterns.
+<para id="x_65c">Include files and directories whose names match the given patterns.
 </para>
 
-<para>\optref{diff}{X}{exclude}
+<para id="x_65d">\optref{diff}{X}{exclude}
 </para>
 
-<para>Exclude files and directories whose names match the given patterns.
+<para id="x_65e">Exclude files and directories whose names match the given patterns.
 </para>
 
-<para>\optref{diff}{a}{text}
+<para id="x_65f">\optref{diff}{a}{text}
 </para>
 
-<para>If this option is not specified, <command role="hg-cmd">hg diff</command> will refuse to print
+<para id="x_660">If this option is not specified, <command role="hg-cmd">hg diff</command> will refuse to print
 diffs for files that it detects as binary. Specifying <option role="hg-opt-diff">-a</option>
 forces <command role="hg-cmd">hg diff</command> to treat all files as text, and generate diffs for
 all of them.
 </para>
 
-<para>This option is useful for files that are <quote>mostly text</quote> but have a
+<para id="x_661">This option is useful for files that are <quote>mostly text</quote> but have a
 few embedded NUL characters.  If you use it on files that contain a
 lot of binary data, its output will be incomprehensible.
 </para>
 
-<para>\optref{diff}{b}{ignore-space-change}
+<para id="x_662">\optref{diff}{b}{ignore-space-change}
 </para>
 
-<para>Do not print a line if the only change to that line is in the amount
+<para id="x_663">Do not print a line if the only change to that line is in the amount
 of white space it contains.
 </para>
 
-<para>\optref{diff}{g}{git}
+<para id="x_664">\optref{diff}{g}{git}
 </para>
 
-<para>Print <command>git</command>-compatible diffs.  XXX reference a format
+<para id="x_665">Print <command>git</command>-compatible diffs.  XXX reference a format
 description.
 </para>
 
-<para>\optref{diff}{p}{show-function}
+<para id="x_666">\optref{diff}{p}{show-function}
 </para>
 
-<para>Display the name of the enclosing function in a hunk header, using a
+<para id="x_667">Display the name of the enclosing function in a hunk header, using a
 simple heuristic.  This functionality is enabled by default, so the
 <option role="hg-opt-diff">-p</option> option has no effect unless you change the value of
 the <envar role="rc-item-diff">showfunc</envar> config item, as in the following example.</para>
 
 <!-- &interaction.cmdref.diff-p; -->
 
-<para>\optref{diff}{r}{rev}
+<para id="x_668">\optref{diff}{r}{rev}
 </para>
 
-<para>Specify one or more revisions to compare.  The <command role="hg-cmd">hg diff</command> command
+<para id="x_669">Specify one or more revisions to compare.  The <command role="hg-cmd">hg diff</command> command
 accepts up to two <option role="hg-opt-diff">-r</option> options to specify the revisions to
 compare.
 </para>
 
 <orderedlist>
-<listitem><para>Display the differences between the parent revision of the
+<listitem><para id="x_66a">Display the differences between the parent revision of the
   working directory and the working directory.
 </para>
 </listitem>
-<listitem><para>Display the differences between the specified changeset and the
+<listitem><para id="x_66b">Display the differences between the specified changeset and the
   working directory.
 </para>
 </listitem>
-<listitem><para>Display the differences between the two specified changesets.
+<listitem><para id="x_66c">Display the differences between the two specified changesets.
 </para>
 </listitem></orderedlist>
 
-<para>You can specify two revisions using either two <option role="hg-opt-diff">-r</option>
+<para id="x_66d">You can specify two revisions using either two <option role="hg-opt-diff">-r</option>
 options or revision range notation.  For example, the two revision
 specifications below are equivalent.
 </para>
 <programlisting>hg diff -r 10 -r 20
 hg diff -r10:20</programlisting>
 
-<para>When you provide two revisions, Mercurial treats the order of those
+<para id="x_66e">When you provide two revisions, Mercurial treats the order of those
 revisions as significant.  Thus, <command role="hg-cmd">hg diff -r10:20</command> will
 produce a diff that will transform files from their contents as of
 revision 10 to their contents as of revision 20, while
@@ -119,23 +119,23 @@
 diffing against the working directory.
 </para>
 
-<para>\optref{diff}{w}{ignore-all-space}
+<para id="x_66f">\optref{diff}{w}{ignore-all-space}
 </para>
 
-<para>\cmdref{version}{print version and copyright information}
+<para id="x_670">\cmdref{version}{print version and copyright information}
 </para>
 
-<para>This command displays the version of Mercurial you are running, and
+<para id="x_671">This command displays the version of Mercurial you are running, and
 its copyright license.  There are four kinds of version string that
 you may see.
 </para>
 <itemizedlist>
-<listitem><para>The string <quote><literal>unknown</literal></quote>. This version of Mercurial was
+<listitem><para id="x_672">The string <quote><literal>unknown</literal></quote>. This version of Mercurial was
   not built in a Mercurial repository, and cannot determine its own
   version.
 </para>
 </listitem>
-<listitem><para>A short numeric string, such as <quote><literal>1.1</literal></quote>. This is a
+<listitem><para id="x_673">A short numeric string, such as <quote><literal>1.1</literal></quote>. This is a
   build of a revision of Mercurial that was identified by a specific
   tag in the repository where it was built.  (This doesn't necessarily
   mean that you're running an official release; someone else could
@@ -143,11 +143,11 @@
   built Mercurial.)
 </para>
 </listitem>
-<listitem><para>A hexadecimal string, such as <quote><literal>875489e31abe</literal></quote>.  This
+<listitem><para id="x_674">A hexadecimal string, such as <quote><literal>875489e31abe</literal></quote>.  This
   is a build of the given revision of Mercurial.
 </para>
 </listitem>
-<listitem><para>A hexadecimal string followed by a date, such as
+<listitem><para id="x_675">A hexadecimal string followed by a date, such as
   <quote><literal>875489e31abe+20070205</literal></quote>.  This is a build of the given
   revision of Mercurial, where the build repository contained some
   local changes that had not been committed.
@@ -161,14 +161,14 @@
 <sect3 id="cmdref:diff-vs-status">
 <title>Why do the results of <command role="hg-cmd">hg diff</command> and <command role="hg-cmd">hg status</command> differ?</title>
 
-<para>When you run the <command role="hg-cmd">hg status</command> command, you'll see a list of files
+<para id="x_676">When you run the <command role="hg-cmd">hg status</command> command, you'll see a list of files
 that Mercurial will record changes for the next time you perform a
 commit.  If you run the <command role="hg-cmd">hg diff</command> command, you may notice that it
 prints diffs for only a <emphasis>subset</emphasis> of the files that <command role="hg-cmd">hg status</command>
 listed.  There are two possible reasons for this.
 </para>
 
-<para>The first is that <command role="hg-cmd">hg status</command> prints some kinds of modifications
+<para id="x_677">The first is that <command role="hg-cmd">hg status</command> prints some kinds of modifications
 that <command role="hg-cmd">hg diff</command> doesn't normally display.  The <command role="hg-cmd">hg diff</command> command
 normally outputs unified diffs, which don't have the ability to
 represent some changes that Mercurial can track.  Most notably,
@@ -176,12 +176,12 @@
 executable, but Mercurial records this information.
 </para>
 
-<para>If you use the <option role="hg-opt-diff">--git</option> option to <command role="hg-cmd">hg diff</command>, it will
+<para id="x_678">If you use the <option role="hg-opt-diff">--git</option> option to <command role="hg-cmd">hg diff</command>, it will
 display <command>git</command>-compatible diffs that <emphasis>can</emphasis> display this
 extra information.
 </para>
 
-<para>The second possible reason that <command role="hg-cmd">hg diff</command> might be printing diffs
+<para id="x_679">The second possible reason that <command role="hg-cmd">hg diff</command> might be printing diffs
 for a subset of the files displayed by <command role="hg-cmd">hg status</command> is that if you
 invoke it without any arguments, <command role="hg-cmd">hg diff</command> prints diffs against the
 first parent of the working directory.  If you have run <command role="hg-cmd">hg merge</command>
@@ -199,14 +199,14 @@
 <sect3>
 <title>Generating safe binary diffs</title>
 
-<para>If you use the <option role="hg-opt-diff">-a</option> option to force Mercurial to print
+<para id="x_67a">If you use the <option role="hg-opt-diff">-a</option> option to force Mercurial to print
 diffs of files that are either <quote>mostly text</quote> or contain lots of
 binary data, those diffs cannot subsequently be applied by either
 Mercurial's <command role="hg-cmd">hg import</command> command or the system's <command>patch</command>
 command.
 </para>
 
-<para>If you want to generate a diff of a binary file that is safe to use as
+<para id="x_67b">If you want to generate a diff of a binary file that is safe to use as
 input for <command role="hg-cmd">hg import</command>, use the <command role="hg-cmd">hg diff</command>{--git} option when you
 generate the patch.  The system <command>patch</command> command cannot handle
 binary patches at all.
--- a/en/appB-mq-ref.xml	Thu Mar 19 20:54:12 2009 -0700
+++ b/en/appB-mq-ref.xml	Thu Mar 19 21:18:52 2009 -0700
@@ -7,14 +7,14 @@
   <sect1 id="sec:mqref:cmdref">
     <title>MQ command reference</title>
 
-    <para>For an overview of the commands provided by MQ, use the
+    <para id="x_5e8">For an overview of the commands provided by MQ, use the
       command <command role="hg-cmd">hg help mq</command>.</para>
 
     <sect2>
       <title><command role="hg-ext-mq">qapplied</command>&emdash;print
 	applied patches</title>
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qapplied</command> command
+      <para id="x_5e9">The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qapplied</command> command
 	prints the current stack of applied patches.  Patches are
 	printed in oldest-to-newest order, so the last patch in the
 	list is the <quote>top</quote> patch.</para>
@@ -24,7 +24,7 @@
       <title><command role="hg-ext-mq">qcommit</command>&emdash;commit
 	changes in the queue repository</title>
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qcommit</command> command
+      <para id="x_5ea">The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qcommit</command> command
 	commits any outstanding changes in the <filename
 	  role="special" class="directory">.hg/patches</filename>
 	repository.  This command only works if the <filename
@@ -36,7 +36,7 @@
 	after running <command
 	  role="hg-ext-mq">qinit</command>.</para>
 
-      <para>This command is shorthand for <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+      <para id="x_5eb">This command is shorthand for <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	  commit --cwd .hg/patches</command>.</para>
     </sect2>
     <sect2>
@@ -45,7 +45,7 @@
 	from the <filename role="special">series</filename>
 	file}</title>
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qdelete</command> command
+      <para id="x_5ec">The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qdelete</command> command
 	removes the entry for a patch from the <filename
 	  role="special">series</filename> file in the <filename
 	  role="special" class="directory">.hg/patches</filename>
@@ -54,9 +54,9 @@
 	the <option role="hg-ext-mq-cmd-qdel-opt">-f</option> option
 	to do that.</para>
 
-      <para>Options:</para>
+      <para id="x_5ed">Options:</para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para><option
+	<listitem><para id="x_5ee"><option
 	      role="hg-ext-mq-cmd-qdel-opt">-f</option>: Delete the
 	    patch file.</para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
@@ -66,7 +66,7 @@
       <title><command role="hg-ext-mq">qdiff</command>&emdash;print a
 	diff of the topmost applied patch</title>
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qdiff</command> command
+      <para id="x_5ef">The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qdiff</command> command
 	prints a diff of the topmost applied patch. It is equivalent
 	to <command role="hg-cmd">hg diff -r-2:-1</command>.</para>
 
@@ -75,12 +75,12 @@
       <title><command role="hg-ext-mq">qfold</command>&emdash;merge
 	(<quote>fold</quote>) several patches into one</title>
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qfold</command> command
+      <para id="x_5f0">The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qfold</command> command
 	merges multiple patches into the topmost applied patch, so
 	that the topmost applied patch makes the union of all of the
 	changes in the patches in question.</para>
 
-      <para>The patches to fold must not be applied; <command
+      <para id="x_5f1">The patches to fold must not be applied; <command
 	  role="hg-ext-mq">qfold</command> will exit with an error if
 	any is.  The order in which patches are folded is significant;
 	<command role="hg-cmd">hg qfold a b</command> means
@@ -88,7 +88,7 @@
 	  <literal>a</literal>, followed by
 	  <literal>b</literal></quote>.</para>
 
-      <para>The comments from the folded patches are appended to the
+      <para id="x_5f2">The comments from the folded patches are appended to the
 	comments of the destination patch, with each block of comments
 	separated by three asterisk
 	(<quote><literal>*</literal></quote>) characters.  Use the
@@ -96,19 +96,19 @@
 	edit the commit message for the combined patch/changeset after
 	the folding has completed.</para>
 
-      <para>Options:</para>
+      <para id="x_5f3">Options:</para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para><option
+	<listitem><para id="x_5f4"><option
 	      role="hg-ext-mq-cmd-qfold-opt">-e</option>: Edit the
 	    commit message and patch description for the newly folded
 	    patch.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><option
+	<listitem><para id="x_5f5"><option
 	      role="hg-ext-mq-cmd-qfold-opt">-l</option>: Use the
 	    contents of the given file as the new commit message and
 	    patch description for the folded patch.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><option
+	<listitem><para id="x_5f6"><option
 	      role="hg-ext-mq-cmd-qfold-opt">-m</option>: Use the
 	    given text as the new commit message and patch description
 	    for the folded patch.</para>
@@ -120,7 +120,7 @@
 	  role="hg-ext-mq">qheader</command>&emdash;display the
 	header/description of a patch</title>
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qheader</command> command
+      <para id="x_5f7">The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qheader</command> command
 	prints the header, or description, of a patch.  By default, it
 	prints the header of the topmost applied patch. Given an
 	argument, it prints the header of the named patch.</para>
@@ -130,7 +130,7 @@
       <title><command role="hg-ext-mq">qimport</command>&emdash;import
 	a third-party patch into the queue</title>
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qimport</command> command
+      <para id="x_5f8">The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qimport</command> command
 	adds an entry for an external patch to the <filename
 	  role="special">series</filename> file, and copies the patch
 	into the <filename role="special"
@@ -138,7 +138,7 @@
 	the entry immediately after the topmost applied patch, but
 	does not push the patch.</para>
 
-      <para>If the <filename role="special"
+      <para id="x_5f9">If the <filename role="special"
 	  class="directory">.hg/patches</filename> directory is a
 	repository, <command role="hg-ext-mq">qimport</command>
 	automatically does an <command role="hg-cmd">hg add</command>
@@ -149,14 +149,14 @@
       <title><command role="hg-ext-mq">qinit</command>&emdash;prepare
 	a repository to work with MQ</title>
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qinit</command> command
+      <para id="x_5fa">The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qinit</command> command
 	prepares a repository to work with MQ.  It creates a directory
 	called <filename role="special"
 	  class="directory">.hg/patches</filename>.</para>
 
-      <para>Options:</para>
+      <para id="x_5fb">Options:</para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para><option
+	<listitem><para id="x_5fc"><option
 	      role="hg-ext-mq-cmd-qinit-opt">-c</option>: Create
 	    <filename role="special"
 	      class="directory">.hg/patches</filename> as a repository
@@ -166,7 +166,7 @@
 	    file.</para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-      <para>When the <filename role="special"
+      <para id="x_5fd">When the <filename role="special"
 	  class="directory">.hg/patches</filename> directory is a
 	repository, the <command role="hg-ext-mq">qimport</command>
 	and <command role="hg-ext-mq">qnew</command> commands
@@ -178,7 +178,7 @@
       <title><command role="hg-ext-mq">qnew</command>&emdash;create a
 	new patch</title>
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qnew</command> command
+      <para id="x_5fe">The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qnew</command> command
 	creates a new patch.  It takes one mandatory argument, the
 	name to use for the patch file.  The newly created patch is
 	created empty by default.  It is added to the <filename
@@ -186,7 +186,7 @@
 	topmost applied patch, and is immediately pushed on top of
 	that patch.</para>
 
-      <para>If <command role="hg-ext-mq">qnew</command> finds modified
+      <para id="x_5ff">If <command role="hg-ext-mq">qnew</command> finds modified
 	files in the working directory, it will refuse to create a new
 	patch unless the <option
 	  role="hg-ext-mq-cmd-qnew-opt">-f</option> option is used
@@ -194,16 +194,16 @@
 	  role="hg-ext-mq">qrefresh</command> your topmost applied
 	patch before you apply a new patch on top of it.</para>
 
-      <para>Options:</para>
+      <para id="x_600">Options:</para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para><option
+	<listitem><para id="x_601"><option
 	      role="hg-ext-mq-cmd-qnew-opt">-f</option>: Create a new
 	    patch if the contents of the working directory are
 	    modified.  Any outstanding modifications are added to the
 	    newly created patch, so after this command completes, the
 	    working directory will no longer be modified.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><option
+	<listitem><para id="x_602"><option
 	      role="hg-ext-mq-cmd-qnew-opt">-m</option>: Use the given
 	    text as the commit message. This text will be stored at
 	    the beginning of the patch file, before the patch
@@ -215,7 +215,7 @@
       <title><command role="hg-ext-mq">qnext</command>&emdash;print
 	the name of the next patch</title>
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qnext</command> command
+      <para id="x_603">The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qnext</command> command
 	prints the name name of the next patch in the <filename
 	  role="special">series</filename> file after the topmost
 	applied patch.  This patch will become the topmost applied
@@ -227,15 +227,15 @@
       <title><command role="hg-ext-mq">qpop</command>&emdash;pop
 	patches off the stack</title>
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qpop</command> command
+      <para id="x_604">The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qpop</command> command
 	removes applied patches from the top of the stack of applied
 	patches.  By default, it removes only one patch.</para>
 
-      <para>This command removes the changesets that represent the
+      <para id="x_605">This command removes the changesets that represent the
 	popped patches from the repository, and updates the working
 	directory to undo the effects of the patches.</para>
 
-      <para>This command takes an optional argument, which it uses as
+      <para id="x_606">This command takes an optional argument, which it uses as
 	the name or index of the patch to pop to.  If given a name, it
 	will pop patches until the named patch is the topmost applied
 	patch.  If given a number, <command
@@ -245,7 +245,7 @@
 	It pops patches until the patch identified by the given index
 	is the topmost applied patch.</para>
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qpop</command> command does
+      <para id="x_607">The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qpop</command> command does
 	not read or write patches or the <filename
 	  role="special">series</filename> file.  It is thus safe to
 	<command role="hg-ext-mq">qpop</command> a patch that you have
@@ -254,31 +254,31 @@
 	In the latter two cases, use the name of the patch as it was
 	when you applied it.</para>
 
-      <para>By default, the <command role="hg-ext-mq">qpop</command>
+      <para id="x_608">By default, the <command role="hg-ext-mq">qpop</command>
 	command will not pop any patches if the working directory has
 	been modified.  You can override this behaviour using the
 	<option role="hg-ext-mq-cmd-qpop-opt">-f</option> option,
 	which reverts all modifications in the working
 	directory.</para>
 
-      <para>Options:</para>
+      <para id="x_609">Options:</para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para><option
+	<listitem><para id="x_60a"><option
 	      role="hg-ext-mq-cmd-qpop-opt">-a</option>: Pop all
 	    applied patches.  This returns the repository to its state
 	    before you applied any patches.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><option
+	<listitem><para id="x_60b"><option
 	      role="hg-ext-mq-cmd-qpop-opt">-f</option>: Forcibly
 	    revert any modifications to the working directory when
 	    popping.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><option
+	<listitem><para id="x_60c"><option
 	      role="hg-ext-mq-cmd-qpop-opt">-n</option>: Pop a patch
 	    from the named queue.</para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qpop</command> command
+      <para id="x_60d">The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qpop</command> command
 	removes one line from the end of the <filename
 	  role="special">status</filename> file for each patch that it
 	pops.</para>
@@ -288,7 +288,7 @@
       <title><command role="hg-ext-mq">qprev</command>&emdash;print
 	the name of the previous patch</title>
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qprev</command> command
+      <para id="x_60e">The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qprev</command> command
 	prints the name of the patch in the <filename
 	  role="special">series</filename> file that comes before the
 	topmost applied patch. This will become the topmost applied
@@ -300,18 +300,18 @@
       <title><command role="hg-ext-mq">qpush</command>&emdash;push
 	patches onto the stack</title>
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qpush</command> command adds
+      <para id="x_60f">The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qpush</command> command adds
 	patches onto the applied stack.  By default, it adds only one
 	patch.</para>
 
-      <para>This command creates a new changeset to represent each
+      <para id="x_610">This command creates a new changeset to represent each
 	applied patch, and updates the working directory to apply the
 	effects of the patches.</para>
 
-      <para>The default data used when creating a changeset are as
+      <para id="x_611">The default data used when creating a changeset are as
 	follows:</para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para>The commit date and time zone are the current
+	<listitem><para id="x_612">The commit date and time zone are the current
 	    date and time zone.  Because these data are used to
 	    compute the identity of a changeset, this means that if
 	    you <command role="hg-ext-mq">qpop</command> a patch and
@@ -319,32 +319,32 @@
 	    changeset that you push will have a different identity
 	    than the changeset you popped.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>The author is the same as the default used by
+	<listitem><para id="x_613">The author is the same as the default used by
 	    the <command role="hg-cmd">hg commit</command>
 	    command.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>The commit message is any text from the patch
+	<listitem><para id="x_614">The commit message is any text from the patch
 	    file that comes before the first diff header.  If there is
 	    no such text, a default commit message is used that
 	    identifies the name of the patch.</para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
-      <para>If a patch contains a Mercurial patch header (XXX add
+      <para id="x_615">If a patch contains a Mercurial patch header (XXX add
 	link), the information in the patch header overrides these
 	defaults.</para>
 
-      <para>Options:</para>
+      <para id="x_616">Options:</para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para><option
+	<listitem><para id="x_617"><option
 	      role="hg-ext-mq-cmd-qpush-opt">-a</option>: Push all
 	    unapplied patches from the <filename
 	      role="special">series</filename> file until there are
 	    none left to push.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><option
+	<listitem><para id="x_618"><option
 	      role="hg-ext-mq-cmd-qpush-opt">-l</option>: Add the name
 	    of the patch to the end of the commit message.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><option
+	<listitem><para id="x_619"><option
 	      role="hg-ext-mq-cmd-qpush-opt">-m</option>: If a patch
 	    fails to apply cleanly, use the entry for the patch in
 	    another saved queue to compute the parameters for a
@@ -352,12 +352,12 @@
 	    normal Mercurial merge machinery.  Use the resolution of
 	    the merge as the new patch content.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><option
+	<listitem><para id="x_61a"><option
 	      role="hg-ext-mq-cmd-qpush-opt">-n</option>: Use the
 	    named queue if merging while pushing.</para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qpush</command> command
+      <para id="x_61b">The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qpush</command> command
 	reads, but does not modify, the <filename
 	  role="special">series</filename> file.  It appends one line
 	to the <command role="hg-cmd">hg status</command> file for
@@ -369,24 +369,24 @@
 	  role="hg-ext-mq">qrefresh</command>&emdash;update the
 	topmost applied patch</title>
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qrefresh</command> command
+      <para id="x_61c">The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qrefresh</command> command
 	updates the topmost applied patch.  It modifies the patch,
 	removes the old changeset that represented the patch, and
 	creates a new changeset to represent the modified
 	patch.</para>
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qrefresh</command> command
+      <para id="x_61d">The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qrefresh</command> command
 	looks for the following modifications:</para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para>Changes to the commit message, i.e. the text
+	<listitem><para id="x_61e">Changes to the commit message, i.e. the text
 	    before the first diff header in the patch file, are
 	    reflected in the new changeset that represents the
 	    patch.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>Modifications to tracked files in the working
+	<listitem><para id="x_61f">Modifications to tracked files in the working
 	    directory are added to the patch.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>Changes to the files tracked using <command
+	<listitem><para id="x_620">Changes to the files tracked using <command
 	      role="hg-cmd">hg add</command>, <command
 	      role="hg-cmd">hg copy</command>, <command
 	      role="hg-cmd">hg remove</command>, or <command
@@ -395,25 +395,25 @@
 	    removed files and rename sources are removed.</para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-      <para>Even if <command role="hg-ext-mq">qrefresh</command>
+      <para id="x_621">Even if <command role="hg-ext-mq">qrefresh</command>
 	detects no changes, it still recreates the changeset that
 	represents the patch.  This causes the identity of the
 	changeset to differ from the previous changeset that
 	identified the patch.</para>
 
-      <para>Options:</para>
+      <para id="x_622">Options:</para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para><option
+	<listitem><para id="x_623"><option
 	      role="hg-ext-mq-cmd-qrefresh-opt">-e</option>: Modify
 	    the commit and patch description, using the preferred text
 	    editor.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><option
+	<listitem><para id="x_624"><option
 	      role="hg-ext-mq-cmd-qrefresh-opt">-m</option>: Modify
 	    the commit message and patch description, using the given
 	    text.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><option
+	<listitem><para id="x_625"><option
 	      role="hg-ext-mq-cmd-qrefresh-opt">-l</option>: Modify
 	    the commit message and patch description, using text from
 	    the given file.</para>
@@ -424,11 +424,11 @@
       <title><command role="hg-ext-mq">qrename</command>&emdash;rename
 	a patch</title>
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qrename</command> command
+      <para id="x_626">The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qrename</command> command
 	renames a patch, and changes the entry for the patch in the
 	<filename role="special">series</filename> file.</para>
 
-      <para>With a single argument, <command
+      <para id="x_627">With a single argument, <command
 	  role="hg-ext-mq">qrename</command> renames the topmost
 	applied patch.  With two arguments, it renames its first
 	argument to its second.</para>
@@ -439,21 +439,21 @@
 	  role="hg-ext-mq">qrestore</command>&emdash;restore saved
 	queue state</title>
 
-      <para>XXX No idea what this does.</para>
+      <para id="x_628">XXX No idea what this does.</para>
 
     </sect2>
     <sect2>
       <title><command role="hg-ext-mq">qsave</command>&emdash;save
 	current queue state</title>
 
-      <para>XXX Likewise.</para>
+      <para id="x_629">XXX Likewise.</para>
 
     </sect2>
     <sect2>
       <title><command role="hg-ext-mq">qseries</command>&emdash;print
 	the entire patch series</title>
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qseries</command> command
+      <para id="x_62a">The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qseries</command> command
 	prints the entire patch series from the <filename
 	  role="special">series</filename> file.  It prints only patch
 	names, not empty lines or comments.  It prints in order from
@@ -464,7 +464,7 @@
       <title><command role="hg-ext-mq">qtop</command>&emdash;print the
 	name of the current patch</title>
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qtop</command> prints the
+      <para id="x_62b">The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qtop</command> prints the
 	name of the topmost currently applied patch.</para>
 
     </sect2>
@@ -473,7 +473,7 @@
 	  role="hg-ext-mq">qunapplied</command>&emdash;print patches
 	not yet applied</title>
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qunapplied</command> command
+      <para id="x_62c">The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qunapplied</command> command
 	prints the names of patches from the <filename
 	  role="special">series</filename> file that are not yet
 	applied.  It prints them in order from the next patch that
@@ -484,28 +484,28 @@
       <title><command role="hg-cmd">hg strip</command>&emdash;remove a
 	revision and descendants</title>
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-cmd">hg strip</command> command
+      <para id="x_62d">The <command role="hg-cmd">hg strip</command> command
 	removes a revision, and all of its descendants, from the
 	repository.  It undoes the effects of the removed revisions
 	from the repository, and updates the working directory to the
 	first parent of the removed revision.</para>
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-cmd">hg strip</command> command
+      <para id="x_62e">The <command role="hg-cmd">hg strip</command> command
 	saves a backup of the removed changesets in a bundle, so that
 	they can be reapplied if removed in error.</para>
 
-      <para>Options:</para>
+      <para id="x_62f">Options:</para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para><option role="hg-opt-strip">-b</option>: Save
+	<listitem><para id="x_630"><option role="hg-opt-strip">-b</option>: Save
 	    unrelated changesets that are intermixed with the stripped
 	    changesets in the backup bundle.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><option role="hg-opt-strip">-f</option>: If a
+	<listitem><para id="x_631"><option role="hg-opt-strip">-f</option>: If a
 	    branch has multiple heads, remove all heads. XXX This
 	    should be renamed, and use <literal>-f</literal> to strip
 	    revs when there are pending changes.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><option role="hg-opt-strip">-n</option>: Do
+	<listitem><para id="x_632"><option role="hg-opt-strip">-n</option>: Do
 	    not save a backup bundle.</para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
 
@@ -518,18 +518,18 @@
       <title>The <filename role="special">series</filename>
 	file</title>
 
-      <para>The <filename role="special">series</filename> file
+      <para id="x_633">The <filename role="special">series</filename> file
 	contains a list of the names of all patches that MQ can apply.
 	It is represented as a list of names, with one name saved per
 	line.  Leading and trailing white space in each line are
 	ignored.</para>
 
-      <para>Lines may contain comments.  A comment begins with the
+      <para id="x_634">Lines may contain comments.  A comment begins with the
 	<quote><literal>#</literal></quote> character, and extends to
 	the end of the line.  Empty lines, and lines that contain only
 	comments, are ignored.</para>
 
-      <para>You will often need to edit the <filename
+      <para id="x_635">You will often need to edit the <filename
 	  role="special">series</filename> file by hand, hence the
 	support for comments and empty lines noted above.  For
 	example, you can comment out a patch temporarily, and <command
@@ -538,7 +538,7 @@
 	patches are applied by reordering their entries in the
 	<filename role="special">series</filename> file.</para>
 
-      <para>Placing the <filename role="special">series</filename>
+      <para id="x_636">Placing the <filename role="special">series</filename>
 	file under revision control is also supported; it is a good
 	idea to place all of the patches that it refers to under
 	revision control, as well.  If you create a patch directory
@@ -551,7 +551,7 @@
       <title>The <filename role="special">status</filename>
 	file</title>
 
-      <para>The <filename role="special">status</filename> file
+      <para id="x_637">The <filename role="special">status</filename> file
 	contains the names and changeset hashes of all patches that MQ
 	currently has applied.  Unlike the <filename
 	  role="special">series</filename> file, this file is not
--- a/en/appC-srcinstall.xml	Thu Mar 19 20:54:12 2009 -0700
+++ b/en/appC-srcinstall.xml	Thu Mar 19 21:18:52 2009 -0700
@@ -7,29 +7,29 @@
   <sect1 id="sec:srcinstall:unixlike">
     <title>On a Unix-like system</title>
 
-    <para>If you are using a Unix-like system that has a sufficiently
+    <para id="x_5e0">If you are using a Unix-like system that has a sufficiently
       recent version of Python (2.3 or newer) available, it is easy to
       install Mercurial from source.</para>
     <orderedlist>
-      <listitem><para>Download a recent source tarball from <ulink
+      <listitem><para id="x_5e1">Download a recent source tarball from <ulink
 	    url="http://www.selenic.com/mercurial/download">http://www.selenic.com/mercurial/download</ulink>.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>Unpack the tarball:</para>
+      <listitem><para id="x_5e2">Unpack the tarball:</para>
 	<programlisting>gzip -dc mercurial-MYVERSION.tar.gz | tar xf -</programlisting>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>Go into the source directory and run the
+      <listitem><para id="x_5e3">Go into the source directory and run the
 	  installer script.  This will build Mercurial and install it
 	  in your home directory.</para>
 	<programlisting>cd mercurial-MYVERSION
 python setup.py install --force --home=$HOME</programlisting>
       </listitem>
     </orderedlist>
-    <para>Once the install finishes, Mercurial will be in the
+    <para id="x_5e4">Once the install finishes, Mercurial will be in the
       <literal>bin</literal> subdirectory of your home directory.
       Don't forget to make sure that this directory is present in your
       shell's search path.</para>
 
-    <para>You will probably need to set the <envar>PYTHONPATH</envar>
+    <para id="x_5e5">You will probably need to set the <envar>PYTHONPATH</envar>
       environment variable so that the Mercurial executable can find
       the rest of the Mercurial packages.  For example, on my laptop,
       I have set it to <literal>/home/bos/lib/python</literal>.  The
@@ -43,14 +43,14 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>On Windows</title>
 
-    <para>Building and installing Mercurial on Windows requires a
+    <para id="x_5e6">Building and installing Mercurial on Windows requires a
       variety of tools, a fair amount of technical knowledge, and
       considerable patience.  I very much <emphasis>do not
 	recommend</emphasis> this route if you are a <quote>casual
 	user</quote>.  Unless you intend to hack on Mercurial, I
       strongly suggest that you use a binary package instead.</para>
 
-    <para>If you are intent on building Mercurial from source on
+    <para id="x_5e7">If you are intent on building Mercurial from source on
       Windows, follow the <quote>hard way</quote> directions on the
       Mercurial wiki at <ulink
 	url="http://www.selenic.com/mercurial/wiki/index.cgi/WindowsInstall">http://www.selenic.com/mercurial/wiki/index.cgi/WindowsInstall</ulink>, 
--- a/en/appD-license.xml	Thu Mar 19 20:54:12 2009 -0700
+++ b/en/appD-license.xml	Thu Mar 19 21:18:52 2009 -0700
@@ -4,24 +4,24 @@
   <?dbhtml filename="open-publication-license.html"?>
   <title>Open Publication License</title>
 
-  <para>Version 1.0, 8 June 1999</para>
+  <para id="x_638">Version 1.0, 8 June 1999</para>
 
   <sect1>
     <title>Requirements on both unmodified and modified
       versions</title>
 
-    <para>The Open Publication works may be reproduced and distributed
+    <para id="x_639">The Open Publication works may be reproduced and distributed
       in whole or in part, in any medium physical or electronic,
       provided that the terms of this license are adhered to, and that
       this license or an incorporation of it by reference (with any
       options elected by the author(s) and/or publisher) is displayed
       in the reproduction.</para>
 
-    <para>Proper form for an incorporation by reference is as
+    <para id="x_63a">Proper form for an incorporation by reference is as
       follows:</para>
 
     <blockquote>
-      <para>  Copyright (c) <emphasis>year</emphasis> by
+      <para id="x_63b">  Copyright (c) <emphasis>year</emphasis> by
 	<emphasis>author's name or designee</emphasis>. This material
 	may be distributed only subject to the terms and conditions
 	set forth in the Open Publication License,
@@ -30,14 +30,14 @@
 	  url="http://www.opencontent.org/openpub/">http://www.opencontent.org/openpub/</ulink>).</para>
     </blockquote>
 
-    <para>The reference must be immediately followed with any options
+    <para id="x_63c">The reference must be immediately followed with any options
       elected by the author(s) and/or publisher of the document (see
       section <xref linkend="sec:opl:options"/>).</para>
 
-    <para>Commercial redistribution of Open Publication-licensed
+    <para id="x_63d">Commercial redistribution of Open Publication-licensed
       material is permitted.</para>
 
-    <para>Any publication in standard (paper) book form shall require
+    <para id="x_63e">Any publication in standard (paper) book form shall require
       the citation of the original publisher and author. The publisher
       and author's names shall appear on all outer surfaces of the
       book. On all outer surfaces of the book the original publisher's
@@ -48,30 +48,30 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Copyright</title>
 
-    <para>The copyright to each Open Publication is owned by its
+    <para id="x_63f">The copyright to each Open Publication is owned by its
       author(s) or designee.</para>
 
   </sect1>
   <sect1>
     <title>Scope of license</title>
 
-    <para>The following license terms apply to all Open Publication
+    <para id="x_640">The following license terms apply to all Open Publication
       works, unless otherwise explicitly stated in the
       document.</para>
 
-    <para>Mere aggregation of Open Publication works or a portion of
+    <para id="x_641">Mere aggregation of Open Publication works or a portion of
       an Open Publication work with other works or programs on the
       same media shall not cause this license to apply to those other
       works. The aggregate work shall contain a notice specifying the
       inclusion of the Open Publication material and appropriate
       copyright notice.</para>
 
-    <para><emphasis role="bold">Severability</emphasis>. If any part
+    <para id="x_642"><emphasis role="bold">Severability</emphasis>. If any part
       of this license is found to be unenforceable in any
       jurisdiction, the remaining portions of the license remain in
       force.</para>
 
-    <para><emphasis role="bold">No warranty</emphasis>. Open
+    <para id="x_643"><emphasis role="bold">No warranty</emphasis>. Open
       Publication works are licensed and provided <quote>as is</quote>
       without warranty of any kind, express or implied, including, but
       not limited to, the implied warranties of merchantability and
@@ -82,25 +82,25 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Requirements on modified works</title>
 
-    <para>All modified versions of documents covered by this license,
+    <para id="x_644">All modified versions of documents covered by this license,
       including translations, anthologies, compilations and partial
       documents, must meet the following requirements:</para>
 
     <orderedlist>
-      <listitem><para>The modified version must be labeled as
+      <listitem><para id="x_645">The modified version must be labeled as
 	  such.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>The person making the modifications must be
+      <listitem><para id="x_646">The person making the modifications must be
 	  identified and the modifications dated.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>Acknowledgement of the original author and
+      <listitem><para id="x_647">Acknowledgement of the original author and
 	  publisher if applicable must be retained according to normal
 	  academic citation practices.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>The location of the original unmodified document
+      <listitem><para id="x_648">The location of the original unmodified document
 	  must be identified.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>The original author's (or authors') name(s) may
+      <listitem><para id="x_649">The original author's (or authors') name(s) may
 	  not be used to assert or imply endorsement of the resulting
 	  document without the original author's (or authors')
 	  permission.</para>
@@ -110,23 +110,23 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Good-practice recommendations</title>
 
-    <para>In addition to the requirements of this license, it is
+    <para id="x_64a">In addition to the requirements of this license, it is
       requested from and strongly recommended of redistributors
       that:</para>
 
     <orderedlist>
-      <listitem><para>If you are distributing Open Publication works
+      <listitem><para id="x_64b">If you are distributing Open Publication works
 	  on hardcopy or CD-ROM, you provide email notification to the
 	  authors of your intent to redistribute at least thirty days
 	  before your manuscript or media freeze, to give the authors
 	  time to provide updated documents. This notification should
 	  describe modifications, if any, made to the document.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>All substantive modifications (including
+      <listitem><para id="x_64c">All substantive modifications (including
 	  deletions) be either clearly marked up in the document or
 	  else described in an attachment to the document.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>Finally, while it is not mandatory under this
+      <listitem><para id="x_64d">Finally, while it is not mandatory under this
 	  license, it is considered good form to offer a free copy of
 	  any hardcopy and CD-ROM expression of an Open
 	  Publication-licensed work to its author(s).</para>
@@ -136,7 +136,7 @@
   <sect1 id="sec:opl:options">
     <title>License options</title>
 
-    <para>The author(s) and/or publisher of an Open
+    <para id="x_64e">The author(s) and/or publisher of an Open
       Publication-licensed document may elect certain options by
       appending language to the reference to or copy of the license.
       These options are considered part of the license instance and
@@ -144,25 +144,25 @@
       reference) in derived works.</para>
 
     <orderedlist>
-      <listitem><para>To prohibit distribution of substantively
+      <listitem><para id="x_64f">To prohibit distribution of substantively
 	  modified versions without the explicit permission of the
 	  author(s). <quote>Substantive modification</quote> is
 	  defined as a change to the semantic content of the document,
 	  and excludes mere changes in format or typographical
 	  corrections.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>  To accomplish this, add the phrase
+      <listitem><para id="x_650">  To accomplish this, add the phrase
 	  <quote>Distribution of substantively modified versions of
 	    this document is prohibited without the explicit
 	    permission of the copyright holder.</quote> to the license
 	  reference or copy.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>To prohibit any publication of this work or
+      <listitem><para id="x_651">To prohibit any publication of this work or
 	  derivative works in whole or in part in standard (paper)
 	  book form for commercial purposes is prohibited unless prior
 	  permission is obtained from the copyright holder.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>To accomplish this, add the phrase
+      <listitem><para id="x_652">To accomplish this, add the phrase
 	  <quote>Distribution of the work or derivative of the work in
 	    any standard (paper) book form is prohibited unless prior
 	    permission is obtained from the copyright holder.</quote>
--- /dev/null	Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000
+++ b/en/autoid.py	Thu Mar 19 21:18:52 2009 -0700
@@ -0,0 +1,47 @@
+#!/usr/bin/env python
+#
+# Add unique ID attributes to para tags.  This script should only be
+# run by one person, since otherwise it introduces the possibility of
+# chaotic conflicts among tags.
+
+import glob, os, re, sys
+
+tagged = re.compile('<para[^>]* id="x_([0-9a-f]+)"[^>]*>', re.M)
+untagged = re.compile('<para>')
+
+names = glob.glob('ch*.xml') + glob.glob('app*.xml')
+
+# First pass: find the highest-numbered paragraph ID.
+
+biggest_id = 0
+seen = set()
+errs = 0
+
+for name in names:
+    for m in tagged.finditer(open(name).read()):
+        i = int(m.group(1),16)
+        if i in seen:
+            print >> sys.stderr, '%s: duplication of ID %s' % (name, i)
+            errs += 1
+        seen.add(i)
+        if i > biggest_id:
+            biggest_id = i
+
+def retag(s):
+    global biggest_id
+    biggest_id += 1
+    return '<para id="x_%x">' % biggest_id
+
+# Second pass: add IDs to paragraphs that currently lack them.
+
+for name in names:
+    f = open(name).read()
+    f1 = untagged.sub(retag, f)
+    if f1 != f:
+        tmpname = name + '.tmp'
+        fp = open(tmpname, 'w')
+        fp.write(f1)
+        fp.close()
+        os.rename(tmpname, name)
+
+sys.exit(errs)
--- a/en/ch00-preface.xml	Thu Mar 19 20:54:12 2009 -0700
+++ b/en/ch00-preface.xml	Thu Mar 19 21:18:52 2009 -0700
@@ -6,13 +6,13 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Why revision control? Why Mercurial?</title>
 
-    <para>Revision control is the process of managing multiple
+    <para id="x_6d">Revision control is the process of managing multiple
       versions of a piece of information.  In its simplest form, this
       is something that many people do by hand: every time you modify
       a file, save it under a new name that contains a number, each
       one higher than the number of the preceding version.</para>
 
-    <para>Manually managing multiple versions of even a single file is
+    <para id="x_6e">Manually managing multiple versions of even a single file is
       an error-prone task, though, so software tools to help automate
       this process have long been available.  The earliest automated
       revision control tools were intended to help a single user to
@@ -23,11 +23,11 @@
       problem coping with thousands of people working together on
       projects that consist of hundreds of thousands of files.</para>
 
-    <para>The arrival of distributed revision control is relatively
+    <para id="x_6f">The arrival of distributed revision control is relatively
       recent, and so far this new field has grown due to people's
       willingness to explore ill-charted territory.</para>
 
-    <para>I am writing a book about distributed revision control
+    <para id="x_70">I am writing a book about distributed revision control
       because I believe that it is an important subject that deserves
       a field guide. I chose to write about Mercurial because it is
       the easiest tool to learn the terrain with, and yet it scales to
@@ -37,41 +37,41 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Why use revision control?</title>
 
-      <para>There are a number of reasons why you or your team might
+      <para id="x_71">There are a number of reasons why you or your team might
 	want to use an automated revision control tool for a
 	project.</para>
 
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para>It will track the history and evolution of
+	<listitem><para id="x_72">It will track the history and evolution of
 	    your project, so you don't have to.  For every change,
 	    you'll have a log of <emphasis>who</emphasis> made it;
 	    <emphasis>why</emphasis> they made it;
 	    <emphasis>when</emphasis> they made it; and
 	    <emphasis>what</emphasis> the change
 	    was.</para></listitem>
-	<listitem><para>When you're working with other people,
+	<listitem><para id="x_73">When you're working with other people,
 	    revision control software makes it easier for you to
 	    collaborate.  For example, when people more or less
 	    simultaneously make potentially incompatible changes, the
 	    software will help you to identify and resolve those
 	    conflicts.</para></listitem>
-	<listitem><para>It can help you to recover from mistakes.  If
+	<listitem><para id="x_74">It can help you to recover from mistakes.  If
 	    you make a change that later turns out to be in error, you
 	    can revert to an earlier version of one or more files.  In
 	    fact, a <emphasis>really</emphasis> good revision control
 	    tool will even help you to efficiently figure out exactly
 	    when a problem was introduced (see section <xref
 	      linkend="sec:undo:bisect"/> for details).</para></listitem>
-	<listitem><para>It will help you to work simultaneously on,
+	<listitem><para id="x_75">It will help you to work simultaneously on,
 	    and manage the drift between, multiple versions of your
 	    project.</para></listitem>
       </itemizedlist>
 
-      <para>Most of these reasons are equally valid---at least in
+      <para id="x_76">Most of these reasons are equally valid---at least in
 	theory---whether you're working on a project by yourself, or
 	with a hundred other people.</para>
 
-      <para>A key question about the practicality of revision control
+      <para id="x_77">A key question about the practicality of revision control
 	at these two different scales (<quote>lone hacker</quote> and
 	<quote>huge team</quote>) is how its
 	<emphasis>benefits</emphasis> compare to its
@@ -79,19 +79,19 @@
 	difficult to understand or use is going to impose a high
 	cost.</para>
 
-      <para>A five-hundred-person project is likely to collapse under
+      <para id="x_78">A five-hundred-person project is likely to collapse under
 	its own weight almost immediately without a revision control
 	tool and process. In this case, the cost of using revision
 	control might hardly seem worth considering, since
 	<emphasis>without</emphasis> it, failure is almost
 	guaranteed.</para>
 
-      <para>On the other hand, a one-person <quote>quick hack</quote>
+      <para id="x_79">On the other hand, a one-person <quote>quick hack</quote>
 	might seem like a poor place to use a revision control tool,
 	because surely the cost of using one must be close to the
 	overall cost of the project.  Right?</para>
 
-      <para>Mercurial uniquely supports <emphasis>both</emphasis> of
+      <para id="x_7a">Mercurial uniquely supports <emphasis>both</emphasis> of
 	these scales of development.  You can learn the basics in just
 	a few minutes, and due to its low overhead, you can apply
 	revision control to the smallest of projects with ease.  Its
@@ -101,7 +101,7 @@
 	time, Mercurial's high performance and peer-to-peer nature let
 	you scale painlessly to handle large projects.</para>
 
-      <para>No revision control tool can rescue a poorly run project,
+      <para id="x_7b">No revision control tool can rescue a poorly run project,
 	but a good choice of tools can make a huge difference to the
 	fluidity with which you can work on a project.</para>
 
@@ -110,19 +110,19 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>The many names of revision control</title>
 
-      <para>Revision control is a diverse field, so much so that it is
+      <para id="x_7c">Revision control is a diverse field, so much so that it is
 	referred to by many names and acronyms.  Here are a few of the
 	more common variations you'll encounter:</para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para>Revision control (RCS)</para></listitem>
-	<listitem><para>Software configuration management (SCM), or
+	<listitem><para id="x_7d">Revision control (RCS)</para></listitem>
+	<listitem><para id="x_7e">Software configuration management (SCM), or
 	    configuration management</para></listitem>
-	<listitem><para>Source code management</para></listitem>
-	<listitem><para>Source code control, or source
+	<listitem><para id="x_7f">Source code management</para></listitem>
+	<listitem><para id="x_80">Source code control, or source
 	    control</para></listitem>
-	<listitem><para>Version control
+	<listitem><para id="x_81">Version control
 	    (VCS)</para></listitem></itemizedlist>
-      <para>Some people claim that these terms actually have different
+      <para id="x_82">Some people claim that these terms actually have different
 	meanings, but in practice they overlap so much that there's no
 	agreed or even useful way to tease them apart.</para>
 
@@ -132,7 +132,7 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>This book is a work in progress</title>
 
-    <para>I am releasing this book while I am still writing it, in the
+    <para id="x_83">I am releasing this book while I am still writing it, in the
       hope that it will prove useful to others.  I am writing under an
       open license in the hope that you, my readers, will contribute
       feedback and perhaps content of your own.</para>
@@ -141,21 +141,21 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>About the examples in this book</title>
 
-    <para>This book takes an unusual approach to code samples.  Every
+    <para id="x_84">This book takes an unusual approach to code samples.  Every
       example is <quote>live</quote>---each one is actually the result
       of a shell script that executes the Mercurial commands you see.
       Every time an image of the book is built from its sources, all
       the example scripts are automatically run, and their current
       results compared against their expected results.</para>
 
-    <para>The advantage of this approach is that the examples are
+    <para id="x_85">The advantage of this approach is that the examples are
       always accurate; they describe <emphasis>exactly</emphasis> the
       behaviour of the version of Mercurial that's mentioned at the
       front of the book.  If I update the version of Mercurial that
       I'm documenting, and the output of some command changes, the
       build fails.</para>
 
-    <para>There is a small disadvantage to this approach, which is
+    <para id="x_86">There is a small disadvantage to this approach, which is
       that the dates and times you'll see in examples tend to be
       <quote>squashed</quote> together in a way that they wouldn't be
       if the same commands were being typed by a human.  Where a human
@@ -163,13 +163,13 @@
       resulting timestamps correspondingly spread out, my automated
       example scripts run many commands in one second.</para>
 
-    <para>As an instance of this, several consecutive commits in an
+    <para id="x_87">As an instance of this, several consecutive commits in an
       example can show up as having occurred during the same second.
       You can see this occur in the <literal
 	role="hg-ext">bisect</literal> example in section <xref
 	id="sec:undo:bisect"/>, for instance.</para>
 
-    <para>So when you're reading examples, don't place too much weight
+    <para id="x_88">So when you're reading examples, don't place too much weight
       on the dates or times you see in the output of commands.  But
       <emphasis>do</emphasis> be confident that the behaviour you're
       seeing is consistent and reproducible.</para>
@@ -179,18 +179,18 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Trends in the field</title>
 
-    <para>There has been an unmistakable trend in the development and
+    <para id="x_89">There has been an unmistakable trend in the development and
       use of revision control tools over the past four decades, as
       people have become familiar with the capabilities of their tools
       and constrained by their limitations.</para>
 
-    <para>The first generation began by managing single files on
+    <para id="x_8a">The first generation began by managing single files on
       individual computers.  Although these tools represented a huge
       advance over ad-hoc manual revision control, their locking model
       and reliance on a single computer limited them to small,
       tightly-knit teams.</para>
 
-    <para>The second generation loosened these constraints by moving
+    <para id="x_8b">The second generation loosened these constraints by moving
       to network-centered architectures, and managing entire projects
       at a time.  As projects grew larger, they ran into new problems.
       With clients needing to talk to servers very frequently, server
@@ -202,7 +202,7 @@
       tools to interact with a project in a natural way, as they could
       not record their changes.</para>
 
-    <para>The current generation of revision control tools is
+    <para id="x_8c">The current generation of revision control tools is
       peer-to-peer in nature.  All of these systems have dropped the
       dependency on a single central server, and allow people to
       distribute their revision control data to where it's actually
@@ -217,14 +217,14 @@
     <title>A few of the advantages of distributed revision
       control</title>
 
-    <para>Even though distributed revision control tools have for
+    <para id="x_8d">Even though distributed revision control tools have for
       several years been as robust and usable as their
       previous-generation counterparts, people using older tools have
       not yet necessarily woken up to their advantages.  There are a
       number of ways in which distributed tools shine relative to
       centralised ones.</para>
 
-    <para>For an individual developer, distributed tools are almost
+    <para id="x_8e">For an individual developer, distributed tools are almost
       always much faster than centralised tools.  This is for a simple
       reason: a centralised tool needs to talk over the network for
       many common operations, because most metadata is stored in a
@@ -235,7 +235,7 @@
       going to spend a lot of time interacting with your revision
       control software.</para>
 
-    <para>Distributed tools are indifferent to the vagaries of your
+    <para id="x_8f">Distributed tools are indifferent to the vagaries of your
       server infrastructure, again because they replicate metadata to
       so many locations.  If you use a centralised system and your
       server catches fire, you'd better hope that your backup media
@@ -243,7 +243,7 @@
       worked.  With a distributed tool, you have many backups
       available on every contributor's computer.</para>
 
-    <para>The reliability of your network will affect distributed
+    <para id="x_90">The reliability of your network will affect distributed
       tools far less than it will centralised tools.  You can't even
       use a centralised tool without a network connection, except for
       a few highly constrained commands.  With a distributed tool, if
@@ -256,7 +256,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Advantages for open source projects</title>
 
-      <para>If you take a shine to an open source project and decide
+      <para id="x_91">If you take a shine to an open source project and decide
 	that you would like to start hacking on it, and that project
 	uses a distributed revision control tool, you are at once a
 	peer with the people who consider themselves the
@@ -274,7 +274,7 @@
       <sect3>
 	<title>The forking non-problem</title>
 
-	<para>It has been suggested that distributed revision control
+	<para id="x_92">It has been suggested that distributed revision control
 	  tools pose some sort of risk to open source projects because
 	  they make it easy to <quote>fork</quote> the development of
 	  a project.  A fork happens when there are differences in
@@ -284,7 +284,7 @@
 	  project's source code, and goes off in its own
 	  direction.</para>
 
-	<para>Sometimes the camps in a fork decide to reconcile their
+	<para id="x_93">Sometimes the camps in a fork decide to reconcile their
 	  differences. With a centralised revision control system, the
 	  <emphasis>technical</emphasis> process of reconciliation is
 	  painful, and has to be performed largely by hand.  You have
@@ -293,7 +293,7 @@
 	  the tree somehow. This usually loses some or all of one
 	  side's revision history.</para>
 
-	<para>What distributed tools do with respect to forking is
+	<para id="x_94">What distributed tools do with respect to forking is
 	  they make forking the <emphasis>only</emphasis> way to
 	  develop a project.  Every single change that you make is
 	  potentially a fork point.  The great strength of this
@@ -302,23 +302,23 @@
 	  because forks are absolutely fundamental: they happen all
 	  the time.</para>
 
-	<para>If every piece of work that everybody does, all the
+	<para id="x_95">If every piece of work that everybody does, all the
 	  time, is framed in terms of forking and merging, then what
 	  the open source world refers to as a <quote>fork</quote>
 	  becomes <emphasis>purely</emphasis> a social issue.  If
 	  anything, distributed tools <emphasis>lower</emphasis> the
 	  likelihood of a fork:</para>
 	<itemizedlist>
-	  <listitem><para>They eliminate the social distinction that
+	  <listitem><para id="x_96">They eliminate the social distinction that
 	      centralised tools impose: that between insiders (people
 	      with commit access) and outsiders (people
 	      without).</para></listitem>
-	  <listitem><para>They make it easier to reconcile after a
+	  <listitem><para id="x_97">They make it easier to reconcile after a
 	      social fork, because all that's involved from the
 	      perspective of the revision control software is just
 	      another merge.</para></listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-	<para>Some people resist distributed tools because they want
+	<para id="x_98">Some people resist distributed tools because they want
 	  to retain tight control over their projects, and they
 	  believe that centralised tools give them this control.
 	  However, if you're of this belief, and you publish your CVS
@@ -335,7 +335,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Advantages for commercial projects</title>
 
-      <para>Many commercial projects are undertaken by teams that are
+      <para id="x_99">Many commercial projects are undertaken by teams that are
 	scattered across the globe.  Contributors who are far from a
 	central server will see slower command execution and perhaps
 	less reliability.  Commercial revision control systems attempt
@@ -347,7 +347,7 @@
 	there's no redundant communication between repositories over
 	expensive long-haul network links.</para>
 
-      <para>Centralised revision control systems tend to have
+      <para id="x_9a">Centralised revision control systems tend to have
 	relatively low scalability.  It's not unusual for an expensive
 	centralised system to fall over under the combined load of
 	just a few dozen concurrent users.  Once again, the typical
@@ -359,7 +359,7 @@
 	replication to balance load becomes a simple matter of
 	scripting.</para>
 
-      <para>If you have an employee in the field, troubleshooting a
+      <para id="x_9b">If you have an employee in the field, troubleshooting a
 	problem at a customer's site, they'll benefit from distributed
 	revision control. The tool will let them generate custom
 	builds, try different fixes in isolation from each other, and
@@ -372,35 +372,35 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Why choose Mercurial?</title>
 
-    <para>Mercurial has a unique set of properties that make it a
+    <para id="x_9c">Mercurial has a unique set of properties that make it a
       particularly good choice as a revision control system.</para>
     <itemizedlist>
-      <listitem><para>It is easy to learn and use.</para></listitem>
-      <listitem><para>It is lightweight.</para></listitem>
-      <listitem><para>It scales excellently.</para></listitem>
-      <listitem><para>It is easy to
+      <listitem><para id="x_9d">It is easy to learn and use.</para></listitem>
+      <listitem><para id="x_9e">It is lightweight.</para></listitem>
+      <listitem><para id="x_9f">It scales excellently.</para></listitem>
+      <listitem><para id="x_a0">It is easy to
 	  customise.</para></listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-    <para>If you are at all familiar with revision control systems,
+    <para id="x_a1">If you are at all familiar with revision control systems,
       you should be able to get up and running with Mercurial in less
       than five minutes.  Even if not, it will take no more than a few
       minutes longer.  Mercurial's command and feature sets are
       generally uniform and consistent, so you can keep track of a few
       general rules instead of a host of exceptions.</para>
 
-    <para>On a small project, you can start working with Mercurial in
+    <para id="x_a2">On a small project, you can start working with Mercurial in
       moments. Creating new changes and branches; transferring changes
       around (whether locally or over a network); and history and
       status operations are all fast.  Mercurial attempts to stay
       nimble and largely out of your way by combining low cognitive
       overhead with blazingly fast operations.</para>
 
-    <para>The usefulness of Mercurial is not limited to small
+    <para id="x_a3">The usefulness of Mercurial is not limited to small
       projects: it is used by projects with hundreds to thousands of
       contributors, each containing tens of thousands of files and
       hundreds of megabytes of source code.</para>
 
-    <para>If the core functionality of Mercurial is not enough for
+    <para id="x_a4">If the core functionality of Mercurial is not enough for
       you, it's easy to build on.  Mercurial is well suited to
       scripting tasks, and its clean internals and implementation in
       Python make it easy to add features in the form of extensions.
@@ -412,7 +412,7 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Mercurial compared with other tools</title>
 
-    <para>Before you read on, please understand that this section
+    <para id="x_a5">Before you read on, please understand that this section
       necessarily reflects my own experiences, interests, and (dare I
       say it) biases.  I have used every one of the revision control
       tools listed below, in most cases for several years at a
@@ -422,22 +422,22 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Subversion</title>
 
-      <para>Subversion is a popular revision control tool, developed
+      <para id="x_a6">Subversion is a popular revision control tool, developed
 	to replace CVS.  It has a centralised client/server
 	architecture.</para>
 
-      <para>Subversion and Mercurial have similarly named commands for
+      <para id="x_a7">Subversion and Mercurial have similarly named commands for
 	performing the same operations, so if you're familiar with
 	one, it is easy to learn to use the other.  Both tools are
 	portable to all popular operating systems.</para>
 
-      <para>Prior to version 1.5, Subversion had no useful support for
+      <para id="x_a8">Prior to version 1.5, Subversion had no useful support for
 	merges. At the time of writing, its merge tracking capability
 	is new, and known to be <ulink
 	  url="http://svnbook.red-bean.com/nightly/en/svn.branchmerge.advanced.html#svn.branchmerge.advanced.finalword">complicated 
 	  and buggy</ulink>.</para>
 
-      <para>Mercurial has a substantial performance advantage over
+      <para id="x_a9">Mercurial has a substantial performance advantage over
 	Subversion on every revision control operation I have
 	benchmarked.  I have measured its advantage as ranging from a
 	factor of two to a factor of six when compared with Subversion
@@ -450,7 +450,7 @@
 	and network bandwidth become bottlenecks for modestly large
 	projects.</para>
 
-      <para>Additionally, Subversion incurs substantial storage
+      <para id="x_aa">Additionally, Subversion incurs substantial storage
 	overhead to avoid network transactions for a few common
 	operations, such as finding modified files
 	(<literal>status</literal>) and displaying modifications
@@ -460,13 +460,13 @@
 	even though the Mercurial repository contains a complete
 	history of the project.</para>
 
-      <para>Subversion is widely supported by third party tools.
+      <para id="x_ab">Subversion is widely supported by third party tools.
 	Mercurial currently lags considerably in this area.  This gap
 	is closing, however, and indeed some of Mercurial's GUI tools
 	now outshine their Subversion equivalents.  Like Mercurial,
 	Subversion has an excellent user manual.</para>
 
-      <para>Because Subversion doesn't store revision history on the
+      <para id="x_ac">Because Subversion doesn't store revision history on the
 	client, it is well suited to managing projects that deal with
 	lots of large, opaque binary files.  If you check in fifty
 	revisions to an incompressible 10MB file, Subversion's
@@ -475,14 +475,14 @@
 	of revisions, because the differences between each revision
 	are large.</para>
 
-      <para>In addition, it's often difficult or, more usually,
+      <para id="x_ad">In addition, it's often difficult or, more usually,
 	impossible to merge different versions of a binary file.
 	Subversion's ability to let a user lock a file, so that they
 	temporarily have the exclusive right to commit changes to it,
 	can be a significant advantage to a project where binary files
 	are widely used.</para>
 
-      <para>Mercurial can import revision history from a Subversion
+      <para id="x_ae">Mercurial can import revision history from a Subversion
 	repository. It can also export revision history to a
 	Subversion repository.  This makes it easy to <quote>test the
 	  waters</quote> and use Mercurial and Subversion in parallel
@@ -496,24 +496,24 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Git</title>
 
-      <para>Git is a distributed revision control tool that was
+      <para id="x_af">Git is a distributed revision control tool that was
 	developed for managing the Linux kernel source tree.  Like
 	Mercurial, its early design was somewhat influenced by
 	Monotone.</para>
 
-      <para>Git has a very large command set, with version 1.5.0
+      <para id="x_b0">Git has a very large command set, with version 1.5.0
 	providing 139 individual commands.  It has something of a
 	reputation for being difficult to learn.  Compared to Git,
 	Mercurial has a strong focus on simplicity.</para>
 
-      <para>In terms of performance, Git is extremely fast.  In
+      <para id="x_b1">In terms of performance, Git is extremely fast.  In
 	several cases, it is faster than Mercurial, at least on Linux,
 	while Mercurial performs better on other operations.  However,
 	on Windows, the performance and general level of support that
 	Git provides is, at the time of writing, far behind that of
 	Mercurial.</para>
 
-      <para>While a Mercurial repository needs no maintenance, a Git
+      <para id="x_b2">While a Mercurial repository needs no maintenance, a Git
 	repository requires frequent manual <quote>repacks</quote> of
 	its metadata.  Without these, performance degrades, while
 	space usage grows rapidly.  A server that contains many Git
@@ -524,13 +524,13 @@
 	slightly smaller than a Mercurial repository, but an unpacked
 	repository is several orders of magnitude larger.</para>
 
-      <para>The core of Git is written in C.  Many Git commands are
+      <para id="x_b3">The core of Git is written in C.  Many Git commands are
 	implemented as shell or Perl scripts, and the quality of these
 	scripts varies widely. I have encountered several instances
 	where scripts charged along blindly in the presence of errors
 	that should have been fatal.</para>
 
-      <para>Mercurial can import revision history from a Git
+      <para id="x_b4">Mercurial can import revision history from a Git
 	repository.</para>
 
 
@@ -538,11 +538,11 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>CVS</title>
 
-      <para>CVS is probably the most widely used revision control tool
+      <para id="x_b5">CVS is probably the most widely used revision control tool
 	in the world.  Due to its age and internal untidiness, it has
 	been only lightly maintained for many years.</para>
 
-      <para>It has a centralised client/server architecture.  It does
+      <para id="x_b6">It has a centralised client/server architecture.  It does
 	not group related file changes into atomic commits, making it
 	easy for people to <quote>break the build</quote>: one person
 	can successfully commit part of a change and then be blocked
@@ -554,7 +554,7 @@
 	the changes made to each file involved (if you even know what
 	those files were).</para>
 
-      <para>CVS has a muddled notion of tags and branches that I will
+      <para id="x_b7">CVS has a muddled notion of tags and branches that I will
 	not attempt to even describe.  It does not support renaming of
 	files or directories well, making it easy to corrupt a
 	repository.  It has almost no internal consistency checking
@@ -562,7 +562,7 @@
 	whether or how a repository is corrupt.  I would not recommend
 	CVS for any project, existing or new.</para>
 
-      <para>Mercurial can import CVS revision history.  However, there
+      <para id="x_b8">Mercurial can import CVS revision history.  However, there
 	are a few caveats that apply; these are true of every other
 	revision control tool's CVS importer, too.  Due to CVS's lack
 	of atomic changes and unversioned filesystem hierarchy, it is
@@ -576,7 +576,7 @@
 	the less interesting problems I can recall from personal
 	experience).</para>
 
-      <para>Mercurial can import revision history from a CVS
+      <para id="x_b9">Mercurial can import revision history from a CVS
 	repository.</para>
 
 
@@ -584,13 +584,13 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Commercial tools</title>
 
-      <para>Perforce has a centralised client/server architecture,
+      <para id="x_ba">Perforce has a centralised client/server architecture,
 	with no client-side caching of any data.  Unlike modern
 	revision control tools, Perforce requires that a user run a
 	command to inform the server about every file they intend to
 	edit.</para>
 
-      <para>The performance of Perforce is quite good for small teams,
+      <para id="x_bb">The performance of Perforce is quite good for small teams,
 	but it falls off rapidly as the number of users grows beyond a
 	few dozen. Modestly large Perforce installations require the
 	deployment of proxies to cope with the load their users
@@ -601,16 +601,16 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Choosing a revision control tool</title>
 
-      <para>With the exception of CVS, all of the tools listed above
+      <para id="x_bc">With the exception of CVS, all of the tools listed above
 	have unique strengths that suit them to particular styles of
 	work.  There is no single revision control tool that is best
 	in all situations.</para>
 
-      <para>As an example, Subversion is a good choice for working
+      <para id="x_bd">As an example, Subversion is a good choice for working
 	with frequently edited binary files, due to its centralised
 	nature and support for file locking.</para>
 
-      <para>I personally find Mercurial's properties of simplicity,
+      <para id="x_be">I personally find Mercurial's properties of simplicity,
 	performance, and good merge support to be a compelling
 	combination that has served me well for several years.</para>
 
@@ -620,7 +620,7 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Switching from another tool to Mercurial</title>
 
-    <para>Mercurial is bundled with an extension named <literal
+    <para id="x_bf">Mercurial is bundled with an extension named <literal
 	role="hg-ext">convert</literal>, which can incrementally
       import revision history from several other revision control
       tools.  By <quote>incremental</quote>, I mean that you can
@@ -628,21 +628,21 @@
       the conversion later to obtain new changes that happened after
       the initial conversion.</para>
 
-    <para>The revision control tools supported by <literal
+    <para id="x_c0">The revision control tools supported by <literal
 	role="hg-ext">convert</literal> are as follows:</para>
     <itemizedlist>
-      <listitem><para>Subversion</para></listitem>
-      <listitem><para>CVS</para></listitem>
-      <listitem><para>Git</para></listitem>
-      <listitem><para>Darcs</para></listitem></itemizedlist>
+      <listitem><para id="x_c1">Subversion</para></listitem>
+      <listitem><para id="x_c2">CVS</para></listitem>
+      <listitem><para id="x_c3">Git</para></listitem>
+      <listitem><para id="x_c4">Darcs</para></listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-    <para>In addition, <literal role="hg-ext">convert</literal> can
+    <para id="x_c5">In addition, <literal role="hg-ext">convert</literal> can
       export changes from Mercurial to Subversion.  This makes it
       possible to try Subversion and Mercurial in parallel before
       committing to a switchover, without risking the loss of any
       work.</para>
 
-    <para>The <command role="hg-ext-convert">convert</command> command
+    <para id="x_c6">The <command role="hg-ext-convert">convert</command> command
       is easy to use.  Simply point it at the path or URL of the
       source repository, optionally give it the name of the
       destination repository, and it will start working.  After the
@@ -653,7 +653,7 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>A short history of revision control</title>
 
-    <para>The best known of the old-time revision control tools is
+    <para id="x_c7">The best known of the old-time revision control tools is
       SCCS (Source Code Control System), which Marc Rochkind wrote at
       Bell Labs, in the early 1970s.  SCCS operated on individual
       files, and required every person working on a project to have
@@ -664,13 +664,13 @@
       modifying those files without the help of an
       administrator.</para>
 
-    <para>Walter Tichy developed a free alternative to SCCS in the
+    <para id="x_c8">Walter Tichy developed a free alternative to SCCS in the
       early 1980s; he called his program RCS (Revision Control System).
       Like SCCS, RCS required developers to work in a single shared
       workspace, and to lock files to prevent multiple people from
       modifying them simultaneously.</para>
 
-    <para>Later in the 1980s, Dick Grune used RCS as a building block
+    <para id="x_c9">Later in the 1980s, Dick Grune used RCS as a building block
       for a set of shell scripts he initially called cmt, but then
       renamed to CVS (Concurrent Versions System).  The big innovation
       of CVS was that it let developers work simultaneously and
@@ -681,7 +681,7 @@
       their copies independently.  They had to merge their edits prior
       to committing changes to the central repository.</para>
 
-    <para>Brian Berliner took Grune's original scripts and rewrote
+    <para id="x_ca">Brian Berliner took Grune's original scripts and rewrote
       them in C, releasing in 1989 the code that has since developed
       into the modern version of CVS.  CVS subsequently acquired the
       ability to operate over a network connection, giving it a
@@ -692,14 +692,14 @@
       server is.  CVS has been enormously successful; it is probably
       the world's most widely used revision control system.</para>
 
-    <para>In the early 1990s, Sun Microsystems developed an early
+    <para id="x_cb">In the early 1990s, Sun Microsystems developed an early
       distributed revision control system, called TeamWare.  A
       TeamWare workspace contains a complete copy of the project's
       history.  TeamWare has no notion of a central repository.  (CVS
       relied upon RCS for its history storage; TeamWare used
       SCCS.)</para>
 
-    <para>As the 1990s progressed, awareness grew of a number of
+    <para id="x_cc">As the 1990s progressed, awareness grew of a number of
       problems with CVS.  It records simultaneous changes to multiple
       files individually, instead of grouping them together as a
       single logically atomic operation.  It does not manage its file
@@ -709,7 +709,7 @@
 	level</quote> of fixing these architectural problems
       prohibitive.</para>
 
-    <para>In 2001, Jim Blandy and Karl Fogel, two developers who had
+    <para id="x_cd">In 2001, Jim Blandy and Karl Fogel, two developers who had
       worked on CVS, started a project to replace it with a tool that
       would have a better architecture and cleaner code.  The result,
       Subversion, does not stray from CVS's centralised client/server
@@ -718,7 +718,7 @@
       generally better tool than CVS. Since its initial release, it
       has rapidly grown in popularity.</para>
 
-    <para>More or less simultaneously, Graydon Hoare began working on
+    <para id="x_ce">More or less simultaneously, Graydon Hoare began working on
       an ambitious distributed revision control system that he named
       Monotone. While Monotone addresses many of CVS's design flaws
       and has a peer-to-peer architecture, it goes beyond earlier (and
@@ -727,7 +727,7 @@
       integral notion of <quote>trust</quote> for code from different
       sources.</para>
 
-    <para>Mercurial began life in 2005.  While a few aspects of its
+    <para id="x_cf">Mercurial began life in 2005.  While a few aspects of its
       design are influenced by Monotone, Mercurial focuses on ease of
       use, high performance, and scalability to very large
       projects.</para>
@@ -737,12 +737,12 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Colophon&emdash;this book is Free</title>
 
-    <para>This book is licensed under the Open Publication License,
+    <para id="x_d0">This book is licensed under the Open Publication License,
       and is produced entirely using Free Software tools.  It is
       typeset with DocBook XML.  Illustrations are drawn and rendered with
       <ulink url="http://www.inkscape.org/">Inkscape</ulink>.</para>
 
-    <para>The complete source code for this book is published as a
+    <para id="x_d1">The complete source code for this book is published as a
       Mercurial repository, at <ulink
 	url="http://hg.serpentine.com/mercurial/book">http://hg.serpentine.com/mercurial/book</ulink>.</para>
 
--- a/en/ch01-tour-basic.xml	Thu Mar 19 20:54:12 2009 -0700
+++ b/en/ch01-tour-basic.xml	Thu Mar 19 21:18:52 2009 -0700
@@ -7,21 +7,21 @@
   <sect1 id="sec:tour:install">
     <title>Installing Mercurial on your system</title>
 
-    <para>Prebuilt binary packages of Mercurial are available for
+    <para id="x_1">Prebuilt binary packages of Mercurial are available for
       every popular operating system.  These make it easy to start
       using Mercurial on your computer immediately.</para>
 
     <sect2>
       <title>Linux</title>
 
-      <para>Because each Linux distribution has its own packaging
+      <para id="x_2">Because each Linux distribution has its own packaging
 	tools, policies, and rate of development, it's difficult to
 	give a comprehensive set of instructions on how to install
 	Mercurial binaries.  The version of Mercurial that you will
 	end up with can vary depending on how active the person is who
 	maintains the package for your distribution.</para>
 
-      <para>To keep things simple, I will focus on installing
+      <para id="x_3">To keep things simple, I will focus on installing
 	Mercurial from the command line under the most popular Linux
 	distributions.  Most of these distributions provide graphical
 	package managers that will let you install Mercurial with a
@@ -29,15 +29,15 @@
 	<literal>mercurial</literal>.</para>
 
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para>Debian:</para>
+	<listitem><para id="x_4">Debian:</para>
 	  <programlisting>apt-get install mercurial</programlisting></listitem>
-	<listitem><para>Fedora Core:</para>
+	<listitem><para id="x_5">Fedora Core:</para>
 	  <programlisting>yum install mercurial</programlisting></listitem>
-	<listitem><para>Gentoo:</para>
+	<listitem><para id="x_6">Gentoo:</para>
 	  <programlisting>emerge mercurial</programlisting></listitem>
-	<listitem><para>OpenSUSE:</para>
+	<listitem><para id="x_7">OpenSUSE:</para>
 	  <programlisting>yum install mercurial</programlisting></listitem>
-	<listitem><para>Ubuntu: Ubuntu's Mercurial package is based on
+	<listitem><para id="x_8">Ubuntu: Ubuntu's Mercurial package is based on
 	    Debian's.  To install it, run the following
 	    command.</para>
 	  <programlisting>apt-get install mercurial</programlisting></listitem>
@@ -47,7 +47,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Solaris</title>
 
-      <para>SunFreeWare, at <ulink
+      <para id="x_9">SunFreeWare, at <ulink
 	  url="http://www.sunfreeware.com">http://www.sunfreeware.com</ulink>, 
 	is a good source for a large number of pre-built Solaris
 	packages for 32 and 64 bit Intel and Sparc architectures,
@@ -57,7 +57,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Mac OS X</title>
 
-      <para>Lee Cantey publishes an installer of Mercurial for Mac OS
+      <para id="x_a">Lee Cantey publishes an installer of Mercurial for Mac OS
 	X at <ulink
 	  url="http://mercurial.berkwood.com">http://mercurial.berkwood.com</ulink>. 
 	This package works on both Intel- and Power-based Macs. Before
@@ -66,7 +66,7 @@
 	is easy to do; simply follow the instructions on Lee's
 	site.</para>
 
-      <para>It's also possible to install Mercurial using Fink or
+      <para id="x_b">It's also possible to install Mercurial using Fink or
 	MacPorts, two popular free package managers for Mac OS X.  If
 	you have Fink, use <command>sudo apt-get install
 	  mercurial-py25</command>.  If MacPorts, <command>sudo port
@@ -76,14 +76,14 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Windows</title>
 
-      <para>Lee Cantey publishes an installer of Mercurial for Windows
+      <para id="x_c">Lee Cantey publishes an installer of Mercurial for Windows
 	at <ulink
 	  url="http://mercurial.berkwood.com">http://mercurial.berkwood.com</ulink>. 
 	This package has no external dependencies; it <quote>just
 	  works</quote>.</para>
 
       <note>
-	<para>  The Windows version of Mercurial does not
+	<para id="x_d">  The Windows version of Mercurial does not
 	  automatically convert line endings between Windows and Unix
 	  styles.  If you want to share work with Unix users, you must
 	  do a little additional configuration work. XXX Flesh this
@@ -95,7 +95,7 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Getting started</title>
 
-    <para>To begin, we'll use the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+    <para id="x_e">To begin, we'll use the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	version</command> command to find out whether Mercurial is
       actually installed properly.  The actual version information
       that it prints isn't so important; it's whether it prints
@@ -106,7 +106,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Built-in help</title>
 
-      <para>Mercurial provides a built-in help system.  This is
+      <para id="x_f">Mercurial provides a built-in help system.  This is
 	  invaluable for those times when you find yourself stuck
 	  trying to remember how to run a command.  If you are
 	  completely stuck, simply run <command role="hg-cmd">hg
@@ -117,7 +117,7 @@
 
 	&interaction.tour.help;
 
-	<para>For a more impressive level of detail (which you won't
+	<para id="x_10">For a more impressive level of detail (which you won't
 	  usually need) run <command role="hg-cmd">hg help <option
 	      role="hg-opt-global">-v</option></command>.  The <option
 	    role="hg-opt-global">-v</option> option is short for
@@ -130,13 +130,13 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Working with a repository</title>
 
-    <para>In Mercurial, everything happens inside a
+    <para id="x_11">In Mercurial, everything happens inside a
       <emphasis>repository</emphasis>.  The repository for a project
       contains all of the files that <quote>belong to</quote> that
       project, along with a historical record of the project's
       files.</para>
 
-    <para>There's nothing particularly magical about a repository; it
+    <para id="x_12">There's nothing particularly magical about a repository; it
       is simply a directory tree in your filesystem that Mercurial
       treats as special. You can rename or delete a repository any
       time you like, using either the command line or your file
@@ -145,7 +145,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Making a local copy of a repository</title>
 
-      <para><emphasis>Copying</emphasis> a repository is just a little
+      <para id="x_13"><emphasis>Copying</emphasis> a repository is just a little
 	bit special.  While you could use a normal file copying
 	command to make a copy of a repository, it's best to use a
 	built-in command that Mercurial provides.  This command is
@@ -154,23 +154,23 @@
 
       &interaction.tour.clone;
 
-      <para>If our clone succeeded, we should now have a local
+      <para id="x_14">If our clone succeeded, we should now have a local
 	directory called <filename class="directory">hello</filename>.
 	This directory will contain some files.</para>
 
       &interaction.tour.ls;
 
-      <para>These files have the same contents and history in our
+      <para id="x_15">These files have the same contents and history in our
 	repository as they do in the repository we cloned.</para>
 
-      <para>Every Mercurial repository is complete, self-contained,
+      <para id="x_16">Every Mercurial repository is complete, self-contained,
 	and independent.  It contains its own private copy of a
 	project's files and history.  A cloned repository remembers
 	the location of the repository it was cloned from, but it does
 	not communicate with that repository, or any other, unless you
 	tell it to.</para>
 
-      <para>What this means for now is that we're free to experiment
+      <para id="x_17">What this means for now is that we're free to experiment
 	with our repository, safe in the knowledge that it's a private
 	<quote>sandbox</quote> that won't affect anyone else.</para>
 
@@ -178,20 +178,20 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>What's in a repository?</title>
 
-      <para>When we take a more detailed look inside a repository, we
+      <para id="x_18">When we take a more detailed look inside a repository, we
 	can see that it contains a directory named <filename
 	  class="directory">.hg</filename>.  This is where Mercurial
 	keeps all of its metadata for the repository.</para>
 
       &interaction.tour.ls-a;
 
-      <para>The contents of the <filename
+      <para id="x_19">The contents of the <filename
 	  class="directory">.hg</filename> directory and its
 	subdirectories are private to Mercurial.  Every other file and
 	directory in the repository is yours to do with as you
 	please.</para>
 
-      <para>To introduce a little terminology, the <filename
+      <para id="x_1a">To introduce a little terminology, the <filename
 	  class="directory">.hg</filename> directory is the
 	<quote>real</quote> repository, and all of the files and
 	directories that coexist with it are said to live in the
@@ -208,45 +208,45 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>A tour through history</title>
 
-    <para>One of the first things we might want to do with a new,
+    <para id="x_1b">One of the first things we might want to do with a new,
       unfamiliar repository is understand its history.  The <command
 	role="hg-cmd">hg log</command> command gives us a view of
       history.</para>
 
     &interaction.tour.log;
 
-    <para>By default, this command prints a brief paragraph of output
+    <para id="x_1c">By default, this command prints a brief paragraph of output
       for each change to the project that was recorded.  In Mercurial
       terminology, we call each of these recorded events a
       <emphasis>changeset</emphasis>, because it can contain a record
       of changes to several files.</para>
 
-    <para>The fields in a record of output from <command
+    <para id="x_1d">The fields in a record of output from <command
 	role="hg-cmd">hg log</command> are as follows.</para>
     <itemizedlist>
-      <listitem><para><literal>changeset</literal>: This field has the
+      <listitem><para id="x_1e"><literal>changeset</literal>: This field has the
 	  format of a number, followed by a colon, followed by a
 	  hexadecimal string.  These are
 	  <emphasis>identifiers</emphasis> for the changeset.  There
 	  are two identifiers because the number is shorter and easier
 	  to type than the hex string.</para></listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal>user</literal>: The identity of the
+      <listitem><para id="x_1f"><literal>user</literal>: The identity of the
 	  person who created the changeset.  This is a free-form
 	  field, but it most often contains a person's name and email
 	  address.</para></listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal>date</literal>: The date and time on
+      <listitem><para id="x_20"><literal>date</literal>: The date and time on
 	  which the changeset was created, and the timezone in which
 	  it was created.  (The date and time are local to that
 	  timezone; they display what time and date it was for the
 	  person who created the changeset.)</para></listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal>summary</literal>: The first line of
+      <listitem><para id="x_21"><literal>summary</literal>: The first line of
 	  the text message that the creator of the changeset entered
 	  to describe the changeset.</para></listitem></itemizedlist>
-    <para>The default output printed by <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+    <para id="x_22">The default output printed by <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	log</command> is purely a summary; it is missing a lot of
       detail.</para>
 
-    <para>Figure <xref linkend="fig:tour-basic:history"/> provides a
+    <para id="x_23">Figure <xref linkend="fig:tour-basic:history"/> provides a
       graphical representation of the history of the <filename
 	class="directory">hello</filename> repository, to make it a
       little easier to see which direction history is
@@ -258,7 +258,7 @@
       <mediaobject>
 	<imageobject><imagedata fileref="tour-history"/></imageobject>
 	<textobject><phrase>XXX add text</phrase></textobject>
-	<caption><para>Graphical history of the <filename
+	<caption><para id="x_24">Graphical history of the <filename
 	      class="directory">hello</filename>
 	    repository</para></caption>
       </mediaobject>
@@ -268,7 +268,7 @@
       <title>Changesets, revisions, and talking to other
 	people</title>
 
-      <para>As English is a notoriously sloppy language, and computer
+      <para id="x_25">As English is a notoriously sloppy language, and computer
 	science has a hallowed history of terminological confusion
 	(why use one term when four will do?), revision control has a
 	variety of words and phrases that mean the same thing.  If you
@@ -278,7 +278,7 @@
 	<quote>cset</quote>, and sometimes a changeset is referred to
 	as a <quote>revision</quote> or a <quote>rev</quote>.</para>
 
-      <para>While it doesn't matter what <emphasis>word</emphasis> you
+      <para id="x_26">While it doesn't matter what <emphasis>word</emphasis> you
 	use to refer to the concept of <quote>a changeset</quote>, the
 	<emphasis>identifier</emphasis> that you use to refer to
 	<quote>a <emphasis>specific</emphasis> changeset</quote> is of
@@ -287,14 +287,14 @@
 	  log</command> identifies a changeset using both a number and
 	a hexadecimal string.</para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para>The revision number is <emphasis>only valid in
+	<listitem><para id="x_27">The revision number is <emphasis>only valid in
 	      that repository</emphasis>,</para></listitem>
-	<listitem><para>while the hex string is the
+	<listitem><para id="x_28">while the hex string is the
 	    <emphasis>permanent, unchanging identifier</emphasis> that
 	    will always identify that exact changeset in
 	    <emphasis>every</emphasis> copy of the
 	    repository.</para></listitem></itemizedlist>
-      <para>This distinction is important.  If you send someone an
+      <para id="x_29">This distinction is important.  If you send someone an
 	email talking about <quote>revision 33</quote>, there's a high
 	likelihood that their revision 33 will <emphasis>not be the
 	  same</emphasis> as yours.  The reason for this is that a
@@ -304,7 +304,7 @@
 	repositories. Three changes $a,b,c$ can easily appear in one
 	repository as $0,1,2$, while in another as $1,0,2$.</para>
 
-      <para>Mercurial uses revision numbers purely as a convenient
+      <para id="x_2a">Mercurial uses revision numbers purely as a convenient
 	shorthand.  If you need to discuss a changeset with someone,
 	or make a record of a changeset for some other reason (for
 	example, in a bug report), use the hexadecimal
@@ -314,7 +314,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Viewing specific revisions</title>
 
-      <para>To narrow the output of <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+      <para id="x_2b">To narrow the output of <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	  log</command> down to a single revision, use the <option
 	  role="hg-opt-log">-r</option> (or <option
 	  role="hg-opt-log">--rev</option>) option.  You can use
@@ -323,7 +323,7 @@
 
       &interaction.tour.log-r;
 
-      <para>If you want to see the history of several revisions
+      <para id="x_2c">If you want to see the history of several revisions
 	without having to list each one, you can use <emphasis>range
 	  notation</emphasis>; this lets you express the idea <quote>I
 	  want all revisions between <literal>abc</literal> and
@@ -331,7 +331,7 @@
       
 	&interaction.tour.log.range;
 
-      <para>Mercurial also honours the order in which you specify
+      <para id="x_2d">Mercurial also honours the order in which you specify
 	revisions, so <command role="hg-cmd">hg log -r 2:4</command>
 	prints 2, 3, and 4. while <command role="hg-cmd">hg log -r
 	  4:2</command> prints 4, 3, and 2.</para>
@@ -340,7 +340,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>More detailed information</title>
 
-      <para>While the summary information printed by <command
+      <para id="x_2e">While the summary information printed by <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg log</command> is useful if you already know
 	what you're looking for, you may need to see a complete
 	description of the change, or a list of the files changed, if
@@ -352,7 +352,7 @@
 
       &interaction.tour.log-v;
 
-      <para>If you want to see both the description and content of a
+      <para id="x_2f">If you want to see both the description and content of a
 	change, add the <option role="hg-opt-log">-p</option> (or
 	<option role="hg-opt-log">--patch</option>) option.  This
 	displays the content of a change as a <emphasis>unified
@@ -367,39 +367,39 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>All about command options</title>
 
-    <para>Let's take a brief break from exploring Mercurial commands
+    <para id="x_30">Let's take a brief break from exploring Mercurial commands
       to discuss a pattern in the way that they work; you may find
       this useful to keep in mind as we continue our tour.</para>
 
-    <para>Mercurial has a consistent and straightforward approach to
+    <para id="x_31">Mercurial has a consistent and straightforward approach to
       dealing with the options that you can pass to commands.  It
       follows the conventions for options that are common to modern
       Linux and Unix systems.</para>
     <itemizedlist>
-      <listitem><para>Every option has a long name.  For example, as
+      <listitem><para id="x_32">Every option has a long name.  For example, as
 	  we've already seen, the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	    log</command> command accepts a <option
 	    role="hg-opt-log">--rev</option> option.</para></listitem>
-      <listitem><para>Most options have short names, too.  Instead of
+      <listitem><para id="x_33">Most options have short names, too.  Instead of
 	  <option role="hg-opt-log">--rev</option>, we can use <option
 	    role="hg-opt-log">-r</option>.  (The reason that some
 	  options don't have short names is that the options in
 	  question are rarely used.)</para></listitem>
-      <listitem><para>Long options start with two dashes (e.g. <option
+      <listitem><para id="x_34">Long options start with two dashes (e.g. <option
 	    role="hg-opt-log">--rev</option>), while short options
 	  start with one (e.g. <option
 	    role="hg-opt-log">-r</option>).</para></listitem>
-      <listitem><para>Option naming and usage is consistent across
+      <listitem><para id="x_35">Option naming and usage is consistent across
 	  commands.  For example, every command that lets you specify
 	  a changeset ID or revision number accepts both <option
 	    role="hg-opt-log">-r</option> and <option
 	    role="hg-opt-log">--rev</option>
 	  arguments.</para></listitem></itemizedlist>
-    <para>In the examples throughout this book, I use short options
+    <para id="x_36">In the examples throughout this book, I use short options
       instead of long.  This just reflects my own preference, so don't
       read anything significant into it.</para>
 
-    <para>Most commands that print output of some kind will print more
+    <para id="x_37">Most commands that print output of some kind will print more
       output when passed a <option role="hg-opt-global">-v</option>
       (or <option role="hg-opt-global">--verbose</option>) option, and
       less when passed <option role="hg-opt-global">-q</option> (or
@@ -409,11 +409,11 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Making and reviewing changes</title>
 
-    <para>Now that we have a grasp of viewing history in Mercurial,
+    <para id="x_38">Now that we have a grasp of viewing history in Mercurial,
       let's take a look at making some changes and examining
       them.</para>
 
-    <para>The first thing we'll do is isolate our experiment in a
+    <para id="x_39">The first thing we'll do is isolate our experiment in a
       repository of its own.  We use the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	clone</command> command, but we don't need to clone a copy of
       the remote repository.  Since we already have a copy of it
@@ -423,7 +423,7 @@
 
     &interaction.tour.reclone;
 
-    <para>As an aside, it's often good practice to keep a
+    <para id="x_3a">As an aside, it's often good practice to keep a
       <quote>pristine</quote> copy of a remote repository around,
       which you can then make temporary clones of to create sandboxes
       for each task you want to work on.  This lets you work on
@@ -432,7 +432,7 @@
       local clones are so cheap, there's almost no overhead to cloning
       and destroying repositories whenever you want.</para>
 
-    <para>In our <filename class="directory">my-hello</filename>
+    <para id="x_3b">In our <filename class="directory">my-hello</filename>
       repository, we have a file <filename>hello.c</filename> that
       contains the classic <quote>hello, world</quote> program. Let's
       use the ancient and venerable <command>sed</command> command to
@@ -445,20 +445,20 @@
 
     &interaction.tour.sed;
 
-    <para>Mercurial's <command role="hg-cmd">hg status</command>
+    <para id="x_3c">Mercurial's <command role="hg-cmd">hg status</command>
       command will tell us what Mercurial knows about the files in the
       repository.</para>
 
     &interaction.tour.status;
 
-    <para>The <command role="hg-cmd">hg status</command> command
+    <para id="x_3d">The <command role="hg-cmd">hg status</command> command
       prints no output for some files, but a line starting with
       <quote><literal>M</literal></quote> for
       <filename>hello.c</filename>.  Unless you tell it to, <command
 	role="hg-cmd">hg status</command> will not print any output
       for files that have not been modified.</para>
 
-    <para>The <quote><literal>M</literal></quote> indicates that
+    <para id="x_3e">The <quote><literal>M</literal></quote> indicates that
       Mercurial has noticed that we modified
       <filename>hello.c</filename>.  We didn't need to
       <emphasis>inform</emphasis> Mercurial that we were going to
@@ -466,7 +466,7 @@
       file after we were done; it was able to figure this out
       itself.</para>
 
-    <para>It's a little bit helpful to know that we've modified
+    <para id="x_3f">It's a little bit helpful to know that we've modified
       <filename>hello.c</filename>, but we might prefer to know
       exactly <emphasis>what</emphasis> changes we've made to it.  To
       do this, we use the <command role="hg-cmd">hg diff</command>
@@ -478,14 +478,14 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Recording changes in a new changeset</title>
 
-    <para>We can modify files, build and test our changes, and use
+    <para id="x_40">We can modify files, build and test our changes, and use
       <command role="hg-cmd">hg status</command> and <command
 	role="hg-cmd">hg diff</command> to review our changes, until
       we're satisfied with what we've done and arrive at a natural
       stopping point where we want to record our work in a new
       changeset.</para>
 
-    <para>The <command role="hg-cmd">hg commit</command> command lets
+    <para id="x_41">The <command role="hg-cmd">hg commit</command> command lets
       us create a new changeset; we'll usually refer to this as
       <quote>making a commit</quote> or
       <quote>committing</quote>.</para>
@@ -493,7 +493,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Setting up a username</title>
 
-      <para>When you try to run <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+      <para id="x_42">When you try to run <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	  commit</command> for the first time, it is not guaranteed to
 	succeed.  Mercurial records your name and address with each
 	change that you commit, so that you and others will later be
@@ -502,36 +502,36 @@
 	change with.  It will attempt each of the following methods,
 	in order:</para>
       <orderedlist>
-	<listitem><para>If you specify a <option
+	<listitem><para id="x_43">If you specify a <option
 	      role="hg-opt-commit">-u</option> option to the <command
 	      role="hg-cmd">hg commit</command> command on the command
 	    line, followed by a username, this is always given the
 	    highest precedence.</para></listitem>
-	<listitem><para>If you have set the <envar>HGUSER</envar>
+	<listitem><para id="x_44">If you have set the <envar>HGUSER</envar>
 	    environment variable, this is checked
 	    next.</para></listitem>
-	<listitem><para>If you create a file in your home directory
+	<listitem><para id="x_45">If you create a file in your home directory
 	    called <filename role="special">.hgrc</filename>, with a
 	    <envar role="rc-item-ui">username</envar> entry, that will
 	    be used next.  To see what the contents of this file
 	    should look like, refer to section <xref
 	      linkend="sec:tour-basic:username"/>
 	    below.</para></listitem>
-	<listitem><para>If you have set the <envar>EMAIL</envar>
+	<listitem><para id="x_46">If you have set the <envar>EMAIL</envar>
 	    environment variable, this will be used
 	    next.</para></listitem>
-	<listitem><para>Mercurial will query your system to find out
+	<listitem><para id="x_47">Mercurial will query your system to find out
 	    your local user name and host name, and construct a
 	    username from these components. Since this often results
 	    in a username that is not very useful, it will print a
 	    warning if it has to do
 	    this.</para></listitem>
       </orderedlist>
-      <para>If all of these mechanisms fail, Mercurial will
+      <para id="x_48">If all of these mechanisms fail, Mercurial will
 	  fail, printing an error message.  In this case, it will not
 	  let you commit until you set up a
 	  username.</para>
-      <para>You should think of the <envar>HGUSER</envar> environment
+      <para id="x_49">You should think of the <envar>HGUSER</envar> environment
 	variable and the <option role="hg-opt-commit">-u</option>
 	option to the <command role="hg-cmd">hg commit</command>
 	command as ways to <emphasis>override</emphasis> Mercurial's
@@ -542,7 +542,7 @@
       <sect3 id="sec:tour-basic:username">
 	<title>Creating a Mercurial configuration file</title>
 
-	<para>To set a user name, use your favourite editor
+	<para id="x_4a">To set a user name, use your favourite editor
 	    to create a file called <filename
 	      role="special">.hgrc</filename> in your home directory.
 	    Mercurial will use this file to look up your personalised
@@ -554,7 +554,7 @@
 username = Firstname Lastname
 &lt;email.address@domain.net&gt;</programlisting>
 
-	<para>The <quote><literal>[ui]</literal></quote> line begins a
+	<para id="x_4b">The <quote><literal>[ui]</literal></quote> line begins a
 	  <emphasis>section</emphasis> of the config file, so you can
 	  read the <quote><literal>username = ...</literal></quote>
 	  line as meaning <quote>set the value of the
@@ -569,14 +569,14 @@
       <sect3>
 	<title>Choosing a user name</title>
 
-	<para>You can use any text you like as the value of
+	<para id="x_4c">You can use any text you like as the value of
 	    the <literal>username</literal> config item, since this
 	    information is for reading by other people, but for
 	    interpreting by Mercurial.  The convention that most
 	    people follow is to use their name and email address, as
 	    in the example above.</para>
 	<note>
-	  <para>Mercurial's built-in web server obfuscates
+	  <para id="x_4d">Mercurial's built-in web server obfuscates
 	      email addresses, to make it more difficult for the email
 	      harvesting tools that spammers use. This reduces the
 	      likelihood that you'll start receiving more junk email
@@ -588,7 +588,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Writing a commit message</title>
 
-      <para>When we commit a change, Mercurial drops us into
+      <para id="x_4e">When we commit a change, Mercurial drops us into
 	  a text editor, to enter a message that will describe the
 	  modifications we've made in this changeset.  This is called
 	  the <emphasis>commit message</emphasis>.  It will be a
@@ -598,14 +598,14 @@
 
        &interaction.tour.commit;
 
-      <para>The editor that the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+      <para id="x_4f">The editor that the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	    commit</command> command drops us into will contain an
 	  empty line, followed by a number of lines starting with
 	  <quote><literal>HG:</literal></quote>.</para>
 
     <programlisting>XXX fix this XXX</programlisting>
 
-      <para>Mercurial ignores the lines that start with
+      <para id="x_50">Mercurial ignores the lines that start with
 	  <quote><literal>HG:</literal></quote>; it uses them only to
 	  tell us which files it's recording changes to.  Modifying or
 	  deleting these lines has no effect.</para>
@@ -613,7 +613,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Writing a good commit message</title>
 
-      <para>Since <command role="hg-cmd">hg log</command>
+      <para id="x_51">Since <command role="hg-cmd">hg log</command>
 	  only prints the first line of a commit message by default,
 	  it's best to write a commit message whose first line stands
 	  alone.  Here's a real example of a commit message that
@@ -627,13 +627,13 @@
 date:        Tue Sep 26 21:37:07 2006 -0700
 summary:     include buildmeister/commondefs. Add exports.</programlisting>
 
-      <para>As far as the remainder of the contents of the
+      <para id="x_52">As far as the remainder of the contents of the
 	  commit message are concerned, there are no hard-and-fast
 	  rules.  Mercurial itself doesn't interpret or care about the
 	  contents of the commit message, though your project may have
 	  policies that dictate a certain kind of
 	  formatting.</para>
-      <para>My personal preference is for short, but
+      <para id="x_53">My personal preference is for short, but
 	  informative, commit messages that tell me something that I
 	  can't figure out with a quick glance at the output of
 	  <command role="hg-cmd">hg log
@@ -642,12 +642,12 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Aborting a commit</title>
 
-      <para>If you decide that you don't want to commit
+      <para id="x_54">If you decide that you don't want to commit
 	  while in the middle of editing a commit message, simply exit
 	  from your editor without saving the file that it's editing.
 	  This will cause nothing to happen to either the repository
 	  or the working directory.</para>
-      <para>If we run the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+      <para id="x_55">If we run the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	    commit</command> command without any arguments, it records
 	  all of the changes we've made, as reported by <command
 	    role="hg-cmd">hg status</command> and <command
@@ -656,7 +656,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Admiring our new handiwork</title>
 
-      <para>Once we've finished the commit, we can use the
+      <para id="x_56">Once we've finished the commit, we can use the
 	  <command role="hg-cmd">hg tip</command> command to display
 	  the changeset we just created.  This command produces output
 	  that is identical to <command role="hg-cmd">hg
@@ -665,7 +665,7 @@
 
       &interaction.tour.tip;
 
-      <para>We refer to
+      <para id="x_57">We refer to
 	  the newest revision in the repository as the tip revision,
 	  or simply the tip.</para>
     </sect2>
@@ -674,7 +674,7 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Sharing changes</title>
 
-    <para>We mentioned earlier that repositories in
+    <para id="x_58">We mentioned earlier that repositories in
 	Mercurial are self-contained.  This means that the changeset
 	we just created exists only in our <filename
 	  class="directory">my-hello</filename> repository.  Let's
@@ -683,7 +683,7 @@
 
     <sect2 id="sec:tour:pull">
       <title>Pulling changes from another repository</title>
-      <para>To get started, let's clone our original
+      <para id="x_59">To get started, let's clone our original
 	  <filename class="directory">hello</filename> repository,
 	  which does not contain the change we just committed.  We'll
 	  call our temporary repository <filename
@@ -691,7 +691,7 @@
 
       &interaction.tour.clone-pull;
 
-      <para>We'll use the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+      <para id="x_5a">We'll use the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	    pull</command> command to bring changes from <filename
 	    class="directory">my-hello</filename> into <filename
 	    class="directory">hello-pull</filename>.  However, blindly
@@ -704,21 +704,21 @@
 
       &interaction.tour.incoming;
 
-      <para>(Of course, someone could
+      <para id="x_5b">(Of course, someone could
 	  cause more changesets to appear in the repository that we
 	  ran <command role="hg-cmd">hg incoming</command> in, before
 	  we get a chance to <command role="hg-cmd">hg pull</command>
 	  the changes, so that we could end up pulling changes that we
 	  didn't expect.)</para>
 
-      <para>Bringing changes into a repository is a simple
+      <para id="x_5c">Bringing changes into a repository is a simple
 	  matter of running the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	    pull</command> command, and telling it which repository to
 	  pull from.</para>
 
       &interaction.tour.pull;
 
-      <para>As you can see
+      <para id="x_5d">As you can see
 	  from the before-and-after output of <command
 	    role="hg-cmd">hg tip</command>, we have successfully
 	  pulled changes into our repository.  There remains one step
@@ -728,7 +728,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Updating the working directory</title>
 
-      <para>We have so far glossed over the relationship between a
+      <para id="x_5e">We have so far glossed over the relationship between a
 	repository and its working directory.  The <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg pull</command> command that we ran in
 	section <xref linkend="sec:tour:pull"/> brought changes
@@ -740,7 +740,7 @@
 
       &interaction.tour.update;
 
-      <para>It might seem a bit strange that <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+      <para id="x_5f">It might seem a bit strange that <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	  pull</command> doesn't update the working directory
 	automatically.  There's actually a good reason for this: you
 	can use <command role="hg-cmd">hg update</command> to update
@@ -751,12 +751,12 @@
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg pull</command> which automatically updated
 	the working directory to a new revision, you might not be
 	terribly happy.</para>
-      <para>However, since pull-then-update is such a common thing to
+      <para id="x_60">However, since pull-then-update is such a common thing to
 	do, Mercurial lets you combine the two by passing the <option
 	  role="hg-opt-pull">-u</option> option to <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg pull</command>.</para>
 
-      <para>If you look back at the output of <command
+      <para id="x_61">If you look back at the output of <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg pull</command> in section <xref
 	    linkend="sec:tour:pull"/> when we ran it without <option
 	  role="hg-opt-pull">-u</option>, you can see that it printed
@@ -765,13 +765,13 @@
 
       <!-- &interaction.xxx.fixme; -->
 
-      <para>To find out what revision the working directory is at, use
+      <para id="x_62">To find out what revision the working directory is at, use
 	the <command role="hg-cmd">hg parents</command>
 	command.</para>
 
       &interaction.tour.parents;
 
-      <para>If you look back at figure <xref
+      <para id="x_63">If you look back at figure <xref
 	  linkend="fig:tour-basic:history"/>,
 	you'll see arrows connecting each changeset.  The node that
 	the arrow leads <emphasis>from</emphasis> in each case is a
@@ -780,14 +780,14 @@
 	has a parent in just the same way; this is the changeset that
 	the working directory currently contains.</para>
 
-      <para>To update the working directory to a particular revision,
+      <para id="x_64">To update the working directory to a particular revision,
 
 	give a revision number or changeset ID to the <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg update</command> command.</para>
 
       &interaction.tour.older;
 
-      <para>If you omit an explicit revision, <command
+      <para id="x_65">If you omit an explicit revision, <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg update</command> will update to the tip
 	revision, as shown by the second call to <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg update</command> in the example
@@ -797,7 +797,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Pushing changes to another repository</title>
 
-      <para>Mercurial lets us push changes to another
+      <para id="x_66">Mercurial lets us push changes to another
 	  repository, from the repository we're currently visiting.
 	  As with the example of <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	    pull</command> above, we'll create a temporary repository
@@ -805,19 +805,19 @@
 
       &interaction.tour.clone-push;
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-cmd">hg outgoing</command> command
+      <para id="x_67">The <command role="hg-cmd">hg outgoing</command> command
 	  tells us what changes would be pushed into another
 	  repository.</para>
 
       &interaction.tour.outgoing;
 
-      <para>And the
+      <para id="x_68">And the
 	  <command role="hg-cmd">hg push</command> command does the
 	  actual push.</para>
 
       &interaction.tour.push;
 
-      <para>As with
+      <para id="x_69">As with
 	  <command role="hg-cmd">hg pull</command>, the <command
 	    role="hg-cmd">hg push</command> command does not update
 	  the working directory in the repository that it's pushing
@@ -826,7 +826,7 @@
 	  does not provide a <literal>-u</literal> option that updates
 	  the other repository's working directory.)</para>
 
-      <para>What happens if we try to pull or push changes
+      <para id="x_6a">What happens if we try to pull or push changes
 	  and the receiving repository already has those changes?
 	  Nothing too exciting.</para>
 
@@ -835,7 +835,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Sharing changes over a network</title>
 
-      <para>The commands we have covered in the previous few
+      <para id="x_6b">The commands we have covered in the previous few
 	  sections are not limited to working with local repositories.
 	  Each works in exactly the same fashion over a network
 	  connection; simply pass in a URL instead of a local
@@ -843,7 +843,7 @@
 	
       &interaction.tour.outgoing.net;
 
-      <para>In this example, we
+      <para id="x_6c">In this example, we
 	  can see what changes we could push to the remote repository,
 	  but the repository is understandably not set up to let
 	  anonymous users push to it.</para>
--- a/en/ch02-tour-merge.xml	Thu Mar 19 20:54:12 2009 -0700
+++ b/en/ch02-tour-merge.xml	Thu Mar 19 21:18:52 2009 -0700
@@ -4,7 +4,7 @@
   <?dbhtml filename="a-tour-of-mercurial-merging-work.html"?>
   <title>A tour of Mercurial: merging work</title>
 
-  <para>We've now covered cloning a repository, making changes in a
+  <para id="x_338">We've now covered cloning a repository, making changes in a
     repository, and pulling or pushing changes from one repository
     into another.  Our next step is <emphasis>merging</emphasis>
     changes from separate repositories.</para>
@@ -12,29 +12,29 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Merging streams of work</title>
 
-    <para>Merging is a fundamental part of working with a distributed
+    <para id="x_339">Merging is a fundamental part of working with a distributed
       revision control tool.</para>
     <itemizedlist>
-      <listitem><para>Alice and Bob each have a personal copy of a
+      <listitem><para id="x_33a">Alice and Bob each have a personal copy of a
 	  repository for a project they're collaborating on.  Alice
 	  fixes a bug in her repository; Bob adds a new feature in
 	  his.  They want the shared repository to contain both the
 	  bug fix and the new feature.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>I frequently work on several different tasks for
+      <listitem><para id="x_33b">I frequently work on several different tasks for
 	  a single project at once, each safely isolated in its own
 	  repository. Working this way means that I often need to
 	  merge one piece of my own work with another.</para>
       </listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-    <para>Because merging is such a common thing to need to do,
+    <para id="x_33c">Because merging is such a common thing to need to do,
       Mercurial makes it easy.  Let's walk through the process.  We'll
       begin by cloning yet another repository (see how often they
       spring up?) and making a change in it.</para>
 
     &interaction.tour.merge.clone;
 
-    <para>We should now have two copies of
+    <para id="x_33d">We should now have two copies of
       <filename>hello.c</filename> with different contents.  The
       histories of the two repositories have also diverged, as
       illustrated in figure <xref
@@ -46,26 +46,26 @@
       <mediaobject>
 	<imageobject><imagedata fileref="tour-merge-sep-repos"/></imageobject>
 	<textobject><phrase>XXX add text</phrase></textobject>
-	<caption><para>Divergent recent histories of the <filename
+	<caption><para id="x_33e">Divergent recent histories of the <filename
 	      class="directory">my-hello</filename> and <filename
 	      class="directory">my-new-hello</filename>
 	    repositories</para></caption>
       </mediaobject>
     </informalfigure>
 
-    <para>We already know that pulling changes from our <filename
+    <para id="x_33f">We already know that pulling changes from our <filename
 	class="directory">my-hello</filename> repository will have no
       effect on the working directory.</para>
 
     &interaction.tour.merge.pull;
 
-    <para>However, the <command role="hg-cmd">hg pull</command>
+    <para id="x_340">However, the <command role="hg-cmd">hg pull</command>
       command says something about <quote>heads</quote>.</para>
 
     <sect2>
       <title>Head changesets</title>
 
-      <para>A head is a change that has no descendants, or children,
+      <para id="x_341">A head is a change that has no descendants, or children,
 	as they're also known.  The tip revision is thus a head,
 	because the newest revision in a repository doesn't have any
 	children, but a repository can contain more than one
@@ -75,14 +75,14 @@
 	<mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata
 				    fileref="tour-merge-pull"/></imageobject><textobject><phrase>XXX 
 	      add text</phrase></textobject>
-	  <caption><para>Repository contents after pulling from
+	  <caption><para id="x_342">Repository contents after pulling from
 	      <filename class="directory">my-hello</filename> into
 	      <filename
 		class="directory">my-new-hello</filename></para></caption>
 	</mediaobject>
       </informalfigure>
 
-      <para>In figure <xref linkend="fig:tour-merge:pull"/>, you can
+      <para id="x_343">In figure <xref linkend="fig:tour-merge:pull"/>, you can
 	see the effect of the pull from <filename
 	  class="directory">my-hello</filename> into <filename
 	  class="directory">my-new-hello</filename>.  The history that
@@ -103,13 +103,13 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Performing the merge</title>
 
-      <para>What happens if we try to use the normal <command
+      <para id="x_344">What happens if we try to use the normal <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg update</command> command to update to the
 	new tip?</para>
 
       &interaction.tour.merge.update;
 
-      <para>Mercurial is telling us that the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+      <para id="x_345">Mercurial is telling us that the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	  update</command> command won't do a merge; it won't update
 	the working directory when it thinks we might be wanting to do
 	a merge, unless we force it to do so.  Instead, we use the
@@ -123,12 +123,12 @@
 	<mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata
 				    fileref="tour-merge-merge"/></imageobject><textobject><phrase>XXX 
 	      add text</phrase></textobject>
-	  <caption><para>Working directory and repository during
+	  <caption><para id="x_346">Working directory and repository during
 	      merge, and following commit</para></caption>
 	</mediaobject>
       </informalfigure>
 
-      <para>This updates the working directory so that it contains
+      <para id="x_347">This updates the working directory so that it contains
 	changes from <emphasis>both</emphasis> heads, which is
 	reflected in both the output of <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	  parents</command> and the contents of
@@ -140,21 +140,21 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Committing the results of the merge</title>
 
-      <para>Whenever we've done a merge, <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+      <para id="x_348">Whenever we've done a merge, <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	  parents</command> will display two parents until we <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg commit</command> the results of the
 	  merge.</para>
 
 	&interaction.tour.merge.commit;
 
-      <para>We now have a new tip revision; notice that it has
+      <para id="x_349">We now have a new tip revision; notice that it has
 	<emphasis>both</emphasis> of our former heads as its parents.
 	These are the same revisions that were previously displayed by
 	<command role="hg-cmd">hg parents</command>.</para>
 
       &interaction.tour.merge.tip;
 
-      <para>In figure <xref
+      <para id="x_34a">In figure <xref
 	  linkend="fig:tour-merge:merge"/>, you can see a
 	representation of what happens to the working directory during
 	the merge, and how this affects the repository when the commit
@@ -167,7 +167,7 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Merging conflicting changes</title>
 
-    <para>Most merges are simple affairs, but sometimes you'll find
+    <para id="x_34b">Most merges are simple affairs, but sometimes you'll find
       yourself merging changes where each modifies the same portions
       of the same files.  Unless both modifications are identical,
       this results in a <emphasis>conflict</emphasis>, where you have
@@ -179,18 +179,18 @@
       <mediaobject id="fig:tour-merge:conflict">
 	<imageobject><imagedata fileref="tour-merge-conflict"/></imageobject>
 	<textobject><phrase>XXX add text</phrase></textobject>
-	<caption><para>Conflicting changes to a
+	<caption><para id="x_34c">Conflicting changes to a
 	    document</para></caption>      </mediaobject>
     </informalfigure>
 
-    <para>Figure <xref linkend="fig:tour-merge:conflict"/> illustrates
+    <para id="x_34d">Figure <xref linkend="fig:tour-merge:conflict"/> illustrates
       an instance of two conflicting changes to a document.  We
       started with a single version of the file; then we made some
       changes; while someone else made different changes to the same
       text.  Our task in resolving the conflicting changes is to
       decide what the file should look like.</para>
 
-    <para>Mercurial doesn't have a built-in facility for handling
+    <para id="x_34e">Mercurial doesn't have a built-in facility for handling
       conflicts. Instead, it runs an external program called
       <command>hgmerge</command>.  This is a shell script that is
       bundled with Mercurial; you can change it to behave however you
@@ -201,7 +201,7 @@
       human guidance) or aren't present, the script tries a few
       different graphical merging tools.</para>
 
-    <para>It's also possible to get Mercurial to run another program
+    <para id="x_34f">It's also possible to get Mercurial to run another program
       or script instead of <command>hgmerge</command>, by setting the
       <envar>HGMERGE</envar> environment variable to the name of your
       preferred program.</para>
@@ -209,7 +209,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Using a graphical merge tool</title>
 
-      <para>My preferred graphical merge tool is
+      <para id="x_350">My preferred graphical merge tool is
 	<command>kdiff3</command>, which I'll use to describe the
 	features that are common to graphical file merging tools.  You
 	can see a screenshot of <command>kdiff3</command> in action in
@@ -219,26 +219,26 @@
 	of the file of interest to us.  The tool thus splits the upper
 	portion of the window into three panes:</para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para>At the left is the <emphasis>base</emphasis>
+	<listitem><para id="x_351">At the left is the <emphasis>base</emphasis>
 	    version of the file, i.e. the most recent version from
 	    which the two versions we're trying to merge are
 	    descended.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>In the middle is <quote>our</quote> version of
+	<listitem><para id="x_352">In the middle is <quote>our</quote> version of
 	    the file, with the contents that we modified.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>On the right is <quote>their</quote> version
+	<listitem><para id="x_353">On the right is <quote>their</quote> version
 	    of the file, the one that from the changeset that we're
 	    trying to merge with.</para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
-      <para>In the pane below these is the current
+      <para id="x_354">In the pane below these is the current
 	<emphasis>result</emphasis> of the merge. Our task is to
 	replace all of the red text, which indicates unresolved
 	conflicts, with some sensible merger of the
 	<quote>ours</quote> and <quote>theirs</quote> versions of the
 	file.</para>
 
-      <para>All four of these panes are <emphasis>locked
+      <para id="x_355">All four of these panes are <emphasis>locked
 	  together</emphasis>; if we scroll vertically or horizontally
 	in any of them, the others are updated to display the
 	corresponding sections of their respective files.</para>
@@ -247,18 +247,18 @@
 	<mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata
 				    fileref="kdiff3"/></imageobject><textobject><phrase>XXX 
 	      add text</phrase></textobject>
-	  <caption><para>Using <command>kdiff3</command> to merge
+	  <caption><para id="x_356">Using <command>kdiff3</command> to merge
 	      versions of a file</para></caption>
 	</mediaobject>
       </informalfigure>
 
-      <para>For each conflicting portion of the file, we can choose to
+      <para id="x_357">For each conflicting portion of the file, we can choose to
 	resolve the conflict using some combination of text from the
 	base version, ours, or theirs.  We can also manually edit the
 	merged file at any time, in case we need to make further
 	modifications.</para>
 
-      <para>There are <emphasis>many</emphasis> file merging tools
+      <para id="x_358">There are <emphasis>many</emphasis> file merging tools
 	available, too many to cover here.  They vary in which
 	platforms they are available for, and in their particular
 	strengths and weaknesses.  Most are tuned for merging files
@@ -269,19 +269,19 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>A worked example</title>
 
-      <para>In this example, we will reproduce the file modification
+      <para id="x_359">In this example, we will reproduce the file modification
 	history of figure <xref linkend="fig:tour-merge:conflict"/>
 	above.  Let's begin by creating a repository with a base
 	version of our document.</para>
 
       &interaction.tour-merge-conflict.wife;
 
-      <para>We'll clone the repository and make a change to the
+      <para id="x_35a">We'll clone the repository and make a change to the
 	file.</para>
 
       &interaction.tour-merge-conflict.cousin;
 
-      <para>And another clone, to simulate someone else making a
+      <para id="x_35b">And another clone, to simulate someone else making a
 	change to the file. (This hints at the idea that it's not all
 	that unusual to merge with yourself when you isolate tasks in
 	separate repositories, and indeed to find and resolve
@@ -289,13 +289,13 @@
 
       &interaction.tour-merge-conflict.son;
 
-      <para>Having created two
+      <para id="x_35c">Having created two
 	different versions of the file, we'll set up an environment
 	suitable for running our merge.</para>
 
       &interaction.tour-merge-conflict.pull;
 
-      <para>In this example, I won't use Mercurial's normal
+      <para id="x_35d">In this example, I won't use Mercurial's normal
 	<command>hgmerge</command> program to do the merge, because it
 	would drop my nice automated example-running tool into a
 	graphical user interface.  Instead, I'll set
@@ -305,25 +305,25 @@
 	example on your computer, don't bother setting
 	<envar>HGMERGE</envar>.</para>
 
-      <para><emphasis role="bold">XXX FIX THIS
+      <para id="x_35e"><emphasis role="bold">XXX FIX THIS
 	  EXAMPLE.</emphasis></para>
 
       &interaction.tour-merge-conflict.merge;
 
-      <para>Because <command>merge</command> can't resolve the
+      <para id="x_35f">Because <command>merge</command> can't resolve the
 	conflicting changes, it leaves <emphasis>merge
 	  markers</emphasis> inside the file that has conflicts,
 	indicating which lines have conflicts, and whether they came
 	from our version of the file or theirs.</para>
 
-      <para>Mercurial can tell from the way <command>merge</command>
+      <para id="x_360">Mercurial can tell from the way <command>merge</command>
 	exits that it wasn't able to merge successfully, so it tells
 	us what commands we'll need to run if we want to redo the
 	merging operation.  This could be useful if, for example, we
 	were running a graphical merge tool and quit because we were
 	confused or realised we had made a mistake.</para>
 
-      <para>If automatic or manual merges fail, there's nothing to
+      <para id="x_361">If automatic or manual merges fail, there's nothing to
 	prevent us from <quote>fixing up</quote> the affected files
 	ourselves, and committing the results of our merge:</para>
 
@@ -334,29 +334,29 @@
   <sect1 id="sec:tour-merge:fetch">
     <title>Simplifying the pull-merge-commit sequence</title>
 
-    <para>The process of merging changes as outlined above is
+    <para id="x_362">The process of merging changes as outlined above is
       straightforward, but requires running three commands in
       sequence.</para>
     <programlisting>hg pull
 hg merge
 hg commit -m 'Merged remote changes'</programlisting>
-    <para>In the case of the final commit, you also need to enter a
+    <para id="x_363">In the case of the final commit, you also need to enter a
       commit message, which is almost always going to be a piece of
       uninteresting <quote>boilerplate</quote> text.</para>
 
-    <para>It would be nice to reduce the number of steps needed, if
+    <para id="x_364">It would be nice to reduce the number of steps needed, if
       this were possible.  Indeed, Mercurial is distributed with an
       extension called <literal role="hg-ext">fetch</literal> that
       does just this.</para>
 
-    <para>Mercurial provides a flexible extension mechanism that lets
+    <para id="x_365">Mercurial provides a flexible extension mechanism that lets
       people extend its functionality, while keeping the core of
       Mercurial small and easy to deal with.  Some extensions add new
       commands that you can use from the command line, while others
       work <quote>behind the scenes,</quote> for example adding
       capabilities to the server.</para>
 
-    <para>The <literal role="hg-ext">fetch</literal> extension adds a
+    <para id="x_366">The <literal role="hg-ext">fetch</literal> extension adds a
       new command called, not surprisingly, <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	fetch</command>.  This extension acts as a combination of
       <command role="hg-cmd">hg pull</command>, <command
@@ -369,7 +369,7 @@
       added, it updates the working directory to the new tip
       changeset.</para>
 
-    <para>Enabling the <literal role="hg-ext">fetch</literal>
+    <para id="x_367">Enabling the <literal role="hg-ext">fetch</literal>
       extension is easy.  Edit your <filename
 	role="special">.hgrc</filename>, and either go to the <literal
 	role="rc-extensions">extensions</literal> section or create an
@@ -378,7 +378,7 @@
 	</literal></quote>.</para>
     <programlisting>[extensions]
 fetch =</programlisting>
-    <para>(Normally, on the right-hand side of the
+    <para id="x_368">(Normally, on the right-hand side of the
       <quote><literal>=</literal></quote> would appear the location of
       the extension, but since the <literal
 	role="hg-ext">fetch</literal> extension is in the standard
--- a/en/ch03-concepts.xml	Thu Mar 19 20:54:12 2009 -0700
+++ b/en/ch03-concepts.xml	Thu Mar 19 21:18:52 2009 -0700
@@ -4,20 +4,20 @@
   <?dbhtml filename="behind-the-scenes.html"?>
   <title>Behind the scenes</title>
 
-  <para>Unlike many revision control systems, the concepts upon which
+  <para id="x_2e8">Unlike many revision control systems, the concepts upon which
     Mercurial is built are simple enough that it's easy to understand
     how the software really works.  Knowing this certainly isn't
     necessary, but I find it useful to have a <quote>mental
       model</quote> of what's going on.</para>
 
-  <para>This understanding gives me confidence that Mercurial has been
+  <para id="x_2e9">This understanding gives me confidence that Mercurial has been
     carefully designed to be both <emphasis>safe</emphasis> and
     <emphasis>efficient</emphasis>.  And just as importantly, if it's
     easy for me to retain a good idea of what the software is doing
     when I perform a revision control task, I'm less likely to be
     surprised by its behaviour.</para>
 
-  <para>In this chapter, we'll initially cover the core concepts
+  <para id="x_2ea">In this chapter, we'll initially cover the core concepts
     behind Mercurial's design, then continue to discuss some of the
     interesting details of its implementation.</para>
 
@@ -27,7 +27,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Tracking the history of a single file</title>
 
-      <para>When Mercurial tracks modifications to a file, it stores
+      <para id="x_2eb">When Mercurial tracks modifications to a file, it stores
 	the history of that file in a metadata object called a
 	<emphasis>filelog</emphasis>.  Each entry in the filelog
 	contains enough information to reconstruct one revision of the
@@ -38,7 +38,7 @@
 	an index to help Mercurial to find a revision
 	efficiently.</para>
 
-      <para>A file that is large, or has a lot of history, has its
+      <para id="x_2ec">A file that is large, or has a lot of history, has its
 	filelog stored in separate data
 	(<quote><literal>.d</literal></quote> suffix) and index
 	(<quote><literal>.i</literal></quote> suffix) files.  For
@@ -53,7 +53,7 @@
 	<mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata
 				    fileref="filelog"/></imageobject><textobject><phrase>XXX 
 	      add text</phrase></textobject>
-	  <caption><para>Relationships between files in working
+	  <caption><para id="x_2ed">Relationships between files in working
 	      directory and filelogs in
 	      repository</para></caption></mediaobject>
       </informalfigure>
@@ -62,7 +62,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Managing tracked files</title>
 
-      <para>Mercurial uses a structure called a
+      <para id="x_2ee">Mercurial uses a structure called a
 	<emphasis>manifest</emphasis> to collect together information
 	about the files that it tracks.  Each entry in the manifest
 	contains information about the files present in a single
@@ -74,7 +74,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Recording changeset information</title>
 
-      <para>The <emphasis>changelog</emphasis> contains information
+      <para id="x_2ef">The <emphasis>changelog</emphasis> contains information
 	about each changeset.  Each revision records who committed a
 	change, the changeset comment, other pieces of
 	changeset-related information, and the revision of the
@@ -84,14 +84,14 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Relationships between revisions</title>
 
-      <para>Within a changelog, a manifest, or a filelog, each
+      <para id="x_2f0">Within a changelog, a manifest, or a filelog, each
 	revision stores a pointer to its immediate parent (or to its
 	two parents, if it's a merge revision).  As I mentioned above,
 	there are also relationships between revisions
 	<emphasis>across</emphasis> these structures, and they are
 	hierarchical in nature.</para>
 
-      <para>For every changeset in a repository, there is exactly one
+      <para id="x_2f1">For every changeset in a repository, there is exactly one
 	revision stored in the changelog.  Each revision of the
 	changelog contains a pointer to a single revision of the
 	manifest.  A revision of the manifest stores a pointer to a
@@ -102,12 +102,12 @@
       <informalfigure id="fig:concepts:metadata">
 	<mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata
 				    fileref="metadata"/></imageobject><textobject><phrase>XXX 
-	      add text</phrase></textobject><caption><para>Metadata
+	      add text</phrase></textobject><caption><para id="x_2f2">Metadata
 	      relationships</para></caption>
 	</mediaobject>
       </informalfigure>
 
-      <para>As the illustration shows, there is
+      <para id="x_2f3">As the illustration shows, there is
 	<emphasis>not</emphasis> a <quote>one to one</quote>
 	relationship between revisions in the changelog, manifest, or
 	filelog. If the manifest hasn't changed between two
@@ -122,14 +122,14 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Safe, efficient storage</title>
 
-    <para>The underpinnings of changelogs, manifests, and filelogs are
+    <para id="x_2f4">The underpinnings of changelogs, manifests, and filelogs are
       provided by a single structure called the
       <emphasis>revlog</emphasis>.</para>
 
     <sect2>
       <title>Efficient storage</title>
 
-      <para>The revlog provides efficient storage of revisions using a
+      <para id="x_2f5">The revlog provides efficient storage of revisions using a
 	<emphasis>delta</emphasis> mechanism.  Instead of storing a
 	complete copy of a file for each revision, it stores the
 	changes needed to transform an older revision into the new
@@ -137,7 +137,7 @@
 	typically a fraction of a percent of the size of a full copy
 	of a file.</para>
 
-      <para>Some obsolete revision control systems can only work with
+      <para id="x_2f6">Some obsolete revision control systems can only work with
 	deltas of text files.  They must either store binary files as
 	complete snapshots or encoded into a text representation, both
 	of which are wasteful approaches.  Mercurial can efficiently
@@ -148,13 +148,13 @@
     <sect2 id="sec:concepts:txn">
       <title>Safe operation</title>
 
-      <para>Mercurial only ever <emphasis>appends</emphasis> data to
+      <para id="x_2f7">Mercurial only ever <emphasis>appends</emphasis> data to
 	the end of a revlog file. It never modifies a section of a
 	file after it has written it.  This is both more robust and
 	efficient than schemes that need to modify or rewrite
 	data.</para>
 
-      <para>In addition, Mercurial treats every write as part of a
+      <para id="x_2f8">In addition, Mercurial treats every write as part of a
 	<emphasis>transaction</emphasis> that can span a number of
 	files.  A transaction is <emphasis>atomic</emphasis>: either
 	the entire transaction succeeds and its effects are all
@@ -164,7 +164,7 @@
 	writing it, the reader will never see a partially written
 	result that might confuse it.</para>
 
-      <para>The fact that Mercurial only appends to files makes it
+      <para id="x_2f9">The fact that Mercurial only appends to files makes it
 	easier to provide this transactional guarantee.  The easier it
 	is to do stuff like this, the more confident you should be
 	that it's done correctly.</para>
@@ -173,7 +173,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Fast retrieval</title>
 
-      <para>Mercurial cleverly avoids a pitfall common to all earlier
+      <para id="x_2fa">Mercurial cleverly avoids a pitfall common to all earlier
 	revision control systems: the problem of <emphasis>inefficient
 	  retrieval</emphasis>. Most revision control systems store
 	the contents of a revision as an incremental series of
@@ -187,12 +187,12 @@
       <informalfigure id="fig:concepts:snapshot">
 	<mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata
 				    fileref="snapshot"/></imageobject><textobject><phrase>XXX 
-	      add text</phrase></textobject><caption><para>Snapshot of
+	      add text</phrase></textobject><caption><para id="x_2fb">Snapshot of
 	      a revlog, with incremental
 	      deltas</para></caption></mediaobject>
       </informalfigure>
 
-      <para>The innovation that Mercurial applies to this problem is
+      <para id="x_2fc">The innovation that Mercurial applies to this problem is
 	simple but effective.  Once the cumulative amount of delta
 	information stored since the last snapshot exceeds a fixed
 	threshold, it stores a new snapshot (compressed, of course),
@@ -201,7 +201,7 @@
 	quickly.  This approach works so well that it has since been
 	copied by several other revision control systems.</para>
 
-      <para>Figure <xref linkend="fig:concepts:snapshot"/> illustrates
+      <para id="x_2fd">Figure <xref linkend="fig:concepts:snapshot"/> illustrates
 	the idea.  In an entry in a revlog's index file, Mercurial
 	stores the range of entries from the data file that it must
 	read to reconstruct a particular revision.</para>
@@ -209,7 +209,7 @@
       <sect3>
 	<title>Aside: the influence of video compression</title>
 
-	<para>If you're familiar with video compression or have ever
+	<para id="x_2fe">If you're familiar with video compression or have ever
 	  watched a TV feed through a digital cable or satellite
 	  service, you may know that most video compression schemes
 	  store each frame of video as a delta against its predecessor
@@ -218,7 +218,7 @@
 	  visual errors accumulate over the course of a number of
 	  inter-frame deltas.</para>
 
-	<para>Because it's possible for a video stream to <quote>drop
+	<para id="x_2ff">Because it's possible for a video stream to <quote>drop
 	    out</quote> occasionally due to signal glitches, and to
 	  limit the accumulation of artefacts introduced by the lossy
 	  compression process, video encoders periodically insert a
@@ -234,24 +234,24 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Identification and strong integrity</title>
 
-      <para>Along with delta or snapshot information, a revlog entry
+      <para id="x_300">Along with delta or snapshot information, a revlog entry
 	contains a cryptographic hash of the data that it represents.
 	This makes it difficult to forge the contents of a revision,
 	and easy to detect accidental corruption.</para>
 
-      <para>Hashes provide more than a mere check against corruption;
+      <para id="x_301">Hashes provide more than a mere check against corruption;
 	they are used as the identifiers for revisions.  The changeset
 	identification hashes that you see as an end user are from
 	revisions of the changelog.  Although filelogs and the
 	manifest also use hashes, Mercurial only uses these behind the
 	scenes.</para>
 
-      <para>Mercurial verifies that hashes are correct when it
+      <para id="x_302">Mercurial verifies that hashes are correct when it
 	retrieves file revisions and when it pulls changes from
 	another repository.  If it encounters an integrity problem, it
 	will complain and stop whatever it's doing.</para>
 
-      <para>In addition to the effect it has on retrieval efficiency,
+      <para id="x_303">In addition to the effect it has on retrieval efficiency,
 	Mercurial's use of periodic snapshots makes it more robust
 	against partial data corruption.  If a revlog becomes partly
 	corrupted due to a hardware error or system bug, it's often
@@ -265,7 +265,7 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Revision history, branching, and merging</title>
 
-    <para>Every entry in a Mercurial revlog knows the identity of its
+    <para id="x_304">Every entry in a Mercurial revlog knows the identity of its
       immediate ancestor revision, usually referred to as its
       <emphasis>parent</emphasis>.  In fact, a revision contains room
       for not one parent, but two.  Mercurial uses a special hash,
@@ -273,13 +273,13 @@
       <quote>there is no parent here</quote>.  This hash is simply a
       string of zeroes.</para>
 
-    <para>In figure <xref linkend="fig:concepts:revlog"/>, you can see
+    <para id="x_305">In figure <xref linkend="fig:concepts:revlog"/>, you can see
       an example of the conceptual structure of a revlog.  Filelogs,
       manifests, and changelogs all have this same structure; they
       differ only in the kind of data stored in each delta or
       snapshot.</para>
 
-    <para>The first revision in a revlog (at the bottom of the image)
+    <para id="x_306">The first revision in a revlog (at the bottom of the image)
       has the null ID in both of its parent slots.  For a
       <quote>normal</quote> revision, its first parent slot contains
       the ID of its parent revision, and its second contains the null
@@ -298,10 +298,10 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>The working directory</title>
 
-    <para>In the working directory, Mercurial stores a snapshot of the
+    <para id="x_307">In the working directory, Mercurial stores a snapshot of the
       files from the repository as of a particular changeset.</para>
 
-    <para>The working directory <quote>knows</quote> which changeset
+    <para id="x_308">The working directory <quote>knows</quote> which changeset
       it contains.  When you update the working directory to contain a
       particular changeset, Mercurial looks up the appropriate
       revision of the manifest to find out which files it was tracking
@@ -310,13 +310,13 @@
       those files, with the same contents it had when the changeset
       was committed.</para>
 
-    <para>The <emphasis>dirstate</emphasis> contains Mercurial's
+    <para id="x_309">The <emphasis>dirstate</emphasis> contains Mercurial's
       knowledge of the working directory.  This details which
       changeset the working directory is updated to, and all of the
       files that Mercurial is tracking in the working
       directory.</para>
 
-    <para>Just as a revision of a revlog has room for two parents, so
+    <para id="x_30a">Just as a revision of a revlog has room for two parents, so
       that it can represent either a normal revision (with one parent)
       or a merge of two earlier revisions, the dirstate has slots for
       two parents.  When you use the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
@@ -332,7 +332,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>What happens when you commit</title>
 
-      <para>The dirstate stores parent information for more than just
+      <para id="x_30b">The dirstate stores parent information for more than just
 	book-keeping purposes.  Mercurial uses the parents of the
 	dirstate as <emphasis>the parents of a new
 	  changeset</emphasis> when you perform a commit.</para>
@@ -340,12 +340,12 @@
       <informalfigure id="fig:concepts:wdir">
 	<mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata
 				    fileref="wdir"/></imageobject><textobject><phrase>XXX 
-	      add text</phrase></textobject><caption><para>The working
+	      add text</phrase></textobject><caption><para id="x_30c">The working
 	      directory can have two
 	      parents</para></caption></mediaobject>
       </informalfigure>
 
-      <para>Figure <xref linkend="fig:concepts:wdir"/> shows the
+      <para id="x_30d">Figure <xref linkend="fig:concepts:wdir"/> shows the
 	normal state of the working directory, where it has a single
 	changeset as parent.  That changeset is the
 	<emphasis>tip</emphasis>, the newest changeset in the
@@ -354,12 +354,12 @@
       <informalfigure id="fig:concepts:wdir-after-commit">
 	<mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata
 				    fileref="wdir-after-commit"/></imageobject><textobject><phrase>XXX 
-	      add text</phrase></textobject><caption><para>The working
+	      add text</phrase></textobject><caption><para id="x_30e">The working
 	      directory gains new parents after a
 	      commit</para></caption></mediaobject>
       </informalfigure>
 
-      <para>It's useful to think of the working directory as
+      <para id="x_30f">It's useful to think of the working directory as
 	<quote>the changeset I'm about to commit</quote>.  Any files
 	that you tell Mercurial that you've added, removed, renamed,
 	or copied will be reflected in that changeset, as will
@@ -367,7 +367,7 @@
 	the new changeset will have the parents of the working
 	directory as its parents.</para>
 
-      <para>After a commit, Mercurial will update the parents of the
+      <para id="x_310">After a commit, Mercurial will update the parents of the
 	working directory, so that the first parent is the ID of the
 	new changeset, and the second is the null ID.  This is shown
 	in figure <xref linkend="fig:concepts:wdir-after-commit"/>.
@@ -380,7 +380,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Creating a new head</title>
 
-      <para>It's perfectly normal to update the working directory to a
+      <para id="x_311">It's perfectly normal to update the working directory to a
 	changeset other than the current tip.  For example, you might
 	want to know what your project looked like last Tuesday, or
 	you could be looking through changesets to see which one
@@ -394,12 +394,12 @@
       <informalfigure id="fig:concepts:wdir-pre-branch">
 	<mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata
 				    fileref="wdir-pre-branch"/></imageobject><textobject><phrase>XXX 
-	      add text</phrase></textobject><caption><para>The working
+	      add text</phrase></textobject><caption><para id="x_312">The working
 	      directory, updated to an older
 	      changeset</para></caption></mediaobject>
       </informalfigure>
 
-      <para>Having updated the working directory to an older
+      <para id="x_313">Having updated the working directory to an older
 	changeset, what happens if you make some changes, and then
 	commit?  Mercurial behaves in the same way as I outlined
 	above.  The parents of the working directory become the
@@ -413,13 +413,13 @@
       <informalfigure id="fig:concepts:wdir-branch">
 	<mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata
 				    fileref="wdir-branch"/></imageobject><textobject><phrase>XXX 
-	      add text</phrase></textobject><caption><para>After a
+	      add text</phrase></textobject><caption><para id="x_314">After a
 	      commit made while synced to an older
 	      changeset</para></caption></mediaobject>
       </informalfigure>
 
       <note>
-	<para>  If you're new to Mercurial, you should keep in mind a
+	<para id="x_315">  If you're new to Mercurial, you should keep in mind a
 	  common <quote>error</quote>, which is to use the <command
 	    role="hg-cmd">hg pull</command> command without any
 	  options.  By default, the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
@@ -431,7 +431,7 @@
 	  a new head, because your working directory isn't synced to
 	  whatever the current tip is.</para>
 
-	<para>  I put the word <quote>error</quote> in quotes because
+	<para id="x_316">  I put the word <quote>error</quote> in quotes because
 	  all that you need to do to rectify this situation is
 	  <command role="hg-cmd">hg merge</command>, then <command
 	    role="hg-cmd">hg commit</command>.  In other words, this
@@ -445,7 +445,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Merging heads</title>
 
-      <para>When you run the <command role="hg-cmd">hg merge</command>
+      <para id="x_317">When you run the <command role="hg-cmd">hg merge</command>
 	command, Mercurial leaves the first parent of the working
 	directory unchanged, and sets the second parent to the
 	changeset you're merging with, as shown in figure <xref
@@ -454,54 +454,54 @@
       <informalfigure id="fig:concepts:wdir-merge">
 	<mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata
 				    fileref="wdir-merge"/></imageobject><textobject><phrase>XXX 
-	      add text</phrase></textobject><caption><para>Merging two
+	      add text</phrase></textobject><caption><para id="x_318">Merging two
 	      heads</para></caption></mediaobject>
       </informalfigure>
 
-      <para>Mercurial also has to modify the working directory, to
+      <para id="x_319">Mercurial also has to modify the working directory, to
 	merge the files managed in the two changesets.  Simplified a
 	little, the merging process goes like this, for every file in
 	the manifests of both changesets.</para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para>If neither changeset has modified a file, do
+	<listitem><para id="x_31a">If neither changeset has modified a file, do
 	    nothing with that file.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>If one changeset has modified a file, and the
+	<listitem><para id="x_31b">If one changeset has modified a file, and the
 	    other hasn't, create the modified copy of the file in the
 	    working directory.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>If one changeset has removed a file, and the
+	<listitem><para id="x_31c">If one changeset has removed a file, and the
 	    other hasn't (or has also deleted it), delete the file
 	    from the working directory.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>If one changeset has removed a file, but the
+	<listitem><para id="x_31d">If one changeset has removed a file, but the
 	    other has modified the file, ask the user what to do: keep
 	    the modified file, or remove it?</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>If both changesets have modified a file,
+	<listitem><para id="x_31e">If both changesets have modified a file,
 	    invoke an external merge program to choose the new
 	    contents for the merged file.  This may require input from
 	    the user.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>If one changeset has modified a file, and the
+	<listitem><para id="x_31f">If one changeset has modified a file, and the
 	    other has renamed or copied the file, make sure that the
 	    changes follow the new name of the file.</para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
-      <para>There are more details&emdash;merging has plenty of corner
+      <para id="x_320">There are more details&emdash;merging has plenty of corner
 	cases&emdash;but these are the most common choices that are
 	involved in a merge.  As you can see, most cases are
 	completely automatic, and indeed most merges finish
 	automatically, without requiring your input to resolve any
 	conflicts.</para>
 
-      <para>When you're thinking about what happens when you commit
+      <para id="x_321">When you're thinking about what happens when you commit
 	after a merge, once again the working directory is <quote>the
 	  changeset I'm about to commit</quote>.  After the <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg merge</command> command completes, the
 	working directory has two parents; these will become the
 	parents of the new changeset.</para>
 
-      <para>Mercurial lets you perform multiple merges, but you must
+      <para id="x_322">Mercurial lets you perform multiple merges, but you must
 	commit the results of each individual merge as you go.  This
 	is necessary because Mercurial only tracks two parents for
 	both revisions and the working directory.  While it would be
@@ -514,7 +514,7 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Other interesting design features</title>
 
-    <para>In the sections above, I've tried to highlight some of the
+    <para id="x_323">In the sections above, I've tried to highlight some of the
       most important aspects of Mercurial's design, to illustrate that
       it pays careful attention to reliability and performance.
       However, the attention to detail doesn't stop there.  There are
@@ -527,13 +527,13 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Clever compression</title>
 
-      <para>When appropriate, Mercurial will store both snapshots and
+      <para id="x_324">When appropriate, Mercurial will store both snapshots and
 	deltas in compressed form.  It does this by always
 	<emphasis>trying to</emphasis> compress a snapshot or delta,
 	but only storing the compressed version if it's smaller than
 	the uncompressed version.</para>
 
-      <para>This means that Mercurial does <quote>the right
+      <para id="x_325">This means that Mercurial does <quote>the right
 	  thing</quote> when storing a file whose native form is
 	compressed, such as a <literal>zip</literal> archive or a JPEG
 	image.  When these types of files are compressed a second
@@ -541,7 +541,7 @@
 	once-compressed form, and so Mercurial will store the plain
 	<literal>zip</literal> or JPEG.</para>
 
-      <para>Deltas between revisions of a compressed file are usually
+      <para id="x_326">Deltas between revisions of a compressed file are usually
 	larger than snapshots of the file, and Mercurial again does
 	<quote>the right thing</quote> in these cases.  It finds that
 	such a delta exceeds the threshold at which it should store a
@@ -552,7 +552,7 @@
       <sect3>
 	<title>Network recompression</title>
 
-	<para>When storing revisions on disk, Mercurial uses the
+	<para id="x_327">When storing revisions on disk, Mercurial uses the
 	  <quote>deflate</quote> compression algorithm (the same one
 	  used by the popular <literal>zip</literal> archive format),
 	  which balances good speed with a respectable compression
@@ -560,7 +560,7 @@
 	  network connection, Mercurial uncompresses the compressed
 	  revision data.</para>
 
-	<para>If the connection is over HTTP, Mercurial recompresses
+	<para id="x_328">If the connection is over HTTP, Mercurial recompresses
 	  the entire stream of data using a compression algorithm that
 	  gives a better compression ratio (the Burrows-Wheeler
 	  algorithm from the widely used <literal>bzip2</literal>
@@ -570,7 +570,7 @@
 	  transferred, yielding better network performance over almost
 	  all kinds of network.</para>
 
-	<para>(If the connection is over <command>ssh</command>,
+	<para id="x_329">(If the connection is over <command>ssh</command>,
 	  Mercurial <emphasis>doesn't</emphasis> recompress the
 	  stream, because <command>ssh</command> can already do this
 	  itself.)</para>
@@ -580,7 +580,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Read/write ordering and atomicity</title>
 
-      <para>Appending to files isn't the whole story when it comes to
+      <para id="x_32a">Appending to files isn't the whole story when it comes to
 	guaranteeing that a reader won't see a partial write.  If you
 	recall figure <xref linkend="fig:concepts:metadata"/>,
 	revisions in the
@@ -588,12 +588,12 @@
 	the manifest point to revisions in filelogs.  This hierarchy
 	is deliberate.</para>
 
-      <para>A writer starts a transaction by writing filelog and
+      <para id="x_32b">A writer starts a transaction by writing filelog and
 	manifest data, and doesn't write any changelog data until
 	those are finished.  A reader starts by reading changelog
 	data, then manifest data, followed by filelog data.</para>
 
-      <para>Since the writer has always finished writing filelog and
+      <para id="x_32c">Since the writer has always finished writing filelog and
 	manifest data before it writes to the changelog, a reader will
 	never read a pointer to a partially written manifest revision
 	from the changelog, and it will never read a pointer to a
@@ -603,7 +603,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Concurrent access</title>
 
-      <para>The read/write ordering and atomicity guarantees mean that
+      <para id="x_32d">The read/write ordering and atomicity guarantees mean that
 	Mercurial never needs to <emphasis>lock</emphasis> a
 	repository when it's reading data, even if the repository is
 	being written to while the read is occurring. This has a big
@@ -612,7 +612,7 @@
 	safely all at once, no matter whether it's being written to or
 	not.</para>
 
-      <para>The lockless nature of reading means that if you're
+      <para id="x_32e">The lockless nature of reading means that if you're
 	sharing a repository on a multi-user system, you don't need to
 	grant other local users permission to
 	<emphasis>write</emphasis> to your repository in order for
@@ -625,7 +625,7 @@
 	which of course makes for all kinds of nasty and annoying
 	security and administrative problems.)</para>
 
-      <para>Mercurial uses locks to ensure that only one process can
+      <para id="x_32f">Mercurial uses locks to ensure that only one process can
 	write to a repository at a time (the locking mechanism is safe
 	even over filesystems that are notoriously hostile to locking,
 	such as NFS).  If a repository is locked, a writer will wait
@@ -639,7 +639,7 @@
       <sect3>
 	<title>Safe dirstate access</title>
 
-	<para>As with revision data, Mercurial doesn't take a lock to
+	<para id="x_330">As with revision data, Mercurial doesn't take a lock to
 	  read the dirstate file; it does acquire a lock to write it.
 	  To avoid the possibility of reading a partially written copy
 	  of the dirstate file, Mercurial writes to a file with a
@@ -654,17 +654,17 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Avoiding seeks</title>
 
-      <para>Critical to Mercurial's performance is the avoidance of
+      <para id="x_331">Critical to Mercurial's performance is the avoidance of
 	seeks of the disk head, since any seek is far more expensive
 	than even a comparatively large read operation.</para>
 
-      <para>This is why, for example, the dirstate is stored in a
+      <para id="x_332">This is why, for example, the dirstate is stored in a
 	single file.  If there were a dirstate file per directory that
 	Mercurial tracked, the disk would seek once per directory.
 	Instead, Mercurial reads the entire single dirstate file in
 	one step.</para>
 
-      <para>Mercurial also uses a <quote>copy on write</quote> scheme
+      <para id="x_333">Mercurial also uses a <quote>copy on write</quote> scheme
 	when cloning a repository on local storage.  Instead of
 	copying every revlog file from the old repository into the new
 	repository, it makes a <quote>hard link</quote>, which is a
@@ -675,7 +675,7 @@
 	one repository is using the file, so Mercurial makes a new
 	copy of the file that is private to this repository.</para>
 
-      <para>A few revision control developers have pointed out that
+      <para id="x_334">A few revision control developers have pointed out that
 	this idea of making a complete private copy of a file is not
 	very efficient in its use of storage.  While this is true,
 	storage is cheap, and this method gives the highest
@@ -689,21 +689,21 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Other contents of the dirstate</title>
 
-      <para>Because Mercurial doesn't force you to tell it when you're
+      <para id="x_335">Because Mercurial doesn't force you to tell it when you're
 	modifying a file, it uses the dirstate to store some extra
 	information so it can determine efficiently whether you have
 	modified a file.  For each file in the working directory, it
 	stores the time that it last modified the file itself, and the
 	size of the file at that time.</para>
 
-      <para>When you explicitly <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+      <para id="x_336">When you explicitly <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	  add</command>, <command role="hg-cmd">hg remove</command>,
 	<command role="hg-cmd">hg rename</command> or <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg copy</command> files, Mercurial updates the
 	dirstate so that it knows what to do with those files when you
 	commit.</para>
 
-      <para>When Mercurial is checking the states of files in the
+      <para id="x_337">When Mercurial is checking the states of files in the
 	working directory, it first checks a file's modification time.
 	If that has not changed, the file must not have been modified.
 	If the file's size has changed, the file must have been
--- a/en/ch04-daily.xml	Thu Mar 19 20:54:12 2009 -0700
+++ b/en/ch04-daily.xml	Thu Mar 19 21:18:52 2009 -0700
@@ -7,14 +7,14 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Telling Mercurial which files to track</title>
 
-    <para>Mercurial does not work with files in your repository unless
+    <para id="x_1a3">Mercurial does not work with files in your repository unless
       you tell it to manage them.  The <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	status</command> command will tell you which files Mercurial
       doesn't know about; it uses a
       <quote><literal>?</literal></quote> to display such
       files.</para>
 
-    <para>To tell Mercurial to track a file, use the <command
+    <para id="x_1a4">To tell Mercurial to track a file, use the <command
 	role="hg-cmd">hg add</command> command.  Once you have added a
       file, the entry in the output of <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	status</command> for that file changes from
@@ -23,7 +23,7 @@
 
       &interaction.daily.files.add;
 
-    <para>After you run a <command role="hg-cmd">hg commit</command>,
+    <para id="x_1a5">After you run a <command role="hg-cmd">hg commit</command>,
       the files that you added before the commit will no longer be
       listed in the output of <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	status</command>.  The reason for this is that <command
@@ -35,7 +35,7 @@
       is tracking, but that have not changed.  (You can still get this
       information; we'll return to this later.)</para>
 
-    <para>Once you add a file, Mercurial doesn't do anything with it
+    <para id="x_1a6">Once you add a file, Mercurial doesn't do anything with it
       immediately.  Instead, it will take a snapshot of the file's
       state the next time you perform a commit.  It will then continue
       to track the changes you make to the file every time you commit,
@@ -44,24 +44,24 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Explicit versus implicit file naming</title>
 
-      <para>A useful behaviour that Mercurial has is that if you pass
+      <para id="x_1a7">A useful behaviour that Mercurial has is that if you pass
 	the name of a directory to a command, every Mercurial command
 	will treat this as <quote>I want to operate on every file in
 	  this directory and its subdirectories</quote>.</para>
 
       &interaction.daily.files.add-dir;
 
-      <para>Notice in this example that Mercurial printed the names of
+      <para id="x_1a8">Notice in this example that Mercurial printed the names of
 	the files it added, whereas it didn't do so when we added the
 	file named <filename>a</filename> in the earlier
 	example.</para>
 
-      <para>What's going on is that in the former case, we explicitly
+      <para id="x_1a9">What's going on is that in the former case, we explicitly
 	named the file to add on the command line, so the assumption
 	that Mercurial makes in such cases is that you know what you
 	were doing, and it doesn't print any output.</para>
 
-      <para>However, when we <emphasis>imply</emphasis> the names of
+      <para id="x_1aa">However, when we <emphasis>imply</emphasis> the names of
 	files by giving the name of a directory, Mercurial takes the
 	extra step of printing the name of each file that it does
 	something with.  This makes it more clear what is happening,
@@ -72,7 +72,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Aside: Mercurial tracks files, not directories</title>
 
-      <para>Mercurial does not track directory information.  Instead,
+      <para id="x_1ab">Mercurial does not track directory information.  Instead,
 	it tracks the path to a file.  Before creating a file, it
 	first creates any missing directory components of the path.
 	After it deletes a file, it then deletes any empty directories
@@ -81,14 +81,14 @@
 	consequence: it is not possible to represent a completely
 	empty directory in Mercurial.</para>
 
-      <para>Empty directories are rarely useful, and there are
+      <para id="x_1ac">Empty directories are rarely useful, and there are
 	unintrusive workarounds that you can use to achieve an
 	appropriate effect.  The developers of Mercurial thus felt
 	that the complexity that would be required to manage empty
 	directories was not worth the limited benefit this feature
 	would bring.</para>
 
-      <para>If you need an empty directory in your repository, there
+      <para id="x_1ad">If you need an empty directory in your repository, there
 	are a few ways to achieve this. One is to create a directory,
 	then <command role="hg-cmd">hg add</command> a
 	<quote>hidden</quote> file to that directory.  On Unix-like
@@ -99,7 +99,7 @@
 
 &interaction.daily.files.hidden;
 
-      <para>Another way to tackle a need for an empty directory is to
+      <para id="x_1ae">Another way to tackle a need for an empty directory is to
 	simply create one in your automated build scripts before they
 	will need it.</para>
 
@@ -108,7 +108,7 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>How to stop tracking a file</title>
 
-    <para>Once you decide that a file no longer belongs in your
+    <para id="x_1af">Once you decide that a file no longer belongs in your
       repository, use the <command role="hg-cmd">hg remove</command>
       command; this deletes the file, and tells Mercurial to stop
       tracking it.  A removed file is represented in the output of
@@ -117,7 +117,7 @@
 
     &interaction.daily.files.remove;
 
-    <para>After you <command role="hg-cmd">hg remove</command> a file,
+    <para id="x_1b0">After you <command role="hg-cmd">hg remove</command> a file,
       Mercurial will no longer track changes to that file, even if you
       recreate a file with the same name in your working directory.
       If you do recreate a file with the same name and want Mercurial
@@ -128,19 +128,19 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Removing a file does not affect its history</title>
 
-      <para>It is important to understand that removing a file has
+      <para id="x_1b1">It is important to understand that removing a file has
 	only two effects.</para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para>It removes the current version of the file
+	<listitem><para id="x_1b2">It removes the current version of the file
 	    from the working directory.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>It stops Mercurial from tracking changes to
+	<listitem><para id="x_1b3">It stops Mercurial from tracking changes to
 	    the file, from the time of the next commit.</para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
-      <para>Removing a file <emphasis>does not</emphasis> in any way
+      <para id="x_1b4">Removing a file <emphasis>does not</emphasis> in any way
 	alter the <emphasis>history</emphasis> of the file.</para>
 
-      <para>If you update the working directory to a changeset in
+      <para id="x_1b5">If you update the working directory to a changeset in
 	which a file that you have removed was still tracked, it will
 	reappear in the working directory, with the contents it had
 	when you committed that changeset.  If you then update the
@@ -152,7 +152,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Missing files</title>
 
-      <para>Mercurial considers a file that you have deleted, but not
+      <para id="x_1b6">Mercurial considers a file that you have deleted, but not
 	used <command role="hg-cmd">hg remove</command> to delete, to
 	be <emphasis>missing</emphasis>.  A missing file is
 	represented with <quote><literal>!</literal></quote> in the
@@ -162,7 +162,7 @@
 
       &interaction.daily.files.missing;
 
-      <para>If your repository contains a file that <command
+      <para id="x_1b7">If your repository contains a file that <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg status</command> reports as missing, and
 	you want the file to stay gone, you can run <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg remove <option
@@ -172,7 +172,7 @@
 
       &interaction.daily.files.remove-after;
 
-      <para>On the other hand, if you deleted the missing file by
+      <para id="x_1b8">On the other hand, if you deleted the missing file by
 	accident, give <command role="hg-cmd">hg revert</command> the
 	name of the file to recover.  It will reappear, in unmodified
 	form.</para>
@@ -184,7 +184,7 @@
       <title>Aside: why tell Mercurial explicitly to remove a
 	file?</title>
 
-      <para>You might wonder why Mercurial requires you to explicitly
+      <para id="x_1b9">You might wonder why Mercurial requires you to explicitly
 	tell it that you are deleting a file.  Early during the
 	development of Mercurial, it let you delete a file however you
 	pleased; Mercurial would notice the absence of the file
@@ -198,13 +198,13 @@
       <title>Useful shorthand&emdash;adding and removing files in one
 	step</title>
 
-      <para>Mercurial offers a combination command, <command
+      <para id="x_1ba">Mercurial offers a combination command, <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg addremove</command>, that adds untracked
 	files and marks missing files as removed.</para>
 
       &interaction.daily.files.addremove;
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-cmd">hg commit</command> command
+      <para id="x_1bb">The <command role="hg-cmd">hg commit</command> command
 	also provides a <option role="hg-opt-commit">-A</option>
 	option that performs this same add-and-remove, immediately
 	followed by a commit.</para>
@@ -216,7 +216,7 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Copying files</title>
 
-    <para>Mercurial provides a <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+    <para id="x_1bc">Mercurial provides a <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	copy</command> command that lets you make a new copy of a
       file.  When you copy a file using this command, Mercurial makes
       a record of the fact that the new file is a copy of the original
@@ -226,32 +226,32 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>The results of copying during a merge</title>
 
-      <para>What happens during a merge is that changes
+      <para id="x_1bd">What happens during a merge is that changes
 	<quote>follow</quote> a copy.  To best illustrate what this
 	means, let's create an example.  We'll start with the usual
 	tiny repository that contains a single file.</para>
 
       &interaction.daily.copy.init;
 
-      <para>We need to do some work in
+      <para id="x_1be">We need to do some work in
 	parallel, so that we'll have something to merge.  So let's
 	clone our repository.</para>
 
       &interaction.daily.copy.clone;
 
-      <para>Back in our initial repository, let's use the <command
+      <para id="x_1bf">Back in our initial repository, let's use the <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg copy</command> command to make a copy of
 	the first file we created.</para>
 
       &interaction.daily.copy.copy;
 
-      <para>If we look at the output of the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+      <para id="x_1c0">If we look at the output of the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	  status</command> command afterwards, the copied file looks
 	just like a normal added file.</para>
 
       &interaction.daily.copy.status;
 
-      <para>But if we pass the <option
+      <para id="x_1c1">But if we pass the <option
 	  role="hg-opt-status">-C</option> option to <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg status</command>, it prints another line of
 	output: this is the file that our newly-added file was copied
@@ -259,13 +259,13 @@
 
       &interaction.daily.copy.status-copy;
 
-      <para>Now, back in the repository we cloned, let's make a change
+      <para id="x_1c2">Now, back in the repository we cloned, let's make a change
 	in parallel.  We'll add a line of content to the original file
 	that we created.</para>
 
       &interaction.daily.copy.other;
 
-      <para>Now we have a modified <filename>file</filename> in this
+      <para id="x_1c3">Now we have a modified <filename>file</filename> in this
 	repository.  When we pull the changes from the first
 	repository, and merge the two heads, Mercurial will propagate
 	the changes that we made locally to <filename>file</filename>
@@ -277,41 +277,41 @@
     <sect2 id="sec:daily:why-copy">
       <title>Why should changes follow copies?</title>
 
-      <para>This behaviour, of changes to a file propagating out to
+      <para id="x_1c4">This behaviour, of changes to a file propagating out to
 	copies of the file, might seem esoteric, but in most cases
 	it's highly desirable.</para>
 
-      <para>First of all, remember that this propagation
+      <para id="x_1c5">First of all, remember that this propagation
 	<emphasis>only</emphasis> happens when you merge.  So if you
 	<command role="hg-cmd">hg copy</command> a file, and
 	subsequently modify the original file during the normal course
 	of your work, nothing will happen.</para>
 
-      <para>The second thing to know is that modifications will only
+      <para id="x_1c6">The second thing to know is that modifications will only
 	propagate across a copy as long as the repository that you're
 	pulling changes from <emphasis>doesn't know</emphasis> about
 	the copy.</para>
 
-      <para>The reason that Mercurial does this is as follows.  Let's
+      <para id="x_1c7">The reason that Mercurial does this is as follows.  Let's
 	say I make an important bug fix in a source file, and commit
 	my changes. Meanwhile, you've decided to <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg copy</command> the file in your repository,
 	without knowing about the bug or having seen the fix, and you
 	have started hacking on your copy of the file.</para>
 
-      <para>If you pulled and merged my changes, and Mercurial
+      <para id="x_1c8">If you pulled and merged my changes, and Mercurial
 	<emphasis>didn't</emphasis> propagate changes across copies,
 	your source file would now contain the bug, and unless you
 	remembered to propagate the bug fix by hand, the bug would
 	<emphasis>remain</emphasis> in your copy of the file.</para>
 
-      <para>By automatically propagating the change that fixed the bug
+      <para id="x_1c9">By automatically propagating the change that fixed the bug
 	from the original file to the copy, Mercurial prevents this
 	class of problem. To my knowledge, Mercurial is the
 	<emphasis>only</emphasis> revision control system that
 	propagates changes across copies like this.</para>
 
-      <para>Once your change history has a record that the copy and
+      <para id="x_1ca">Once your change history has a record that the copy and
 	subsequent merge occurred, there's usually no further need to
 	propagate changes from the original file to the copied file,
 	and that's why Mercurial only propagates changes across copies
@@ -322,7 +322,7 @@
       <title>How to make changes <emphasis>not</emphasis> follow a
 	copy</title>
 
-      <para>If, for some reason, you decide that this business of
+      <para id="x_1cb">If, for some reason, you decide that this business of
 	automatically propagating changes across copies is not for
 	you, simply use your system's normal file copy command (on
 	Unix-like systems, that's <command>cp</command>) to make a
@@ -338,7 +338,7 @@
       <title>Behaviour of the <command role="hg-cmd">hg copy</command>
 	command</title>
 
-      <para>When you use the <command role="hg-cmd">hg copy</command>
+      <para id="x_1cc">When you use the <command role="hg-cmd">hg copy</command>
 	command, Mercurial makes a copy of each source file as it
 	currently stands in the working directory.  This means that if
 	you make some modifications to a file, then <command
@@ -348,7 +348,7 @@
 	behaviour a little counterintuitive, which is why I mention it
 	here.)</para>
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-cmd">hg copy</command> command acts
+      <para id="x_1cd">The <command role="hg-cmd">hg copy</command> command acts
 	similarly to the Unix <command>cp</command> command (you can
 	use the <command role="hg-cmd">hg cp</command> alias if you
 	prefer).  The last argument is the
@@ -359,23 +359,23 @@
 
       &interaction.daily.copy.simple;
       
-      <para>If the destination is a directory, Mercurial copies its
+      <para id="x_1ce">If the destination is a directory, Mercurial copies its
 	sources into that directory.</para>
 
       &interaction.daily.copy.dir-dest;
 
-      <para>Copying a directory is
+      <para id="x_1cf">Copying a directory is
 	recursive, and preserves the directory structure of the
 	source.</para>
 
       &interaction.daily.copy.dir-src;
 
-      <para>If the source and destination are both directories, the
+      <para id="x_1d0">If the source and destination are both directories, the
 	source tree is recreated in the destination directory.</para>
 
 	&interaction.daily.copy.dir-src-dest;
 
-      <para>As with the <command role="hg-cmd">hg rename</command>
+      <para id="x_1d1">As with the <command role="hg-cmd">hg rename</command>
 	command, if you copy a file manually and then want Mercurial
 	to know that you've copied the file, simply use the <option
 	  role="hg-opt-copy">--after</option> option to <command
@@ -388,7 +388,7 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Renaming files</title>
 
-    <para>It's rather more common to need to rename a file than to
+    <para id="x_1d2">It's rather more common to need to rename a file than to
       make a copy of it.  The reason I discussed the <command
 	role="hg-cmd">hg copy</command> command before talking about
       renaming files is that Mercurial treats a rename in essentially
@@ -396,19 +396,19 @@
       when you copy a file tells you what to expect when you rename a
       file.</para>
 
-    <para>When you use the <command role="hg-cmd">hg rename</command>
+    <para id="x_1d3">When you use the <command role="hg-cmd">hg rename</command>
       command, Mercurial makes a copy of each source file, then
       deletes it and marks the file as removed.</para>
 
       &interaction.daily.rename.rename;
 
-    <para>The <command role="hg-cmd">hg status</command> command shows
+    <para id="x_1d4">The <command role="hg-cmd">hg status</command> command shows
       the newly copied file as added, and the copied-from file as
       removed.</para>
 
     &interaction.daily.rename.status;
 
-    <para>As with the results of a <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+    <para id="x_1d5">As with the results of a <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	copy</command>, we must use the <option
 	role="hg-opt-status">-C</option> option to <command
 	role="hg-cmd">hg status</command> to see that the added file
@@ -417,7 +417,7 @@
 
     &interaction.daily.rename.status-copy;
 
-    <para>As with <command role="hg-cmd">hg remove</command> and
+    <para id="x_1d6">As with <command role="hg-cmd">hg remove</command> and
       <command role="hg-cmd">hg copy</command>, you can tell Mercurial
       about a rename after the fact using the <option
 	role="hg-opt-rename">--after</option> option.  In most other
@@ -429,18 +429,18 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Renaming files and merging changes</title>
 
-      <para>Since Mercurial's rename is implemented as
+      <para id="x_1d7">Since Mercurial's rename is implemented as
 	copy-and-remove, the same propagation of changes happens when
 	you merge after a rename as after a copy.</para>
 
-      <para>If I modify a file, and you rename it to a new name, and
+      <para id="x_1d8">If I modify a file, and you rename it to a new name, and
 	then we merge our respective changes, my modifications to the
 	file under its original name will be propagated into the file
 	under its new name. (This is something you might expect to
 	<quote>simply work,</quote> but not all revision control
 	systems actually do this.)</para>
 
-      <para>Whereas having changes follow a copy is a feature where
+      <para id="x_1d9">Whereas having changes follow a copy is a feature where
 	you can perhaps nod and say <quote>yes, that might be
 	  useful,</quote> it should be clear that having them follow a
 	rename is definitely important.  Without this facility, it
@@ -451,34 +451,34 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Divergent renames and merging</title>
 
-      <para>The case of diverging names occurs when two developers
+      <para id="x_1da">The case of diverging names occurs when two developers
 	start with a file&emdash;let's call it
 	<filename>foo</filename>&emdash;in their respective
 	repositories.</para>
 
       &interaction.rename.divergent.clone;
 
-      <para>Anne renames the file to <filename>bar</filename>.</para>
+      <para id="x_1db">Anne renames the file to <filename>bar</filename>.</para>
 
       &interaction.rename.divergent.rename.anne;
 
-      <para>Meanwhile, Bob renames it to
+      <para id="x_1dc">Meanwhile, Bob renames it to
 	<filename>quux</filename>.</para>
 
 	&interaction.rename.divergent.rename.bob;
 
-      <para>I like to think of this as a conflict because each
+      <para id="x_1dd">I like to think of this as a conflict because each
 	developer has expressed different intentions about what the
 	file ought to be named.</para>
 
-      <para>What do you think should happen when they merge their
+      <para id="x_1de">What do you think should happen when they merge their
 	work? Mercurial's actual behaviour is that it always preserves
 	<emphasis>both</emphasis> names when it merges changesets that
 	contain divergent renames.</para>
 
       &interaction.rename.divergent.merge;
 
-      <para>Notice that Mercurial does warn about the divergent
+      <para id="x_1df">Notice that Mercurial does warn about the divergent
 	renames, but it leaves it up to you to do something about the
 	divergence after the merge.</para>
 
@@ -486,7 +486,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Convergent renames and merging</title>
 
-      <para>Another kind of rename conflict occurs when two people
+      <para id="x_1e0">Another kind of rename conflict occurs when two people
 	choose to rename different <emphasis>source</emphasis> files
 	to the same <emphasis>destination</emphasis>. In this case,
 	Mercurial runs its normal merge machinery, and lets you guide
@@ -496,7 +496,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Other name-related corner cases</title>
 
-      <para>Mercurial has a longstanding bug in which it fails to
+      <para id="x_1e1">Mercurial has a longstanding bug in which it fails to
 	handle a merge where one side has a file with a given name,
 	while another has a directory with the same name.  This is
 	documented as <ulink role="hg-bug"
@@ -510,10 +510,10 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Recovering from mistakes</title>
 
-    <para>Mercurial has some useful commands that will help you to
+    <para id="x_1e2">Mercurial has some useful commands that will help you to
       recover from some common mistakes.</para>
 
-    <para>The <command role="hg-cmd">hg revert</command> command lets
+    <para id="x_1e3">The <command role="hg-cmd">hg revert</command> command lets
       you undo changes that you have made to your working directory.
       For example, if you <command role="hg-cmd">hg add</command> a
       file by accident, just run <command role="hg-cmd">hg
@@ -523,13 +523,13 @@
       <command role="hg-cmd">hg revert</command> to get rid of
       erroneous changes to a file.</para>
 
-    <para>It's useful to remember that the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+    <para id="x_1e4">It's useful to remember that the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	revert</command> command is useful for changes that you have
       not yet committed.  Once you've committed a change, if you
       decide it was a mistake, you can still do something about it,
       though your options may be more limited.</para>
 
-    <para>For more information about the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+    <para id="x_1e5">For more information about the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	revert</command> command, and details about how to deal with
       changes you have already committed, see chapter <xref
 	linkend="chap:undo"/>.</para>
--- a/en/ch05-collab.xml	Thu Mar 19 20:54:12 2009 -0700
+++ b/en/ch05-collab.xml	Thu Mar 19 21:18:52 2009 -0700
@@ -4,7 +4,7 @@
   <?dbhtml filename="collaborating-with-other-people.html"?>
   <title>Collaborating with other people</title>
 
-  <para>As a completely decentralised tool, Mercurial doesn't impose
+  <para id="x_44a">As a completely decentralised tool, Mercurial doesn't impose
     any policy on how people ought to work with each other.  However,
     if you're new to distributed revision control, it helps to have
     some tools and examples in mind when you're thinking about
@@ -13,15 +13,15 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Mercurial's web interface</title>
 
-    <para>Mercurial has a powerful web interface that provides several
+    <para id="x_44b">Mercurial has a powerful web interface that provides several
       useful capabilities.</para>
 
-    <para>For interactive use, the web interface lets you browse a
+    <para id="x_44c">For interactive use, the web interface lets you browse a
       single repository or a collection of repositories.  You can view
       the history of a repository, examine each change (comments and
       diffs), and view the contents of each directory and file.</para>
 
-    <para>Also for human consumption, the web interface provides an
+    <para id="x_44d">Also for human consumption, the web interface provides an
       RSS feed of the changes in a repository.  This lets you
       <quote>subscribe</quote> to a repository using your favourite
       feed reader, and be automatically notified of activity in that
@@ -31,18 +31,18 @@
       configuration on the part of whoever is serving the
       repository.</para>
 
-    <para>The web interface also lets remote users clone a repository,
+    <para id="x_44e">The web interface also lets remote users clone a repository,
       pull changes from it, and (when the server is configured to
       permit it) push changes back to it.  Mercurial's HTTP tunneling
       protocol aggressively compresses data, so that it works
       efficiently even over low-bandwidth network connections.</para>
 
-    <para>The easiest way to get started with the web interface is to
+    <para id="x_44f">The easiest way to get started with the web interface is to
       use your web browser to visit an existing repository, such as
       the master Mercurial repository at <ulink
 	url="http://www.selenic.com/repo/hg?style=gitweb">http://www.selenic.com/repo/hg?style=gitweb</ulink>.</para>
 
-    <para>If you're interested in providing a web interface to your
+    <para id="x_450">If you're interested in providing a web interface to your
       own repositories, Mercurial provides two ways to do this.  The
       first is using the <command role="hg-cmd">hg serve</command>
       command, which is best suited to short-term
@@ -59,7 +59,7 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Collaboration models</title>
 
-    <para>With a suitably flexible tool, making decisions about
+    <para id="x_451">With a suitably flexible tool, making decisions about
       workflow is much more of a social engineering challenge than a
       technical one. Mercurial imposes few limitations on how you can
       structure the flow of work in a project, so it's up to you and
@@ -69,13 +69,13 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Factors to keep in mind</title>
 
-      <para>The most important aspect of any model that you must keep
+      <para id="x_452">The most important aspect of any model that you must keep
 	in mind is how well it matches the needs and capabilities of
 	the people who will be using it.  This might seem
 	self-evident; even so, you still can't afford to forget it for
 	a moment.</para>
 
-      <para>I once put together a workflow model that seemed to make
+      <para id="x_453">I once put together a workflow model that seemed to make
 	perfect sense to me, but that caused a considerable amount of
 	consternation and strife within my development team.  In spite
 	of my attempts to explain why we needed a complex set of
@@ -85,7 +85,7 @@
 	operating under, or face the consequences of those constraints
 	in the details of the model that I was advocating.</para>
 
-      <para>Don't sweep foreseeable social or technical problems under
+      <para id="x_454">Don't sweep foreseeable social or technical problems under
 	the rug. Whatever scheme you put into effect, you should plan
 	for mistakes and problem scenarios.  Consider adding automated
 	machinery to prevent, or quickly recover from, trouble that
@@ -101,12 +101,12 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Informal anarchy</title>
 
-      <para>I wouldn't suggest an <quote>anything goes</quote>
+      <para id="x_455">I wouldn't suggest an <quote>anything goes</quote>
 	approach as something sustainable, but it's a model that's
 	easy to grasp, and it works perfectly well in a few unusual
 	situations.</para>
 
-      <para>As one example, many projects have a loose-knit group of
+      <para id="x_456">As one example, many projects have a loose-knit group of
 	collaborators who rarely physically meet each other.  Some
 	groups like to overcome the isolation of working at a distance
 	by organising occasional <quote>sprints</quote>.  In a sprint,
@@ -115,7 +115,7 @@
 	place) and spend several days more or less locked in there,
 	hacking intensely on a handful of projects.</para>
 
-      <para>A sprint is the perfect place to use the <command
+      <para id="x_457">A sprint is the perfect place to use the <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg serve</command> command, since <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg serve</command> does not require any fancy
 	server infrastructure.  You can get started with <command
@@ -129,7 +129,7 @@
 	they can pull a bugfix from you and verify it; or they can
 	clone a branch containing a new feature and try it out.</para>
 
-      <para>The charm, and the problem, with doing things in an ad hoc
+      <para id="x_458">The charm, and the problem, with doing things in an ad hoc
 	fashion like this is that only people who know about your
 	changes, and where they are, can see them.  Such an informal
 	approach simply doesn't scale beyond a handful people, because
@@ -140,18 +140,18 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>A single central repository</title>
 
-      <para>For smaller projects migrating from a centralised revision
+      <para id="x_459">For smaller projects migrating from a centralised revision
 	control tool, perhaps the easiest way to get started is to
 	have changes flow through a single shared central repository.
 	This is also the most common <quote>building block</quote> for
 	more ambitious workflow schemes.</para>
 
-      <para>Contributors start by cloning a copy of this repository.
+      <para id="x_45a">Contributors start by cloning a copy of this repository.
 	They can pull changes from it whenever they need to, and some
 	(perhaps all) developers have permission to push a change back
 	when they're ready for other people to see it.</para>
 
-      <para>Under this model, it can still often make sense for people
+      <para id="x_45b">Under this model, it can still often make sense for people
 	to pull changes directly from each other, without going
 	through the central repository.  Consider a case in which I
 	have a tentative bug fix, but I am worried that if I were to
@@ -162,7 +162,7 @@
 	lets us put off publishing the potentially unsafe change until
 	it has had a little testing.</para>
 
-      <para>In this kind of scenario, people usually use the
+      <para id="x_45c">In this kind of scenario, people usually use the
 	<command>ssh</command> protocol to securely push changes to
 	the central repository, as documented in section <xref
 	  linkend="sec:collab:ssh"/>.  It's also
@@ -177,7 +177,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Working with multiple branches</title>
 
-      <para>Projects of any significant size naturally tend to make
+      <para id="x_45d">Projects of any significant size naturally tend to make
 	progress on several fronts simultaneously.  In the case of
 	software, it's common for a project to go through periodic
 	official releases.  A release might then go into
@@ -190,7 +190,7 @@
 	different directions in which development is
 	proceeding.</para>
 
-      <para>Mercurial is particularly well suited to managing a number
+      <para id="x_45e">Mercurial is particularly well suited to managing a number
 	of simultaneous, but not identical, branches.  Each
 	<quote>development direction</quote> can live in its own
 	central repository, and you can merge changes from one to
@@ -199,27 +199,27 @@
 	branch will never affect a stable branch unless someone
 	explicitly merges those changes in.</para>
 
-      <para>Here's an example of how this can work in practice.  Let's
+      <para id="x_45f">Here's an example of how this can work in practice.  Let's
 	say you have one <quote>main branch</quote> on a central
 	server.</para>
 
       &interaction.branching.init;
 
-      <para>People clone it, make changes locally, test them, and push
+      <para id="x_460">People clone it, make changes locally, test them, and push
 	them back.</para>
 
-      <para>Once the main branch reaches a release milestone, you can
+      <para id="x_461">Once the main branch reaches a release milestone, you can
 	use the <command role="hg-cmd">hg tag</command> command to
 	give a permanent name to the milestone revision.</para>
 
 	&interaction.branching.tag;
 
-      <para>Let's say some ongoing
+      <para id="x_462">Let's say some ongoing
 	development occurs on the main branch.</para>
 
       &interaction.branching.main;
 
-      <para>Using the tag that was recorded at the milestone, people
+      <para id="x_463">Using the tag that was recorded at the milestone, people
 	who clone that repository at any time in the future can use
 	<command role="hg-cmd">hg update</command> to get a copy of
 	the working directory exactly as it was when that tagged
@@ -227,26 +227,26 @@
 
       &interaction.branching.update;
 
-      <para>In addition, immediately after the main branch is tagged,
+      <para id="x_464">In addition, immediately after the main branch is tagged,
 	someone can then clone the main branch on the server to a new
 	<quote>stable</quote> branch, also on the server.</para>
 
       &interaction.branching.clone;
 
-      <para>Someone who needs to make a change to the stable branch
+      <para id="x_465">Someone who needs to make a change to the stable branch
 	can then clone <emphasis>that</emphasis> repository, make
 	their changes, commit, and push their changes back there.</para>
 
       &interaction.branching.stable;
 
-      <para>Because Mercurial repositories are independent, and
+      <para id="x_466">Because Mercurial repositories are independent, and
 	Mercurial doesn't move changes around automatically, the
 	stable and main branches are <emphasis>isolated</emphasis>
 	from each other.  The changes that you made on the main branch
 	don't <quote>leak</quote> to the stable branch, and vice
 	versa.</para>
 
-      <para>You'll often want all of your bugfixes on the stable
+      <para id="x_467">You'll often want all of your bugfixes on the stable
 	branch to show up on the main branch, too.  Rather than
 	rewrite a bugfix on the main branch, you can simply pull and
 	merge changes from the stable to the main branch, and
@@ -254,7 +254,7 @@
 
 	&interaction.branching.merge;
 
-      <para>The main branch will still contain changes that are not on
+      <para id="x_468">The main branch will still contain changes that are not on
 	the stable branch, but it will also contain all of the
 	bugfixes from the stable branch.  The stable branch remains
 	unaffected by these changes.</para>
@@ -263,7 +263,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Feature branches</title>
 
-      <para>For larger projects, an effective way to manage change is
+      <para id="x_469">For larger projects, an effective way to manage change is
 	to break up a team into smaller groups.  Each group has a
 	shared branch of its own, cloned from a single
 	<quote>master</quote> branch used by the entire project.
@@ -273,11 +273,11 @@
       <informalfigure id="fig:collab:feature-branches">
 	<mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata
 				    fileref="feature-branches"/></imageobject><textobject><phrase>XXX 
-	      add text</phrase></textobject><caption><para>Feature
+	      add text</phrase></textobject><caption><para id="x_46a">Feature
 	      branches</para></caption></mediaobject>
       </informalfigure>
 
-      <para>When a particular feature is deemed to be in suitable
+      <para id="x_46b">When a particular feature is deemed to be in suitable
 	shape, someone on that feature team pulls and merges from the
 	master branch into the feature branch, then pushes back up to
 	the master branch.</para>
@@ -286,12 +286,12 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>The release train</title>
 
-      <para>Some projects are organised on a <quote>train</quote>
+      <para id="x_46c">Some projects are organised on a <quote>train</quote>
 	basis: a release is scheduled to happen every few months, and
 	whatever features are ready when the <quote>train</quote> is
 	ready to leave are allowed in.</para>
 
-      <para>This model resembles working with feature branches.  The
+      <para id="x_46d">This model resembles working with feature branches.  The
 	difference is that when a feature branch misses a train,
 	someone on the feature team pulls and merges the changes that
 	went out on that train release into the feature branch, and
@@ -302,7 +302,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>The Linux kernel model</title>
 
-      <para>The development of the Linux kernel has a shallow
+      <para id="x_46e">The development of the Linux kernel has a shallow
 	hierarchical structure, surrounded by a cloud of apparent
 	chaos.  Because most Linux developers use
 	<command>git</command>, a distributed revision control tool
@@ -310,14 +310,14 @@
 	describe the way work flows in that environment; if you like
 	the ideas, the approach translates well across tools.</para>
 
-      <para>At the center of the community sits Linus Torvalds, the
+      <para id="x_46f">At the center of the community sits Linus Torvalds, the
 	creator of Linux.  He publishes a single source repository
 	that is considered the <quote>authoritative</quote> current
 	tree by the entire developer community. Anyone can clone
 	Linus's tree, but he is very choosy about whose trees he pulls
 	from.</para>
 
-      <para>Linus has a number of <quote>trusted lieutenants</quote>.
+      <para id="x_470">Linus has a number of <quote>trusted lieutenants</quote>.
 	As a general rule, he pulls whatever changes they publish, in
 	most cases without even reviewing those changes.  Some of
 	those lieutenants are generally agreed to be
@@ -329,7 +329,7 @@
 	If the maintainer reviews their changes and agrees to take
 	them, they'll pass them along to Linus in due course.</para>
 
-      <para>Individual lieutenants have their own approaches to
+      <para id="x_471">Individual lieutenants have their own approaches to
 	reviewing, accepting, and publishing changes; and for deciding
 	when to feed them to Linus.  In addition, there are several
 	well known branches that people use for different purposes.
@@ -340,14 +340,14 @@
 	that they are about to feed upstream; and so on.  Others just
 	publish a single tree.</para>
 
-      <para>This model has two notable features.  The first is that
+      <para id="x_472">This model has two notable features.  The first is that
 	it's <quote>pull only</quote>.  You have to ask, convince, or
 	beg another developer to take a change from you, because there
 	are almost no trees to which more than one person can push,
 	and there's no way to push changes into a tree that someone
 	else controls.</para>
 
-      <para>The second is that it's based on reputation and acclaim.
+      <para id="x_473">The second is that it's based on reputation and acclaim.
 	If you're an unknown, Linus will probably ignore changes from
 	you without even responding.  But a subsystem maintainer will
 	probably review them, and will likely take them if they pass
@@ -358,14 +358,14 @@
 	Linus hasn't yet accepted, people with similar interests may
 	pull your changes regularly to keep up with your work.</para>
 
-      <para>Reputation and acclaim don't necessarily cross subsystem
+      <para id="x_474">Reputation and acclaim don't necessarily cross subsystem
 	or <quote>people</quote> boundaries.  If you're a respected
 	but specialised storage hacker, and you try to fix a
 	networking bug, that change will receive a level of scrutiny
 	from a network maintainer comparable to a change from a
 	complete stranger.</para>
 
-      <para>To people who come from more orderly project backgrounds,
+      <para id="x_475">To people who come from more orderly project backgrounds,
 	the comparatively chaotic Linux kernel development process
 	often seems completely insane.  It's subject to the whims of
 	individuals; people make sweeping changes whenever they deem
@@ -377,13 +377,13 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Pull-only versus shared-push collaboration</title>
 
-      <para>A perpetual source of heat in the open source community is
+      <para id="x_476">A perpetual source of heat in the open source community is
 	whether a development model in which people only ever pull
 	changes from others is <quote>better than</quote> one in which
 	multiple people can push changes to a shared
 	repository.</para>
 
-      <para>Typically, the backers of the shared-push model use tools
+      <para id="x_477">Typically, the backers of the shared-push model use tools
 	that actively enforce this approach.  If you're using a
 	centralised revision control tool such as Subversion, there's
 	no way to make a choice over which model you'll use: the tool
@@ -391,7 +391,7 @@
 	you'll have to roll your own approach on top (such as applying
 	a patch by hand).</para>
 
-      <para>A good distributed revision control tool, such as
+      <para id="x_478">A good distributed revision control tool, such as
 	Mercurial, will support both models.  You and your
 	collaborators can then structure how you work together based
 	on your own needs and preferences, not on what contortions
@@ -401,7 +401,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Where collaboration meets branch management</title>
 
-      <para>Once you and your team set up some shared repositories and
+      <para id="x_479">Once you and your team set up some shared repositories and
 	start propagating changes back and forth between local and
 	shared repos, you begin to face a related, but slightly
 	different challenge: that of managing the multiple directions
@@ -415,7 +415,7 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>The technical side of sharing</title>
 
-    <para>The remainder of this chapter is devoted to the question of
+    <para id="x_47a">The remainder of this chapter is devoted to the question of
       serving data to your collaborators.</para>
 
   </sect1>
@@ -423,12 +423,12 @@
     <title>Informal sharing with <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	serve</command></title>
 
-    <para>Mercurial's <command role="hg-cmd">hg serve</command>
+    <para id="x_47b">Mercurial's <command role="hg-cmd">hg serve</command>
       command is wonderfully suited to small, tight-knit, and
       fast-paced group environments.  It also provides a great way to
       get a feel for using Mercurial commands over a network.</para>
 
-    <para>Run <command role="hg-cmd">hg serve</command> inside a
+    <para id="x_47c">Run <command role="hg-cmd">hg serve</command> inside a
       repository, and in under a second it will bring up a specialised
       HTTP server; this will accept connections from any client, and
       serve up data for that repository until you terminate it.
@@ -439,24 +439,24 @@
       on a laptop is likely to look something like
       <literal>http://my-laptop.local:8000/</literal>.</para>
 
-    <para>The <command role="hg-cmd">hg serve</command> command is
+    <para id="x_47d">The <command role="hg-cmd">hg serve</command> command is
       <emphasis>not</emphasis> a general-purpose web server. It can do
       only two things:</para>
     <itemizedlist>
-      <listitem><para>Allow people to browse the history of the
+      <listitem><para id="x_47e">Allow people to browse the history of the
 	  repository it's serving, from their normal web
 	  browsers.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>Speak Mercurial's wire protocol, so that people
+      <listitem><para id="x_47f">Speak Mercurial's wire protocol, so that people
 	  can <command role="hg-cmd">hg clone</command> or <command
 	    role="hg-cmd">hg pull</command> changes from that
 	  repository.</para>
       </listitem></itemizedlist>
-    <para>In particular, <command role="hg-cmd">hg serve</command>
+    <para id="x_480">In particular, <command role="hg-cmd">hg serve</command>
       won't allow remote users to <emphasis>modify</emphasis> your
       repository.  It's intended for read-only use.</para>
 
-    <para>If you're getting started with Mercurial, there's nothing to
+    <para id="x_481">If you're getting started with Mercurial, there's nothing to
       prevent you from using <command role="hg-cmd">hg serve</command>
       to serve up a repository on your own computer, then use commands
       like <command role="hg-cmd">hg clone</command>, <command
@@ -468,13 +468,13 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>A few things to keep in mind</title>
 
-      <para>Because it provides unauthenticated read access to all
+      <para id="x_482">Because it provides unauthenticated read access to all
 	clients, you should only use <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	  serve</command> in an environment where you either don't
 	care, or have complete control over, who can access your
 	network and pull data from your repository.</para>
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-cmd">hg serve</command> command
+      <para id="x_483">The <command role="hg-cmd">hg serve</command> command
 	knows nothing about any firewall software you might have
 	installed on your system or network.  It cannot detect or
 	control your firewall software.  If other people are unable to
@@ -483,13 +483,13 @@
 	(<emphasis>after</emphasis> you make sure that they're using
 	the correct URL) is check your firewall configuration.</para>
 
-      <para>By default, <command role="hg-cmd">hg serve</command>
+      <para id="x_484">By default, <command role="hg-cmd">hg serve</command>
 	listens for incoming connections on port 8000.  If another
 	process is already listening on the port you want to use, you
 	can specify a different port to listen on using the <option
 	  role="hg-opt-serve">-p</option> option.</para>
 
-      <para>Normally, when <command role="hg-cmd">hg serve</command>
+      <para id="x_485">Normally, when <command role="hg-cmd">hg serve</command>
 	starts, it prints no output, which can be a bit unnerving.  If
 	you'd like to confirm that it is indeed running correctly, and
 	find out what URL you should send to your collaborators, start
@@ -501,56 +501,56 @@
   <sect1 id="sec:collab:ssh">
     <title>Using the Secure Shell (ssh) protocol</title>
 
-    <para>You can pull and push changes securely over a network
+    <para id="x_486">You can pull and push changes securely over a network
       connection using the Secure Shell (<literal>ssh</literal>)
       protocol.  To use this successfully, you may have to do a little
       bit of configuration on the client or server sides.</para>
 
-    <para>If you're not familiar with ssh, it's a network protocol
+    <para id="x_487">If you're not familiar with ssh, it's a network protocol
       that lets you securely communicate with another computer.  To
       use it with Mercurial, you'll be setting up one or more user
       accounts on a server so that remote users can log in and execute
       commands.</para>
 
-    <para>(If you <emphasis>are</emphasis> familiar with ssh, you'll
+    <para id="x_488">(If you <emphasis>are</emphasis> familiar with ssh, you'll
       probably find some of the material that follows to be elementary
       in nature.)</para>
 
     <sect2>
       <title>How to read and write ssh URLs</title>
 
-      <para>An ssh URL tends to look like this:</para>
+      <para id="x_489">An ssh URL tends to look like this:</para>
       <programlisting>ssh://bos@hg.serpentine.com:22/hg/hgbook</programlisting>
       <orderedlist>
-	<listitem><para>The <quote><literal>ssh://</literal></quote>
+	<listitem><para id="x_48a">The <quote><literal>ssh://</literal></quote>
 	    part tells Mercurial to use the ssh protocol.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>The <quote><literal>bos@</literal></quote>
+	<listitem><para id="x_48b">The <quote><literal>bos@</literal></quote>
 	    component indicates what username to log into the server
 	    as.  You can leave this out if the remote username is the
 	    same as your local username.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>The
+	<listitem><para id="x_48c">The
 	    <quote><literal>hg.serpentine.com</literal></quote> gives
 	    the hostname of the server to log into.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>The <quote>:22</quote> identifies the port
+	<listitem><para id="x_48d">The <quote>:22</quote> identifies the port
 	    number to connect to the server on.  The default port is
 	    22, so you only need to specify a colon and port number if
 	    you're <emphasis>not</emphasis> using port 22.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>The remainder of the URL is the local path to
+	<listitem><para id="x_48e">The remainder of the URL is the local path to
 	    the repository on the server.</para>
 	</listitem></orderedlist>
 
-      <para>There's plenty of scope for confusion with the path
+      <para id="x_48f">There's plenty of scope for confusion with the path
 	component of ssh URLs, as there is no standard way for tools
 	to interpret it.  Some programs behave differently than others
 	when dealing with these paths. This isn't an ideal situation,
 	but it's unlikely to change.  Please read the following
 	paragraphs carefully.</para>
 
-      <para>Mercurial treats the path to a repository on the server as
+      <para id="x_490">Mercurial treats the path to a repository on the server as
 	relative to the remote user's home directory.  For example, if
 	user <literal>foo</literal> on the server has a home directory
 	of <filename class="directory">/home/foo</filename>, then an
@@ -559,13 +559,13 @@
 	refers to the directory <filename
 	  class="directory">/home/foo/bar</filename>.</para>
 
-      <para>If you want to specify a path relative to another user's
+      <para id="x_491">If you want to specify a path relative to another user's
 	home directory, you can use a path that starts with a tilde
 	character followed by the user's name (let's call them
 	<literal>otheruser</literal>), like this.</para>
       <programlisting>ssh://server/~otheruser/hg/repo</programlisting>
 
-      <para>And if you really want to specify an
+      <para id="x_492">And if you really want to specify an
 	<emphasis>absolute</emphasis> path on the server, begin the
 	path component with two slashes, as in this example.</para>
       <programlisting>ssh://server//absolute/path</programlisting>
@@ -574,7 +574,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Finding an ssh client for your system</title>
 
-      <para>Almost every Unix-like system comes with OpenSSH
+      <para id="x_493">Almost every Unix-like system comes with OpenSSH
 	preinstalled.  If you're using such a system, run
 	<literal>which ssh</literal> to find out if the
 	<command>ssh</command> command is installed (it's usually in
@@ -582,17 +582,17 @@
 	unlikely event that it isn't present, take a look at your
 	system documentation to figure out how to install it.</para>
 
-      <para>On Windows, you'll first need to download a suitable ssh
+      <para id="x_494">On Windows, you'll first need to download a suitable ssh
 	client.  There are two alternatives.</para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para>Simon Tatham's excellent PuTTY package
+	<listitem><para id="x_495">Simon Tatham's excellent PuTTY package
 	    <citation>web:putty</citation> provides a complete suite
 	    of ssh client commands.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>If you have a high tolerance for pain, you can
+	<listitem><para id="x_496">If you have a high tolerance for pain, you can
 	    use the Cygwin port of OpenSSH.</para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
-      <para>In either case, you'll need to edit your <filename
+      <para id="x_497">In either case, you'll need to edit your <filename
       role="special">hg.ini</filename> file to
 	tell Mercurial where to find the actual client command.  For
 	example, if you're using PuTTY, you'll need to use the
@@ -602,7 +602,7 @@
 ssh = C:/path/to/plink.exe -ssh -i "C:/path/to/my/private/key"</programlisting>
 
       <note>
-	<para>  The path to <command>plink</command> shouldn't contain
+	<para id="x_498">  The path to <command>plink</command> shouldn't contain
 	  any whitespace characters, or Mercurial may not be able to
 	  run it correctly (so putting it in <filename
 	    class="directory">C:\Program Files</filename> is probably
@@ -613,7 +613,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Generating a key pair</title>
 
-      <para>To avoid the need to repetitively type a password every
+      <para id="x_499">To avoid the need to repetitively type a password every
 	time you need to use your ssh client, I recommend generating a
 	key pair.  On a Unix-like system, the
 	<command>ssh-keygen</command> command will do the trick. On
@@ -621,13 +621,13 @@
 	<command>puttygen</command> command is what you'll
 	need.</para>
 
-      <para>When you generate a key pair, it's usually
+      <para id="x_49a">When you generate a key pair, it's usually
 	<emphasis>highly</emphasis> advisable to protect it with a
 	passphrase.  (The only time that you might not want to do this
 	is when you're using the ssh protocol for automated tasks on a
 	secure network.)</para>
 
-      <para>Simply generating a key pair isn't enough, however.
+      <para id="x_49b">Simply generating a key pair isn't enough, however.
 	You'll need to add the public key to the set of authorised
 	keys for whatever user you're logging in remotely as.  For
 	servers using OpenSSH (the vast majority), this will mean
@@ -636,7 +636,7 @@
 	  role="special" class="directory">.ssh</filename>
 	directory.</para>
 
-      <para>On a Unix-like system, your public key will have a
+      <para id="x_49c">On a Unix-like system, your public key will have a
 	<filename>.pub</filename> extension.  If you're using
 	<command>puttygen</command> on Windows, you can save the
 	public key to a file of your choosing, or paste it from the
@@ -647,7 +647,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Using an authentication agent</title>
 
-      <para>An authentication agent is a daemon that stores
+      <para id="x_49d">An authentication agent is a daemon that stores
 	passphrases in memory (so it will forget passphrases if you
 	log out and log back in again). An ssh client will notice if
 	it's running, and query it for a passphrase.  If there's no
@@ -656,14 +656,14 @@
 	every time Mercurial tries to communicate with a server on
 	your behalf (e.g. whenever you pull or push changes).</para>
 
-      <para>The downside of storing passphrases in an agent is that
+      <para id="x_49e">The downside of storing passphrases in an agent is that
 	it's possible for a well-prepared attacker to recover the
 	plain text of your passphrases, in some cases even if your
 	system has been power-cycled. You should make your own
 	judgment as to whether this is an acceptable risk.  It
 	certainly saves a lot of repeated typing.</para>
 
-      <para>On Unix-like systems, the agent is called
+      <para id="x_49f">On Unix-like systems, the agent is called
 	<command>ssh-agent</command>, and it's often run automatically
 	for you when you log in.  You'll need to use the
 	<command>ssh-add</command> command to add passphrases to the
@@ -676,7 +676,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Configuring the server side properly</title>
 
-      <para>Because ssh can be fiddly to set up if you're new to it,
+      <para id="x_4a0">Because ssh can be fiddly to set up if you're new to it,
 	there's a variety of things that can go wrong.  Add Mercurial
 	on top, and there's plenty more scope for head-scratching.
 	Most of these potential problems occur on the server side, not
@@ -684,7 +684,7 @@
 	configuration working, it will usually continue to work
 	indefinitely.</para>
 
-      <para>Before you try using Mercurial to talk to an ssh server,
+      <para id="x_4a1">Before you try using Mercurial to talk to an ssh server,
 	it's best to make sure that you can use the normal
 	<command>ssh</command> or <command>putty</command> command to
 	talk to the server first.  If you run into problems with using
@@ -695,29 +695,29 @@
 	<emphasis>before</emphasis> you worry about whether there's a
 	problem with Mercurial.</para>
 
-      <para>The first thing to be sure of on the server side is that
+      <para id="x_4a2">The first thing to be sure of on the server side is that
 	you can actually log in from another machine at all.  If you
 	can't use <command>ssh</command> or <command>putty</command>
 	to log in, the error message you get may give you a few hints
 	as to what's wrong.  The most common problems are as
 	follows.</para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para>If you get a <quote>connection refused</quote>
+	<listitem><para id="x_4a3">If you get a <quote>connection refused</quote>
 	    error, either there isn't an SSH daemon running on the
 	    server at all, or it's inaccessible due to firewall
 	    configuration.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>If you get a <quote>no route to host</quote>
+	<listitem><para id="x_4a4">If you get a <quote>no route to host</quote>
 	    error, you either have an incorrect address for the server
 	    or a seriously locked down firewall that won't admit its
 	    existence at all.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>If you get a <quote>permission denied</quote>
+	<listitem><para id="x_4a5">If you get a <quote>permission denied</quote>
 	    error, you may have mistyped the username on the server,
 	    or you could have mistyped your key's passphrase or the
 	    remote user's password.</para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
-      <para>In summary, if you're having trouble talking to the
+      <para id="x_4a6">In summary, if you're having trouble talking to the
 	server's ssh daemon, first make sure that one is running at
 	all.  On many systems it will be installed, but disabled, by
 	default.  Once you're done with this step, you should then
@@ -727,23 +727,23 @@
 	for misconfiguration until you've checked these two
 	first.</para>
 
-      <para>If you're using an authentication agent on the client side
+      <para id="x_4a7">If you're using an authentication agent on the client side
 	to store passphrases for your keys, you ought to be able to
 	log into the server without being prompted for a passphrase or
 	a password.  If you're prompted for a passphrase, there are a
 	few possible culprits.</para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para>You might have forgotten to use
+	<listitem><para id="x_4a8">You might have forgotten to use
 	    <command>ssh-add</command> or <command>pageant</command>
 	    to store the passphrase.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>You might have stored the passphrase for the
+	<listitem><para id="x_4a9">You might have stored the passphrase for the
 	    wrong key.</para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
-      <para>If you're being prompted for the remote user's password,
+      <para id="x_4aa">If you're being prompted for the remote user's password,
 	there are another few possible problems to check.</para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para>Either the user's home directory or their
+	<listitem><para id="x_4ab">Either the user's home directory or their
 	    <filename role="special" class="directory">.ssh</filename>
 	    directory might have excessively liberal permissions.  As
 	    a result, the ssh daemon will not trust or read their
@@ -752,19 +752,19 @@
 	      role="special" class="directory">.ssh</filename>
 	    directory will often cause this symptom.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>The user's <filename
+	<listitem><para id="x_4ac">The user's <filename
 	      role="special">authorized_keys</filename> file may have
 	    a problem. If anyone other than the user owns or can write
 	    to that file, the ssh daemon will not trust or read
 	    it.</para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-      <para>In the ideal world, you should be able to run the
+      <para id="x_4ad">In the ideal world, you should be able to run the
 	following command successfully, and it should print exactly
 	one line of output, the current date and time.</para>
       <programlisting>ssh myserver date</programlisting>
 
-      <para>If, on your server, you have login scripts that print
+      <para id="x_4ae">If, on your server, you have login scripts that print
 	banners or other junk even when running non-interactive
 	commands like this, you should fix them before you continue,
 	so that they only print output if they're run interactively.
@@ -778,43 +778,43 @@
 	shell is to check the return code from the command
 	<literal>tty -s</literal>.)</para>
 
-      <para>Once you've verified that plain old ssh is working with
+      <para id="x_4af">Once you've verified that plain old ssh is working with
 	your server, the next step is to ensure that Mercurial runs on
 	the server.  The following command should run
 	successfully:</para>
 
       <programlisting>ssh myserver hg version</programlisting>
 
-      <para>If you see an error message instead of normal <command
+      <para id="x_4b0">If you see an error message instead of normal <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg version</command> output, this is usually
 	because you haven't installed Mercurial to <filename
 	  class="directory">/usr/bin</filename>.  Don't worry if this
 	is the case; you don't need to do that.  But you should check
 	for a few possible problems.</para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para>Is Mercurial really installed on the server at
+	<listitem><para id="x_4b1">Is Mercurial really installed on the server at
 	    all?  I know this sounds trivial, but it's worth
 	    checking!</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>Maybe your shell's search path (usually set
+	<listitem><para id="x_4b2">Maybe your shell's search path (usually set
 	    via the <envar>PATH</envar> environment variable) is
 	    simply misconfigured.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>Perhaps your <envar>PATH</envar> environment
+	<listitem><para id="x_4b3">Perhaps your <envar>PATH</envar> environment
 	    variable is only being set to point to the location of the
 	    <command>hg</command> executable if the login session is
 	    interactive.  This can happen if you're setting the path
 	    in the wrong shell login script.  See your shell's
 	    documentation for details.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>The <envar>PYTHONPATH</envar> environment
+	<listitem><para id="x_4b4">The <envar>PYTHONPATH</envar> environment
 	    variable may need to contain the path to the Mercurial
 	    Python modules.  It might not be set at all; it could be
 	    incorrect; or it may be set only if the login is
 	    interactive.</para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-      <para>If you can run <command role="hg-cmd">hg version</command>
+      <para id="x_4b5">If you can run <command role="hg-cmd">hg version</command>
 	over an ssh connection, well done! You've got the server and
 	client sorted out.  You should now be able to use Mercurial to
 	access repositories hosted by that username on that server.
@@ -826,19 +826,19 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Using compression with ssh</title>
 
-      <para>Mercurial does not compress data when it uses the ssh
+      <para id="x_4b6">Mercurial does not compress data when it uses the ssh
 	protocol, because the ssh protocol can transparently compress
 	data.  However, the default behaviour of ssh clients is
 	<emphasis>not</emphasis> to request compression.</para>
 
-      <para>Over any network other than a fast LAN (even a wireless
+      <para id="x_4b7">Over any network other than a fast LAN (even a wireless
 	network), using compression is likely to significantly speed
 	up Mercurial's network operations.  For example, over a WAN,
 	someone measured compression as reducing the amount of time
 	required to clone a particularly large repository from 51
 	minutes to 17 minutes.</para>
 
-      <para>Both <command>ssh</command> and <command>plink</command>
+      <para id="x_4b8">Both <command>ssh</command> and <command>plink</command>
 	accept a <option role="cmd-opt-ssh">-C</option> option which
 	turns on compression.  You can easily edit your <filename
 	  role="special">~/.hgrc</filename> to enable compression for
@@ -846,7 +846,7 @@
       <programlisting>[ui]
 ssh = ssh -C</programlisting>
 
-      <para>If you use <command>ssh</command>, you can configure it to
+      <para id="x_4b9">If you use <command>ssh</command>, you can configure it to
 	always use compression when talking to your server.  To do
 	this, edit your <filename
 	  role="special">.ssh/config</filename> file (which may not
@@ -854,7 +854,7 @@
       <programlisting>Host hg
   Compression yes
   HostName hg.example.com</programlisting>
-      <para>This defines an alias, <literal>hg</literal>.  When you
+      <para id="x_4ba">This defines an alias, <literal>hg</literal>.  When you
 	use it on the <command>ssh</command> command line or in a
 	Mercurial <literal>ssh</literal>-protocol URL, it will cause
 	<command>ssh</command> to connect to
@@ -867,17 +867,17 @@
   <sect1 id="sec:collab:cgi">
     <title>Serving over HTTP using CGI</title>
 
-    <para>Depending on how ambitious you are, configuring Mercurial's
+    <para id="x_4bb">Depending on how ambitious you are, configuring Mercurial's
       CGI interface can take anything from a few moments to several
       hours.</para>
 
-    <para>We'll begin with the simplest of examples, and work our way
+    <para id="x_4bc">We'll begin with the simplest of examples, and work our way
       towards a more complex configuration.  Even for the most basic
       case, you're almost certainly going to need to read and modify
       your web server's configuration.</para>
 
     <note>
-      <para>  Configuring a web server is a complex, fiddly, and
+      <para id="x_4bd">  Configuring a web server is a complex, fiddly, and
 	highly system-dependent activity.  I can't possibly give you
 	instructions that will cover anything like all of the cases
 	you will encounter. Please use your discretion and judgment in
@@ -889,25 +889,25 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Web server configuration checklist</title>
 
-      <para>Before you continue, do take a few moments to check a few
+      <para id="x_4be">Before you continue, do take a few moments to check a few
 	aspects of your system's setup.</para>
 
       <orderedlist>
-	<listitem><para>Do you have a web server installed at all?
+	<listitem><para id="x_4bf">Do you have a web server installed at all?
 	    Mac OS X ships with Apache, but many other systems may not
 	    have a web server installed.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>If you have a web server installed, is it
+	<listitem><para id="x_4c0">If you have a web server installed, is it
 	    actually running?  On most systems, even if one is
 	    present, it will be disabled by default.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>Is your server configured to allow you to run
+	<listitem><para id="x_4c1">Is your server configured to allow you to run
 	    CGI programs in the directory where you plan to do so?
 	    Most servers default to explicitly disabling the ability
 	    to run CGI programs.</para>
 	</listitem></orderedlist>
 
-      <para>If you don't have a web server installed, and don't have
+      <para id="x_4c2">If you don't have a web server installed, and don't have
 	substantial experience configuring Apache, you should consider
 	using the <literal>lighttpd</literal> web server instead of
 	Apache.  Apache has a well-deserved reputation for baroque and
@@ -922,7 +922,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Basic CGI configuration</title>
 
-      <para>On Unix-like systems, it's common for users to have a
+      <para id="x_4c3">On Unix-like systems, it's common for users to have a
 	subdirectory named something like <filename
 	  class="directory">public_html</filename> in their home
 	directory, from which they can serve up web pages.  A file
@@ -930,19 +930,19 @@
 	accessible at a URL of the form
 	<literal>http://www.example.com/username/foo</literal>.</para>
 
-      <para>To get started, find the <filename
+      <para id="x_4c4">To get started, find the <filename
 	  role="special">hgweb.cgi</filename> script that should be
 	present in your Mercurial installation.  If you can't quickly
 	find a local copy on your system, simply download one from the
 	master Mercurial repository at <ulink
 	  url="http://www.selenic.com/repo/hg/raw-file/tip/hgweb.cgi">http://www.selenic.com/repo/hg/raw-file/tip/hgweb.cgi</ulink>.</para>
 
-      <para>You'll need to copy this script into your <filename
+      <para id="x_4c5">You'll need to copy this script into your <filename
 	  class="directory">public_html</filename> directory, and
 	ensure that it's executable.</para>
       <programlisting>cp .../hgweb.cgi ~/public_html
 chmod 755 ~/public_html/hgweb.cgi</programlisting>
-      <para>The <literal>755</literal> argument to
+      <para id="x_4c6">The <literal>755</literal> argument to
 	<command>chmod</command> is a little more general than just
 	making the script executable: it ensures that the script is
 	executable by anyone, and that <quote>group</quote> and
@@ -959,7 +959,7 @@
 	<title>What could <emphasis>possibly</emphasis> go
 	  wrong?</title>
 
-	<para>Once you've copied the CGI script into place, go into a
+	<para id="x_4c7">Once you've copied the CGI script into place, go into a
 	  web browser, and try to open the URL <ulink
 	    url="http://myhostname/
 	    myuser/hgweb.cgi">http://myhostname/
@@ -973,7 +973,7 @@
 	  fresh installation of Apache, and a user account that I
 	  created specially to perform this exercise.</para>
 
-	<para>Your web server may have per-user directories disabled.
+	<para id="x_4c8">Your web server may have per-user directories disabled.
 	  If you're using Apache, search your config file for a
 	  <literal>UserDir</literal> directive.  If there's none
 	  present, per-user directories will be disabled.  If one
@@ -984,7 +984,7 @@
 	  directory, for example <filename
 	    class="directory">public_html</filename>.</para>
 
-	<para>Your file access permissions may be too restrictive.
+	<para id="x_4c9">Your file access permissions may be too restrictive.
 	  The web server must be able to traverse your home directory
 	  and directories under your <filename
 	    class="directory">public_html</filename> directory, and
@@ -994,34 +994,34 @@
 find ~/public_html -type d -print0 | xargs -0r chmod 755
 find ~/public_html -type f -print0 | xargs -0r chmod 644</programlisting>
 
-	<para>The other possibility with permissions is that you might
+	<para id="x_4ca">The other possibility with permissions is that you might
 	  get a completely empty window when you try to load the
 	  script.  In this case, it's likely that your access
 	  permissions are <emphasis>too permissive</emphasis>.  Apache's
 	  <literal>suexec</literal> subsystem won't execute a script
 	  that's group- or world-writable, for example.</para>
 
-	<para>Your web server may be configured to disallow execution
+	<para id="x_4cb">Your web server may be configured to disallow execution
 	  of CGI programs in your per-user web directory.  Here's
 	  Apache's default per-user configuration from my Fedora
 	  system.</para>
 
 	&ch06-apache-config.lst;
 
-	<para>If you find a similar-looking
+	<para id="x_4cc">If you find a similar-looking
 	  <literal>Directory</literal> group in your Apache
 	  configuration, the directive to look at inside it is
 	  <literal>Options</literal>. Add <literal>ExecCGI</literal>
 	  to the end of this list if it's missing, and restart the web
 	  server.</para>
 
-	<para>If you find that Apache serves you the text of the CGI
+	<para id="x_4cd">If you find that Apache serves you the text of the CGI
 	  script instead of executing it, you may need to either
 	  uncomment (if already present) or add a directive like
 	  this.</para>
 	<programlisting>AddHandler cgi-script .cgi</programlisting>
 
-	<para>The next possibility is that you might be served with a
+	<para id="x_4ce">The next possibility is that you might be served with a
 	  colourful Python backtrace claiming that it can't import a
 	  <literal>mercurial</literal>-related module.  This is
 	  actually progress!  The server is now capable of executing
@@ -1035,7 +1035,7 @@
 	  directions inside it to correctly set your
 	  <envar>PYTHONPATH</envar> environment variable.</para>
 
-	<para>Finally, you are <emphasis>certain</emphasis> to by
+	<para id="x_4cf">Finally, you are <emphasis>certain</emphasis> to by
 	  served with another colourful Python backtrace: this one
 	  will complain that it can't find <filename
 	    class="directory">/path/to/repository</filename>.  Edit
@@ -1045,7 +1045,7 @@
 	  with the complete path to the repository you want to serve
 	  up.</para>
 
-	<para>At this point, when you try to reload the page, you
+	<para id="x_4d0">At this point, when you try to reload the page, you
 	  should be presented with a nice HTML view of your
 	  repository's history.  Whew!</para>
 
@@ -1053,7 +1053,7 @@
       <sect3>
 	<title>Configuring lighttpd</title>
 
-	<para>To be exhaustive in my experiments, I tried configuring
+	<para id="x_4d1">To be exhaustive in my experiments, I tried configuring
 	  the increasingly popular <literal>lighttpd</literal> web
 	  server to serve the same repository as I described with
 	  Apache above.  I had already overcome all of the problems I
@@ -1063,7 +1063,7 @@
 	    role="special">hgweb.cgi</filename> script was properly
 	  edited.</para>
 
-	<para>Once I had Apache running, getting
+	<para id="x_4d2">Once I had Apache running, getting
 	  <literal>lighttpd</literal> to serve the repository was a
 	  snap (in other words, even if you're trying to use
 	  <literal>lighttpd</literal>, you should read the Apache
@@ -1075,7 +1075,7 @@
 	  end of the config file, to configure these modules.</para>
 	<programlisting>userdir.path = "public_html"
 cgi.assign = (".cgi" =&gt; "" )</programlisting>
-	<para>With this done, <literal>lighttpd</literal> ran
+	<para id="x_4d3">With this done, <literal>lighttpd</literal> ran
 	  immediately for me.  If I had configured
 	  <literal>lighttpd</literal> before Apache, I'd almost
 	  certainly have run into many of the same system-level
@@ -1090,7 +1090,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Sharing multiple repositories with one CGI script</title>
 
-      <para>The <filename role="special">hgweb.cgi</filename> script
+      <para id="x_4d4">The <filename role="special">hgweb.cgi</filename> script
 	only lets you publish a single repository, which is an
 	annoying restriction.  If you want to publish more than one
 	without wracking yourself with multiple copies of the same
@@ -1098,7 +1098,7 @@
 	the <filename role="special">hgwebdir.cgi</filename>
 	script.</para>
 
-      <para>The procedure to configure <filename
+      <para id="x_4d5">The procedure to configure <filename
 	  role="special">hgwebdir.cgi</filename> is only a little more
 	involved than for <filename
 	  role="special">hgweb.cgi</filename>.  First, you must obtain
@@ -1106,12 +1106,12 @@
 	download a copy from the master Mercurial repository at <ulink
 	  url="http://www.selenic.com/repo/hg/raw-file/tip/hgwebdir.cgi">http://www.selenic.com/repo/hg/raw-file/tip/hgwebdir.cgi</ulink>.</para>
 
-      <para>You'll need to copy this script into your <filename
+      <para id="x_4d6">You'll need to copy this script into your <filename
 	  class="directory">public_html</filename> directory, and
 	ensure that it's executable.</para>
       <programlisting>cp .../hgwebdir.cgi ~/public_html
 chmod 755 ~/public_html ~/public_html/hgwebdir.cgi</programlisting>
-      <para>With basic configuration out of the way, try to visit
+      <para id="x_4d7">With basic configuration out of the way, try to visit
 	<ulink url="http://myhostname/
 	  myuser/hgwebdir.cgi">http://myhostname/
 	  myuser/hgwebdir.cgi</ulink> in your browser.  It should
@@ -1120,7 +1120,7 @@
 	potential problems in section <xref
 	  linkend="sec:collab:wtf"/>.</para>
 
-      <para>The <filename role="special">hgwebdir.cgi</filename>
+      <para id="x_4d8">The <filename role="special">hgwebdir.cgi</filename>
 	script relies on an external configuration file.  By default,
 	it searches for a file named <filename
 	  role="special">hgweb.config</filename> in the same directory
@@ -1130,7 +1130,7 @@
 	<literal>ConfigParser</literal>
 	<citation>web:configparser</citation> module.</para>
 
-      <para>The easiest way to configure <filename
+      <para id="x_4d9">The easiest way to configure <filename
 	  role="special">hgwebdir.cgi</filename> is with a section
 	named <literal>collections</literal>.  This will automatically
 	publish <emphasis>every</emphasis> repository under the
@@ -1138,7 +1138,7 @@
 	this:</para>
       <programlisting>[collections]
 /my/root = /my/root</programlisting>
-      <para>Mercurial interprets this by looking at the directory name
+      <para id="x_4da">Mercurial interprets this by looking at the directory name
 	on the <emphasis>right</emphasis> hand side of the
 	<quote><literal>=</literal></quote> sign; finding repositories
 	in that directory hierarchy; and using the text on the
@@ -1147,7 +1147,7 @@
 	remaining component of a path after this stripping has
 	occurred is called a <quote>virtual path</quote>.</para>
 
-      <para>Given the example above, if we have a repository whose
+      <para id="x_4db">Given the example above, if we have a repository whose
 	local path is <filename
 	  class="directory">/my/root/this/repo</filename>, the CGI
 	script will strip the leading <filename
@@ -1161,7 +1161,7 @@
 	  myuser/hgwebdir.cgi/this/repo">http://myhostname/
 	  myuser/hgwebdir.cgi/this/repo</ulink>.</para>
 
-      <para>If we replace <filename
+      <para id="x_4dc">If we replace <filename
 	  class="directory">/my/root</filename> on the left hand side
 	of this example with <filename
 	  class="directory">/my</filename>, then <filename
@@ -1171,13 +1171,13 @@
 	  class="directory">root/this/repo</filename> instead of
 	<filename class="directory">this/repo</filename>.</para>
 
-      <para>The <filename role="special">hgwebdir.cgi</filename>
+      <para id="x_4dd">The <filename role="special">hgwebdir.cgi</filename>
 	script will recursively search each directory listed in the
 	<literal>collections</literal> section of its configuration
 	file, but it will <literal>not</literal> recurse into the
 	repositories it finds.</para>
 
-      <para>The <literal>collections</literal> mechanism makes it easy
+      <para id="x_4de">The <literal>collections</literal> mechanism makes it easy
 	to publish many repositories in a <quote>fire and
 	  forget</quote> manner.  You only need to set up the CGI
 	script and configuration file one time.  Afterwards, you can
@@ -1190,7 +1190,7 @@
 	<title>Explicitly specifying which repositories to
 	  publish</title>
 
-	<para>In addition to the <literal>collections</literal>
+	<para id="x_4df">In addition to the <literal>collections</literal>
 	  mechanism, the <filename
 	    role="special">hgwebdir.cgi</filename> script allows you
 	  to publish a specific list of repositories.  To do so,
@@ -1199,20 +1199,20 @@
 	<programlisting>[paths]
 repo1 = /my/path/to/some/repo
 repo2 = /some/path/to/another</programlisting>
-	<para>In this case, the virtual path (the component that will
+	<para id="x_4e0">In this case, the virtual path (the component that will
 	  appear in a URL) is on the left hand side of each
 	  definition, while the path to the repository is on the
 	  right.  Notice that there does not need to be any
 	  relationship between the virtual path you choose and the
 	  location of a repository in your filesystem.</para>
 
-	<para>If you wish, you can use both the
+	<para id="x_4e1">If you wish, you can use both the
 	  <literal>collections</literal> and <literal>paths</literal>
 	  mechanisms simultaneously in a single configuration
 	  file.</para>
 
 	<note>
-	  <para>  If multiple repositories have the same virtual path,
+	  <para id="x_4e2">  If multiple repositories have the same virtual path,
 	    <filename role="special">hgwebdir.cgi</filename> will not
 	    report an error.  Instead, it will behave
 	    unpredictably.</para>
@@ -1223,12 +1223,12 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Downloading source archives</title>
 
-      <para>Mercurial's web interface lets users download an archive
+      <para id="x_4e3">Mercurial's web interface lets users download an archive
 	of any revision.  This archive will contain a snapshot of the
 	working directory as of that revision, but it will not contain
 	a copy of the repository data.</para>
 
-      <para>By default, this feature is not enabled.  To enable it,
+      <para id="x_4e4">By default, this feature is not enabled.  To enable it,
 	you'll need to add an <envar
 	  role="rc-item-web">allow_archive</envar> item to the
 	<literal role="rc-web">web</literal> section of your <filename
@@ -1238,7 +1238,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Web configuration options</title>
 
-      <para>Mercurial's web interfaces (the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+      <para id="x_4e5">Mercurial's web interfaces (the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	  serve</command> command, and the <filename
 	  role="special">hgweb.cgi</filename> and <filename
 	  role="special">hgwebdir.cgi</filename> scripts) have a
@@ -1246,7 +1246,7 @@
 	belong in a section named <literal
 	  role="rc-web">web</literal>.</para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para><envar
+	<listitem><para id="x_4e6"><envar
 	      role="rc-item-web">allow_archive</envar>: Determines
 	    which (if any) archive download mechanisms Mercurial
 	    supports.  If you enable this feature, users of the web
@@ -1255,30 +1255,30 @@
 	    archive feature, this item must take the form of a
 	    sequence of words drawn from the list below.</para>
 	  <itemizedlist>
-	    <listitem><para><literal>bz2</literal>: A
+	    <listitem><para id="x_4e7"><literal>bz2</literal>: A
 		<command>tar</command> archive, compressed using
 		<literal>bzip2</literal> compression.  This has the
 		best compression ratio, but uses the most CPU time on
 		the server.</para>
 	    </listitem>
-	    <listitem><para><literal>gz</literal>: A
+	    <listitem><para id="x_4e8"><literal>gz</literal>: A
 		<command>tar</command> archive, compressed using
 		<literal>gzip</literal> compression.</para>
 	    </listitem>
-	    <listitem><para><literal>zip</literal>: A
+	    <listitem><para id="x_4e9"><literal>zip</literal>: A
 		<command>zip</command> archive, compressed using LZW
 		compression.  This format has the worst compression
 		ratio, but is widely used in the Windows world.</para>
 	    </listitem>
 	  </itemizedlist>
-	  <para>  If you provide an empty list, or don't have an
+	  <para id="x_4ea">  If you provide an empty list, or don't have an
 	    <envar role="rc-item-web">allow_archive</envar> entry at
 	    all, this feature will be disabled.  Here is an example of
 	    how to enable all three supported formats.</para>
 	  <programlisting>[web]
 allow_archive = bz2 gz zip</programlisting>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><envar role="rc-item-web">allowpull</envar>:
+	<listitem><para id="x_4eb"><envar role="rc-item-web">allowpull</envar>:
 	    Boolean.  Determines whether the web interface allows
 	    remote users to <command role="hg-cmd">hg pull</command>
 	    and <command role="hg-cmd">hg clone</command> this
@@ -1287,7 +1287,7 @@
 	    <quote>human-oriented</quote> portion of the web interface
 	    is available.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><envar role="rc-item-web">contact</envar>:
+	<listitem><para id="x_4ec"><envar role="rc-item-web">contact</envar>:
 	    String.  A free-form (but preferably brief) string
 	    identifying the person or group in charge of the
 	    repository.  This often contains the name and email
@@ -1298,21 +1298,21 @@
 	      role="special">~/.hgrc</filename> if every repository
 	    has a single maintainer.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><envar role="rc-item-web">maxchanges</envar>:
+	<listitem><para id="x_4ed"><envar role="rc-item-web">maxchanges</envar>:
 	    Integer.  The default maximum number of changesets to
 	    display in a single page of output.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><envar role="rc-item-web">maxfiles</envar>:
+	<listitem><para id="x_4ee"><envar role="rc-item-web">maxfiles</envar>:
 	    Integer.  The default maximum number of modified files to
 	    display in a single page of output.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><envar role="rc-item-web">stripes</envar>:
+	<listitem><para id="x_4ef"><envar role="rc-item-web">stripes</envar>:
 	    Integer.  If the web interface displays alternating
 	    <quote>stripes</quote> to make it easier to visually align
 	    rows when you are looking at a table, this number controls
 	    the number of rows in each stripe.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><envar role="rc-item-web">style</envar>:
+	<listitem><para id="x_4f0"><envar role="rc-item-web">style</envar>:
 	    Controls the template Mercurial uses to display the web
 	    interface.  Mercurial ships with two web templates, named
 	    <literal>default</literal> and <literal>gitweb</literal>
@@ -1324,12 +1324,12 @@
 	  <programlisting>[web]
 style = gitweb</programlisting>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><envar role="rc-item-web">templates</envar>:
+	<listitem><para id="x_4f1"><envar role="rc-item-web">templates</envar>:
 	    Path.  The directory in which to search for template
 	    files.  By default, Mercurial searches in the directory in
 	    which it was installed.</para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
-      <para>If you are using <filename
+      <para id="x_4f2">If you are using <filename
 	  role="special">hgwebdir.cgi</filename>, you can place a few
 	configuration items in a <literal role="rc-web">web</literal>
 	section of the <filename
@@ -1342,17 +1342,17 @@
       <sect3>
 	<title>Options specific to an individual repository</title>
 
-	<para>A few <literal role="rc-web">web</literal> configuration
+	<para id="x_4f3">A few <literal role="rc-web">web</literal> configuration
 	  items ought to be placed in a repository's local <filename
 	    role="special">.hg/hgrc</filename>, rather than a user's
 	  or global <filename role="special">~/.hgrc</filename>.</para>
 	<itemizedlist>
-	  <listitem><para><envar
+	  <listitem><para id="x_4f4"><envar
 		role="rc-item-web">description</envar>: String.  A
 	      free-form (but preferably brief) string that describes
 	      the contents or purpose of the repository.</para>
 	  </listitem>
-	  <listitem><para><envar role="rc-item-web">name</envar>:
+	  <listitem><para id="x_4f5"><envar role="rc-item-web">name</envar>:
 	      String.  The name to use for the repository in the web
 	      interface.  This overrides the default name, which is
 	      the last component of the repository's path.</para>
@@ -1363,13 +1363,13 @@
 	<title>Options specific to the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	    serve</command> command</title>
 
-	<para>Some of the items in the <literal
+	<para id="x_4f6">Some of the items in the <literal
 	    role="rc-web">web</literal> section of a <filename
 	    role="special">~/.hgrc</filename> file are only for use
 	  with the <command role="hg-cmd">hg serve</command>
 	  command.</para>
 	<itemizedlist>
-	  <listitem><para><envar role="rc-item-web">accesslog</envar>:
+	  <listitem><para id="x_4f7"><envar role="rc-item-web">accesslog</envar>:
 	      Path.  The name of a file into which to write an access
 	      log.  By default, the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 		serve</command> command writes this information to
@@ -1377,22 +1377,22 @@
 	      in the standard <quote>combined</quote> file format used
 	      by almost all web servers.</para>
 	  </listitem>
-	  <listitem><para><envar role="rc-item-web">address</envar>:
+	  <listitem><para id="x_4f8"><envar role="rc-item-web">address</envar>:
 	      String.  The local address on which the server should
 	      listen for incoming connections.  By default, the server
 	      listens on all addresses.</para>
 	  </listitem>
-	  <listitem><para><envar role="rc-item-web">errorlog</envar>:
+	  <listitem><para id="x_4f9"><envar role="rc-item-web">errorlog</envar>:
 	      Path.  The name of a file into which to write an error
 	      log.  By default, the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 		serve</command> command writes this information to
 	      standard error, not to a file.</para>
 	  </listitem>
-	  <listitem><para><envar role="rc-item-web">ipv6</envar>:
+	  <listitem><para id="x_4fa"><envar role="rc-item-web">ipv6</envar>:
 	      Boolean.  Whether to use the IPv6 protocol. By default,
 	      IPv6 is not used.</para>
 	  </listitem>
-	  <listitem><para><envar role="rc-item-web">port</envar>:
+	  <listitem><para id="x_4fb"><envar role="rc-item-web">port</envar>:
 	      Integer.  The TCP port number on which the server should
 	      listen.  The default port number used is 8000.</para>
 	  </listitem></itemizedlist>
@@ -1403,14 +1403,14 @@
 	    role="special">~/.hgrc</filename> file to add <literal
 	    role="rc-web">web</literal> items to</title>
 
-	<para>It is important to remember that a web server like
+	<para id="x_4fc">It is important to remember that a web server like
 	  Apache or <literal>lighttpd</literal> will run under a user
 	  ID that is different to yours. CGI scripts run by your
 	  server, such as <filename
 	    role="special">hgweb.cgi</filename>, will usually also run
 	  under that user ID.</para>
 
-	<para>If you add <literal role="rc-web">web</literal> items to
+	<para id="x_4fd">If you add <literal role="rc-web">web</literal> items to
 	  your own personal <filename role="special">~/.hgrc</filename> file, CGI scripts won't read that
 	  <filename role="special">~/.hgrc</filename> file.  Those
 	  settings will thus only affect the behaviour of the <command
--- a/en/ch06-filenames.xml	Thu Mar 19 20:54:12 2009 -0700
+++ b/en/ch06-filenames.xml	Thu Mar 19 21:18:52 2009 -0700
@@ -4,22 +4,22 @@
   <?dbhtml filename="file-names-and-pattern-matching.html"?>
   <title>File names and pattern matching</title>
 
-  <para>Mercurial provides mechanisms that let you work with file
+  <para id="x_543">Mercurial provides mechanisms that let you work with file
     names in a consistent and expressive way.</para>
 
   <sect1>
     <title>Simple file naming</title>
 
-    <para>Mercurial uses a unified piece of machinery <quote>under the
+    <para id="x_544">Mercurial uses a unified piece of machinery <quote>under the
 	hood</quote> to handle file names.  Every command behaves
       uniformly with respect to file names.  The way in which commands
       work with file names is as follows.</para>
 
-    <para>If you explicitly name real files on the command line,
+    <para id="x_545">If you explicitly name real files on the command line,
       Mercurial works with exactly those files, as you would expect.
       &interaction.filenames.files;</para>
 
-    <para>When you provide a directory name, Mercurial will interpret
+    <para id="x_546">When you provide a directory name, Mercurial will interpret
       this as <quote>operate on every file in this directory and its
 	subdirectories</quote>. Mercurial traverses the files and
       subdirectories in a directory in alphabetical order.  When it
@@ -32,18 +32,18 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Running commands without any file names</title>
 
-    <para>Mercurial's commands that work with file names have useful
+    <para id="x_547">Mercurial's commands that work with file names have useful
       default behaviours when you invoke them without providing any
       file names or patterns.  What kind of behaviour you should
       expect depends on what the command does.  Here are a few rules
       of thumb you can use to predict what a command is likely to do
       if you don't give it any names to work with.</para>
     <itemizedlist>
-      <listitem><para>Most commands will operate on the entire working
+      <listitem><para id="x_548">Most commands will operate on the entire working
 	  directory. This is what the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	    add</command> command does, for example.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>If the command has effects that are difficult or
+      <listitem><para id="x_549">If the command has effects that are difficult or
 	  impossible to reverse, it will force you to explicitly
 	  provide at least one name or pattern (see below).  This
 	  protects you from accidentally deleting files by running
@@ -51,7 +51,7 @@
 	  arguments, for example.</para>
       </listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-    <para>It's easy to work around these default behaviours if they
+    <para id="x_54a">It's easy to work around these default behaviours if they
       don't suit you.  If a command normally operates on the whole
       working directory, you can invoke it on just the current
       directory and its subdirectories by giving it the name
@@ -59,7 +59,7 @@
 
     &interaction.filenames.wdir-subdir;
 
-    <para>Along the same lines, some commands normally print file
+    <para id="x_54b">Along the same lines, some commands normally print file
       names relative to the root of the repository, even if you're
       invoking them from a subdirectory.  Such a command will print
       file names relative to your subdirectory if you give it explicit
@@ -75,21 +75,21 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Telling you what's going on</title>
 
-    <para>The <command role="hg-cmd">hg add</command> example in the
+    <para id="x_54c">The <command role="hg-cmd">hg add</command> example in the
       preceding section illustrates something else that's helpful
       about Mercurial commands.  If a command operates on a file that
       you didn't name explicitly on the command line, it will usually
       print the name of the file, so that you will not be surprised
       what's going on.</para>
 
-    <para>The principle here is of <emphasis>least
+    <para id="x_54d">The principle here is of <emphasis>least
 	surprise</emphasis>.  If you've exactly named a file on the
       command line, there's no point in repeating it back at you.  If
       Mercurial is acting on a file <emphasis>implicitly</emphasis>,
       because you provided no names, or a directory, or a pattern (see
       below), it's safest to tell you what it's doing.</para>
 
-    <para>For commands that behave this way, you can silence them
+    <para id="x_54e">For commands that behave this way, you can silence them
       using the <option role="hg-opt-global">-q</option> option.  You
       can also get them to print the name of every file, even those
       you've named explicitly, using the <option
@@ -99,39 +99,39 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Using patterns to identify files</title>
 
-    <para>In addition to working with file and directory names,
+    <para id="x_54f">In addition to working with file and directory names,
       Mercurial lets you use <emphasis>patterns</emphasis> to identify
       files.  Mercurial's pattern handling is expressive.</para>
 
-    <para>On Unix-like systems (Linux, MacOS, etc.), the job of
+    <para id="x_550">On Unix-like systems (Linux, MacOS, etc.), the job of
       matching file names to patterns normally falls to the shell.  On
       these systems, you must explicitly tell Mercurial that a name is
       a pattern.  On Windows, the shell does not expand patterns, so
       Mercurial will automatically identify names that are patterns,
       and expand them for you.</para>
 
-    <para>To provide a pattern in place of a regular name on the
+    <para id="x_551">To provide a pattern in place of a regular name on the
       command line, the mechanism is simple:</para>
     <programlisting>syntax:patternbody</programlisting>
-    <para>That is, a pattern is identified by a short text string that
+    <para id="x_552">That is, a pattern is identified by a short text string that
       says what kind of pattern this is, followed by a colon, followed
       by the actual pattern.</para>
 
-    <para>Mercurial supports two kinds of pattern syntax.  The most
+    <para id="x_553">Mercurial supports two kinds of pattern syntax.  The most
       frequently used is called <literal>glob</literal>; this is the
       same kind of pattern matching used by the Unix shell, and should
       be familiar to Windows command prompt users, too.</para>
 
-    <para>When Mercurial does automatic pattern matching on Windows,
+    <para id="x_554">When Mercurial does automatic pattern matching on Windows,
       it uses <literal>glob</literal> syntax.  You can thus omit the
       <quote><literal>glob:</literal></quote> prefix on Windows, but
       it's safe to use it, too.</para>
 
-    <para>The <literal>re</literal> syntax is more powerful; it lets
+    <para id="x_555">The <literal>re</literal> syntax is more powerful; it lets
       you specify patterns using regular expressions, also known as
       regexps.</para>
 
-    <para>By the way, in the examples that follow, notice that I'm
+    <para id="x_556">By the way, in the examples that follow, notice that I'm
       careful to wrap all of my patterns in quote characters, so that
       they won't get expanded by the shell before Mercurial sees
       them.</para>
@@ -139,27 +139,27 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Shell-style <literal>glob</literal> patterns</title>
 
-      <para>This is an overview of the kinds of patterns you can use
+      <para id="x_557">This is an overview of the kinds of patterns you can use
 	when you're matching on glob patterns.</para>
 
-      <para>The <quote><literal>*</literal></quote> character matches
+      <para id="x_558">The <quote><literal>*</literal></quote> character matches
 	any string, within a single directory.</para>
 
       &interaction.filenames.glob.star;
 
-      <para>The <quote><literal>**</literal></quote> pattern matches
+      <para id="x_559">The <quote><literal>**</literal></quote> pattern matches
 	any string, and crosses directory boundaries.  It's not a
 	standard Unix glob token, but it's accepted by several popular
 	Unix shells, and is very useful.</para>
 
       &interaction.filenames.glob.starstar;
 
-      <para>The <quote><literal>?</literal></quote> pattern matches
+      <para id="x_55a">The <quote><literal>?</literal></quote> pattern matches
 	any single character.</para>
 
       &interaction.filenames.glob.question;
 
-      <para>The <quote><literal>[</literal></quote> character begins a
+      <para id="x_55b">The <quote><literal>[</literal></quote> character begins a
 	<emphasis>character class</emphasis>.  This matches any single
 	character within the class.  The class ends with a
 	<quote><literal>]</literal></quote> character.  A class may
@@ -169,13 +169,13 @@
 
 	&interaction.filenames.glob.range;
 
-      <para>If the first character after the
+      <para id="x_55c">If the first character after the
 	<quote><literal>[</literal></quote> in a character class is a
 	<quote><literal>!</literal></quote>, it
 	<emphasis>negates</emphasis> the class, making it match any
 	single character not in the class.</para>
 
-      <para>A <quote><literal>{</literal></quote> begins a group of
+      <para id="x_55d">A <quote><literal>{</literal></quote> begins a group of
 	subpatterns, where the whole group matches if any subpattern
 	in the group matches.  The <quote><literal>,</literal></quote>
 	character separates subpatterns, and
@@ -186,7 +186,7 @@
       <sect3>
 	<title>Watch out!</title>
 
-	<para>Don't forget that if you want to match a pattern in any
+	<para id="x_55e">Don't forget that if you want to match a pattern in any
 	  directory, you should not be using the
 	  <quote><literal>*</literal></quote> match-any token, as this
 	  will only match within one directory.  Instead, use the
@@ -201,27 +201,27 @@
       <title>Regular expression matching with <literal>re</literal>
 	patterns</title>
 
-      <para>Mercurial accepts the same regular expression syntax as
+      <para id="x_55f">Mercurial accepts the same regular expression syntax as
 	the Python programming language (it uses Python's regexp
 	engine internally). This is based on the Perl language's
 	regexp syntax, which is the most popular dialect in use (it's
 	also used in Java, for example).</para>
 
-      <para>I won't discuss Mercurial's regexp dialect in any detail
+      <para id="x_560">I won't discuss Mercurial's regexp dialect in any detail
 	here, as regexps are not often used.  Perl-style regexps are
 	in any case already exhaustively documented on a multitude of
 	web sites, and in many books.  Instead, I will focus here on a
 	few things you should know if you find yourself needing to use
 	regexps with Mercurial.</para>
 
-      <para>A regexp is matched against an entire file name, relative
+      <para id="x_561">A regexp is matched against an entire file name, relative
 	to the root of the repository.  In other words, even if you're
 	already in subbdirectory <filename
 	  class="directory">foo</filename>, if you want to match files
 	under this directory, your pattern must start with
 	<quote><literal>foo/</literal></quote>.</para>
 
-      <para>One thing to note, if you're familiar with Perl-style
+      <para id="x_562">One thing to note, if you're familiar with Perl-style
 	regexps, is that Mercurial's are <emphasis>rooted</emphasis>.
 	That is, a regexp starts matching against the beginning of a
 	string; it doesn't look for a match anywhere within the
@@ -233,35 +233,35 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Filtering files</title>
 
-    <para>Not only does Mercurial give you a variety of ways to
+    <para id="x_563">Not only does Mercurial give you a variety of ways to
       specify files; it lets you further winnow those files using
       <emphasis>filters</emphasis>.  Commands that work with file
       names accept two filtering options.</para>
     <itemizedlist>
-      <listitem><para><option role="hg-opt-global">-I</option>, or
+      <listitem><para id="x_564"><option role="hg-opt-global">-I</option>, or
 	  <option role="hg-opt-global">--include</option>, lets you
 	  specify a pattern that file names must match in order to be
 	  processed.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><option role="hg-opt-global">-X</option>, or
+      <listitem><para id="x_565"><option role="hg-opt-global">-X</option>, or
 	  <option role="hg-opt-global">--exclude</option>, gives you a
 	  way to <emphasis>avoid</emphasis> processing files, if they
 	  match this pattern.</para>
       </listitem></itemizedlist>
-    <para>You can provide multiple <option
+    <para id="x_566">You can provide multiple <option
 	role="hg-opt-global">-I</option> and <option
 	role="hg-opt-global">-X</option> options on the command line,
       and intermix them as you please.  Mercurial interprets the
       patterns you provide using glob syntax by default (but you can
       use regexps if you need to).</para>
 
-    <para>You can read a <option role="hg-opt-global">-I</option>
+    <para id="x_567">You can read a <option role="hg-opt-global">-I</option>
       filter as <quote>process only the files that match this
 	filter</quote>.</para>
 
     &interaction.filenames.filter.include;
 
-    <para>The <option role="hg-opt-global">-X</option> filter is best
+    <para id="x_568">The <option role="hg-opt-global">-X</option> filter is best
       read as <quote>process only the files that don't match this
 	pattern</quote>.</para>
 
@@ -271,13 +271,13 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Ignoring unwanted files and directories</title>
 
-    <para>XXX.</para>
+    <para id="x_569">XXX.</para>
 
   </sect1>
   <sect1 id="sec:names:case">
     <title>Case sensitivity</title>
 
-    <para>If you're working in a mixed development environment that
+    <para id="x_56a">If you're working in a mixed development environment that
       contains both Linux (or other Unix) systems and Macs or Windows
       systems, you should keep in the back of your mind the knowledge
       that they treat the case (<quote>N</quote> versus
@@ -286,17 +286,17 @@
       does, but it could surprise you if you don't know about
       it.</para>
 
-    <para>Operating systems and filesystems differ in the way they
+    <para id="x_56b">Operating systems and filesystems differ in the way they
       handle the <emphasis>case</emphasis> of characters in file and
       directory names.  There are three common ways to handle case in
       names.</para>
     <itemizedlist>
-      <listitem><para>Completely case insensitive.  Uppercase and
+      <listitem><para id="x_56c">Completely case insensitive.  Uppercase and
 	  lowercase versions of a letter are treated as identical,
 	  both when creating a file and during subsequent accesses.
 	  This is common on older DOS-based systems.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>Case preserving, but insensitive.  When a file
+      <listitem><para id="x_56d">Case preserving, but insensitive.  When a file
 	  or directory is created, the case of its name is stored, and
 	  can be retrieved and displayed by the operating system.
 	  When an existing file is being looked up, its case is
@@ -307,13 +307,13 @@
 	  interchangeable is also referred to as <emphasis>case
 	    folding</emphasis>.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>Case sensitive.  The case of a name is
+      <listitem><para id="x_56e">Case sensitive.  The case of a name is
 	  significant at all times. The names <filename>foo</filename>
 	  and {FoO} identify different files.  This is the way Linux
 	  and Unix systems normally work.</para>
       </listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-    <para>On Unix-like systems, it is possible to have any or all of
+    <para id="x_56f">On Unix-like systems, it is possible to have any or all of
       the above ways of handling case in action at once.  For example,
       if you use a USB thumb drive formatted with a FAT32 filesystem
       on a Linux system, Linux will handle names on that filesystem in
@@ -322,7 +322,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Safe, portable repository storage</title>
 
-      <para>Mercurial's repository storage mechanism is <emphasis>case
+      <para id="x_570">Mercurial's repository storage mechanism is <emphasis>case
 	  safe</emphasis>.  It translates file names so that they can
 	be safely stored on both case sensitive and case insensitive
 	filesystems.  This means that you can use normal file copying
@@ -335,13 +335,13 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Detecting case conflicts</title>
 
-      <para>When operating in the working directory, Mercurial honours
+      <para id="x_571">When operating in the working directory, Mercurial honours
 	the naming policy of the filesystem where the working
 	directory is located.  If the filesystem is case preserving,
 	but insensitive, Mercurial will treat names that differ only
 	in case as the same.</para>
 
-      <para>An important aspect of this approach is that it is
+      <para id="x_572">An important aspect of this approach is that it is
 	possible to commit a changeset on a case sensitive (typically
 	Linux or Unix) filesystem that will cause trouble for users on
 	case insensitive (usually Windows and MacOS) users.  If a
@@ -352,7 +352,7 @@
 	Linux users, they will be correctly represented as separate
 	files.</para>
 
-      <para>If a Windows or Mac user pulls this change, they will not
+      <para id="x_573">If a Windows or Mac user pulls this change, they will not
 	initially have a problem, because Mercurial's repository
 	storage mechanism is case safe.  However, once they try to
 	<command role="hg-cmd">hg update</command> the working
@@ -366,14 +366,14 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Fixing a case conflict</title>
 
-      <para>If you are using Windows or a Mac in a mixed environment
+      <para id="x_574">If you are using Windows or a Mac in a mixed environment
 	where some of your collaborators are using Linux or Unix, and
 	Mercurial reports a case folding conflict when you try to
 	<command role="hg-cmd">hg update</command> or <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg merge</command>, the procedure to fix the
 	problem is simple.</para>
 
-      <para>Just find a nearby Linux or Unix box, clone the problem
+      <para id="x_575">Just find a nearby Linux or Unix box, clone the problem
 	repository onto it, and use Mercurial's <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg rename</command> command to change the
 	names of any offending files or directories so that they will
@@ -383,14 +383,14 @@
 	MacOS system, and <command role="hg-cmd">hg update</command>
 	to the revision with the non-conflicting names.</para>
 
-      <para>The changeset with case-conflicting names will remain in
+      <para id="x_576">The changeset with case-conflicting names will remain in
 	your project's history, and you still won't be able to
 	<command role="hg-cmd">hg update</command> your working
 	directory to that changeset on a Windows or MacOS system, but
 	you can continue development unimpeded.</para>
 
       <note>
-	<para>  Prior to version 0.9.3, Mercurial did not use a case
+	<para id="x_577">  Prior to version 0.9.3, Mercurial did not use a case
 	  safe repository storage mechanism, and did not detect case
 	  folding conflicts.  If you are using an older version of
 	  Mercurial on Windows or MacOS, I strongly recommend that you
--- a/en/ch07-branch.xml	Thu Mar 19 20:54:12 2009 -0700
+++ b/en/ch07-branch.xml	Thu Mar 19 21:18:52 2009 -0700
@@ -4,18 +4,18 @@
   <?dbhtml filename="managing-releases-and-branchy-development.html"?>
   <title>Managing releases and branchy development</title>
 
-  <para>Mercurial provides several mechanisms for you to manage a
+  <para id="x_369">Mercurial provides several mechanisms for you to manage a
     project that is making progress on multiple fronts at once.  To
     understand these mechanisms, let's first take a brief look at a
     fairly normal software project structure.</para>
 
-  <para>Many software projects issue periodic <quote>major</quote>
+  <para id="x_36a">Many software projects issue periodic <quote>major</quote>
     releases that contain substantial new features.  In parallel, they
     may issue <quote>minor</quote> releases.  These are usually
     identical to the major releases off which they're based, but with
     a few bugs fixed.</para>
 
-  <para>In this chapter, we'll start by talking about how to keep
+  <para id="x_36b">In this chapter, we'll start by talking about how to keep
     records of project milestones such as releases.  We'll then
     continue on to talk about the flow of work between different
     phases of a project, and how Mercurial can help you to isolate and
@@ -24,20 +24,20 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Giving a persistent name to a revision</title>
 
-    <para>Once you decide that you'd like to call a particular
+    <para id="x_36c">Once you decide that you'd like to call a particular
       revision a <quote>release</quote>, it's a good idea to record
       the identity of that revision. This will let you reproduce that
       release at a later date, for whatever purpose you might need at
       the time (reproducing a bug, porting to a new platform, etc).
       &interaction.tag.init;</para>
 
-    <para>Mercurial lets you give a permanent name to any revision
+    <para id="x_36d">Mercurial lets you give a permanent name to any revision
       using the <command role="hg-cmd">hg tag</command> command.  Not
       surprisingly, these names are called <quote>tags</quote>.</para>
 
     &interaction.tag.tag;
 
-    <para>A tag is nothing more than a <quote>symbolic name</quote>
+    <para id="x_36e">A tag is nothing more than a <quote>symbolic name</quote>
       for a revision.  Tags exist purely for your convenience, so that
       you have a handy permanent way to refer to a revision; Mercurial
       doesn't interpret the tag names you use in any way.  Neither
@@ -46,17 +46,17 @@
       parsed unambiguously.  A tag name cannot contain any of the
       following characters:</para>
     <itemizedlist>
-      <listitem><para>Colon (ASCII 58,
+      <listitem><para id="x_36f">Colon (ASCII 58,
 	  <quote><literal>:</literal></quote>)</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>Carriage return (ASCII 13,
+      <listitem><para id="x_370">Carriage return (ASCII 13,
 	  <quote><literal>\r</literal></quote>)</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>Newline (ASCII 10,
+      <listitem><para id="x_371">Newline (ASCII 10,
 	  <quote><literal>\n</literal></quote>)</para>
       </listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-    <para>You can use the <command role="hg-cmd">hg tags</command>
+    <para id="x_372">You can use the <command role="hg-cmd">hg tags</command>
       command to display the tags present in your repository.  In the
       output, each tagged revision is identified first by its name,
       then by revision number, and finally by the unique hash of the
@@ -64,33 +64,33 @@
 
     &interaction.tag.tags;
 
-    <para>Notice that <literal>tip</literal> is listed in the output
+    <para id="x_373">Notice that <literal>tip</literal> is listed in the output
       of <command role="hg-cmd">hg tags</command>.  The
       <literal>tip</literal> tag is a special <quote>floating</quote>
       tag, which always identifies the newest revision in the
       repository.</para>
 
-    <para>In the output of the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+    <para id="x_374">In the output of the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	tags</command> command, tags are listed in reverse order, by
       revision number.  This usually means that recent tags are listed
       before older tags.  It also means that <literal>tip</literal> is
       always going to be the first tag listed in the output of
       <command role="hg-cmd">hg tags</command>.</para>
 
-    <para>When you run <command role="hg-cmd">hg log</command>, if it
+    <para id="x_375">When you run <command role="hg-cmd">hg log</command>, if it
       displays a revision that has tags associated with it, it will
       print those tags.</para>
 
     &interaction.tag.log;
 
-    <para>Any time you need to provide a revision ID to a Mercurial
+    <para id="x_376">Any time you need to provide a revision ID to a Mercurial
       command, the command will accept a tag name in its place.
       Internally, Mercurial will translate your tag name into the
       corresponding revision ID, then use that.</para>
 
     &interaction.tag.log.v1.0;
 
-    <para>There's no limit on the number of tags you can have in a
+    <para id="x_377">There's no limit on the number of tags you can have in a
       repository, or on the number of tags that a single revision can
       have.  As a practical matter, it's not a great idea to have
       <quote>too many</quote> (a number which will vary from project
@@ -98,7 +98,7 @@
       find revisions.  If you have lots of tags, the ease of using
       them to identify revisions diminishes rapidly.</para>
 
-    <para>For example, if your project has milestones as frequent as
+    <para id="x_378">For example, if your project has milestones as frequent as
       every few days, it's perfectly reasonable to tag each one of
       those.  But if you have a continuous build system that makes
       sure every revision can be built cleanly, you'd be introducing a
@@ -106,12 +106,12 @@
       could tag failed builds (on the assumption that they're rare!),
       or simply not use tags to track buildability.</para>
 
-    <para>If you want to remove a tag that you no longer want, use
+    <para id="x_379">If you want to remove a tag that you no longer want, use
       <command role="hg-cmd">hg tag --remove</command>.</para>
 
     &interaction.tag.remove;
 
-    <para>You can also modify a tag at any time, so that it identifies
+    <para id="x_37a">You can also modify a tag at any time, so that it identifies
       a different revision, by simply issuing a new <command
 	role="hg-cmd">hg tag</command> command. You'll have to use the
       <option role="hg-opt-tag">-f</option> option to tell Mercurial
@@ -120,13 +120,13 @@
 
     &interaction.tag.replace;
 
-    <para>There will still be a permanent record of the previous
+    <para id="x_37b">There will still be a permanent record of the previous
       identity of the tag, but Mercurial will no longer use it.
       There's thus no penalty to tagging the wrong revision; all you
       have to do is turn around and tag the correct revision once you
       discover your error.</para>
 
-    <para>Mercurial stores tags in a normal revision-controlled file
+    <para id="x_37c">Mercurial stores tags in a normal revision-controlled file
       in your repository.  If you've created any tags, you'll find
       them in a file named <filename
 	role="special">.hgtags</filename>.  When you run the <command
@@ -141,14 +141,14 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Handling tag conflicts during a merge</title>
 
-      <para>You won't often need to care about the <filename
+      <para id="x_37d">You won't often need to care about the <filename
 	  role="special">.hgtags</filename> file, but it sometimes
 	makes its presence known during a merge.  The format of the
 	file is simple: it consists of a series of lines.  Each line
 	starts with a changeset hash, followed by a space, followed by
 	the name of a tag.</para>
 
-      <para>If you're resolving a conflict in the <filename
+      <para id="x_37e">If you're resolving a conflict in the <filename
 	  role="special">.hgtags</filename> file during a merge,
 	there's one twist to modifying the <filename
 	  role="special">.hgtags</filename> file: when Mercurial is
@@ -158,7 +158,7 @@
 	reads the <emphasis>most recently committed</emphasis>
 	revision of the file.</para>
 
-      <para>An unfortunate consequence of this design is that you
+      <para id="x_37f">An unfortunate consequence of this design is that you
 	can't actually verify that your merged <filename
 	  role="special">.hgtags</filename> file is correct until
 	<emphasis>after</emphasis> you've committed a change.  So if
@@ -175,7 +175,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Tags and cloning</title>
 
-      <para>You may have noticed that the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+      <para id="x_380">You may have noticed that the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	  clone</command> command has a <option
 	  role="hg-opt-clone">-r</option> option that lets you clone
 	an exact copy of the repository as of a particular changeset.
@@ -183,7 +183,7 @@
 	after the revision you specified.  This has an interaction
 	with tags that can surprise the unwary.</para>
 
-      <para>Recall that a tag is stored as a revision to the <filename
+      <para id="x_381">Recall that a tag is stored as a revision to the <filename
 	  role="special">.hgtags</filename> file, so that when you
 	create a tag, the changeset in which it's recorded necessarily
 	refers to an older changeset.  When you run <command
@@ -200,7 +200,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>When permanent tags are too much</title>
 
-      <para>Since Mercurial's tags are revision controlled and carried
+      <para id="x_382">Since Mercurial's tags are revision controlled and carried
 	around with a project's history, everyone you work with will
 	see the tags you create.  But giving names to revisions has
 	uses beyond simply noting that revision
@@ -210,7 +210,7 @@
 	like <quote>Anne saw the symptoms with this
 	  revision</quote>.</para>
 
-      <para>For cases like this, what you might want to use are
+      <para id="x_383">For cases like this, what you might want to use are
 	<emphasis>local</emphasis> tags. You can create a local tag
 	with the <option role="hg-opt-tag">-l</option> option to the
 	<command role="hg-cmd">hg tag</command> command.  This will
@@ -227,27 +227,27 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>The flow of changes&emdash;big picture vs. little</title>
 
-    <para>To return to the outline I sketched at the beginning of a
+    <para id="x_384">To return to the outline I sketched at the beginning of a
       chapter, let's think about a project that has multiple
       concurrent pieces of work under development at once.</para>
 
-    <para>There might be a push for a new <quote>main</quote> release;
+    <para id="x_385">There might be a push for a new <quote>main</quote> release;
       a new minor bugfix release to the last main release; and an
       unexpected <quote>hot fix</quote> to an old release that is now
       in maintenance mode.</para>
 
-    <para>The usual way people refer to these different concurrent
+    <para id="x_386">The usual way people refer to these different concurrent
       directions of development is as <quote>branches</quote>.
       However, we've already seen numerous times that Mercurial treats
       <emphasis>all of history</emphasis> as a series of branches and
       merges.  Really, what we have here is two ideas that are
       peripherally related, but which happen to share a name.</para>
     <itemizedlist>
-      <listitem><para><quote>Big picture</quote> branches represent
+      <listitem><para id="x_387"><quote>Big picture</quote> branches represent
 	  the sweep of a project's evolution; people give them names,
 	  and talk about them in conversation.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><quote>Little picture</quote> branches are
+      <listitem><para id="x_388"><quote>Little picture</quote> branches are
 	  artefacts of the day-to-day activity of developing and
 	  merging changes.  They expose the narrative of how the code
 	  was developed.</para>
@@ -257,7 +257,7 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Managing big-picture branches in repositories</title>
 
-    <para>The easiest way to isolate a <quote>big picture</quote>
+    <para id="x_389">The easiest way to isolate a <quote>big picture</quote>
       branch in Mercurial is in a dedicated repository.  If you have
       an existing shared repository&emdash;let's call it
       <literal>myproject</literal>&emdash;that reaches a
@@ -267,20 +267,20 @@
 
     &interaction.branch-repo.tag;
 
-    <para>You can then clone a new shared
+    <para id="x_38a">You can then clone a new shared
       <literal>myproject-1.0.1</literal> repository as of that
       tag.</para>
 
     &interaction.branch-repo.clone;
 
-    <para>Afterwards, if someone needs to work on a bug fix that ought
+    <para id="x_38b">Afterwards, if someone needs to work on a bug fix that ought
       to go into an upcoming 1.0.1 minor release, they clone the
       <literal>myproject-1.0.1</literal> repository, make their
       changes, and push them back.</para>
 
     &interaction.branch-repo.bugfix;
 
-    <para>Meanwhile, development for
+    <para id="x_38c">Meanwhile, development for
       the next major release can continue, isolated and unabated, in
       the <literal>myproject</literal> repository.</para>
 
@@ -290,7 +290,7 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Don't repeat yourself: merging across branches</title>
 
-    <para>In many cases, if you have a bug to fix on a maintenance
+    <para id="x_38d">In many cases, if you have a bug to fix on a maintenance
       branch, the chances are good that the bug exists on your
       project's main branch (and possibly other maintenance branches,
       too).  It's a rare developer who wants to fix the same bug
@@ -298,13 +298,13 @@
       help you to manage these bugfixes without duplicating your
       work.</para>
 
-    <para>In the simplest instance, all you need to do is pull changes
+    <para id="x_38e">In the simplest instance, all you need to do is pull changes
       from your maintenance branch into your local clone of the target
       branch.</para>
 
     &interaction.branch-repo.pull;
 
-    <para>You'll then need to merge the heads of the two branches, and
+    <para id="x_38f">You'll then need to merge the heads of the two branches, and
       push back to the main branch.</para>
 
     &interaction.branch-repo.merge;
@@ -313,14 +313,14 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Naming branches within one repository</title>
 
-    <para>In most instances, isolating branches in repositories is the
+    <para id="x_390">In most instances, isolating branches in repositories is the
       right approach.  Its simplicity makes it easy to understand; and
       so it's hard to make mistakes.  There's a one-to-one
       relationship between branches you're working in and directories
       on your system.  This lets you use normal (non-Mercurial-aware)
       tools to work on files within a branch/repository.</para>
 
-    <para>If you're more in the <quote>power user</quote> category
+    <para id="x_391">If you're more in the <quote>power user</quote> category
       (<emphasis>and</emphasis> your collaborators are too), there is
       an alternative way of handling branches that you can consider.
       I've already mentioned the human-level distinction between
@@ -331,58 +331,58 @@
       it can <emphasis>also</emphasis> work with multiple <quote>big
 	picture</quote> branches.</para>
 
-    <para>The key to working this way is that Mercurial lets you
+    <para id="x_392">The key to working this way is that Mercurial lets you
       assign a persistent <emphasis>name</emphasis> to a branch.
       There always exists a branch named <literal>default</literal>.
       Even before you start naming branches yourself, you can find
       traces of the <literal>default</literal> branch if you look for
       them.</para>
 
-    <para>As an example, when you run the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+    <para id="x_393">As an example, when you run the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	commit</command> command, and it pops up your editor so that
       you can enter a commit message, look for a line that contains
       the text <quote><literal>HG: branch default</literal></quote> at
       the bottom. This is telling you that your commit will occur on
       the branch named <literal>default</literal>.</para>
 
-    <para>To start working with named branches, use the <command
+    <para id="x_394">To start working with named branches, use the <command
 	role="hg-cmd">hg branches</command> command.  This command
       lists the named branches already present in your repository,
       telling you which changeset is the tip of each.</para>
 
     &interaction.branch-named.branches;
 
-    <para>Since you haven't created any named branches yet, the only
+    <para id="x_395">Since you haven't created any named branches yet, the only
       one that exists is <literal>default</literal>.</para>
 
-    <para>To find out what the <quote>current</quote> branch is, run
+    <para id="x_396">To find out what the <quote>current</quote> branch is, run
       the <command role="hg-cmd">hg branch</command> command, giving
       it no arguments.  This tells you what branch the parent of the
       current changeset is on.</para>
 
     &interaction.branch-named.branch;
 
-    <para>To create a new branch, run the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+    <para id="x_397">To create a new branch, run the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	branch</command> command again.  This time, give it one
       argument: the name of the branch you want to create.</para>
 
     &interaction.branch-named.create;
 
-    <para>After you've created a branch, you might wonder what effect
+    <para id="x_398">After you've created a branch, you might wonder what effect
       the <command role="hg-cmd">hg branch</command> command has had.
       What do the <command role="hg-cmd">hg status</command> and
       <command role="hg-cmd">hg tip</command> commands report?</para>
 
     &interaction.branch-named.status;
 
-    <para>Nothing has changed in the
+    <para id="x_399">Nothing has changed in the
       working directory, and there's been no new history created.  As
       this suggests, running the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	branch</command> command has no permanent effect; it only
       tells Mercurial what branch name to use the
       <emphasis>next</emphasis> time you commit a changeset.</para>
 
-    <para>When you commit a change, Mercurial records the name of the
+    <para id="x_39a">When you commit a change, Mercurial records the name of the
       branch on which you committed.  Once you've switched from the
       <literal>default</literal> branch to another and committed,
       you'll see the name of the new branch show up in the output of
@@ -392,12 +392,12 @@
 
     &interaction.branch-named.commit;
 
-    <para>The <command role="hg-cmd">hg log</command>-like commands
+    <para id="x_39b">The <command role="hg-cmd">hg log</command>-like commands
       will print the branch name of every changeset that's not on the
       <literal>default</literal> branch.  As a result, if you never
       use named branches, you'll never see this information.</para>
 
-    <para>Once you've named a branch and committed a change with that
+    <para id="x_39c">Once you've named a branch and committed a change with that
       name, every subsequent commit that descends from that change
       will inherit the same branch name.  You can change the name of a
       branch at any time, using the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
@@ -405,7 +405,7 @@
 
     &interaction.branch-named.rebranch;
 
-    <para>In practice, this is something you won't do very often, as
+    <para id="x_39d">In practice, this is something you won't do very often, as
       branch names tend to have fairly long lifetimes.  (This isn't a
       rule, just an observation.)</para>
 
@@ -414,7 +414,7 @@
     <title>Dealing with multiple named branches in a
       repository</title>
 
-    <para>If you have more than one named branch in a repository,
+    <para id="x_39e">If you have more than one named branch in a repository,
       Mercurial will remember the branch that your working directory
       on when you start a command like <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	update</command> or <command role="hg-cmd">hg pull
@@ -424,17 +424,17 @@
       you may need to use the <option role="hg-opt-update">-C</option>
       option to <command role="hg-cmd">hg update</command>.</para>
 
-    <para>This behaviour is a little subtle, so let's see it in
+    <para id="x_39f">This behaviour is a little subtle, so let's see it in
       action.  First, let's remind ourselves what branch we're
       currently on, and what branches are in our repository.</para>
 
     &interaction.branch-named.parents;
 
-    <para>We're on the <literal>bar</literal> branch, but there also
+    <para id="x_3a0">We're on the <literal>bar</literal> branch, but there also
       exists an older <command role="hg-cmd">hg foo</command>
       branch.</para>
 
-    <para>We can <command role="hg-cmd">hg update</command> back and
+    <para id="x_3a1">We can <command role="hg-cmd">hg update</command> back and
       forth between the tips of the <literal>foo</literal> and
       <literal>bar</literal> branches without needing to use the
       <option role="hg-opt-update">-C</option> option, because this
@@ -443,14 +443,14 @@
 
     &interaction.branch-named.update-switchy;
 
-    <para>If we go back to the <literal>foo</literal> branch and then
+    <para id="x_3a2">If we go back to the <literal>foo</literal> branch and then
       run <command role="hg-cmd">hg update</command>, it will keep us
       on <literal>foo</literal>, not move us to the tip of
       <literal>bar</literal>.</para>
 
     &interaction.branch-named.update-nothing;
 
-    <para>Committing a new change on the <literal>foo</literal> branch
+    <para id="x_3a3">Committing a new change on the <literal>foo</literal> branch
       introduces a new head.</para>
 
     &interaction.branch-named.foo-commit;
@@ -459,7 +459,7 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Branch names and merging</title>
 
-    <para>As you've probably noticed, merges in Mercurial are not
+    <para id="x_3a4">As you've probably noticed, merges in Mercurial are not
       symmetrical. Let's say our repository has two heads, 17 and 23.
       If I <command role="hg-cmd">hg update</command> to 17 and then
       <command role="hg-cmd">hg merge</command> with 23, Mercurial
@@ -469,14 +469,14 @@
       17, it records 23 as the first parent, and 17 as the
       second.</para>
 
-    <para>This affects Mercurial's choice of branch name when you
+    <para id="x_3a5">This affects Mercurial's choice of branch name when you
       merge.  After a merge, Mercurial will retain the branch name of
       the first parent when you commit the result of the merge.  If
       your first parent's branch name is <literal>foo</literal>, and
       you merge with <literal>bar</literal>, the branch name will
       still be <literal>foo</literal> after you merge.</para>
 
-    <para>It's not unusual for a repository to contain multiple heads,
+    <para id="x_3a6">It's not unusual for a repository to contain multiple heads,
       each with the same branch name.  Let's say I'm working on the
       <literal>foo</literal> branch, and so are you.  We commit
       different changes; I pull your changes; I now have two heads,
@@ -484,13 +484,13 @@
       result of a merge will be a single head on the
       <literal>foo</literal> branch, as you might hope.</para>
 
-    <para>But if I'm working on the <literal>bar</literal> branch, and
+    <para id="x_3a7">But if I'm working on the <literal>bar</literal> branch, and
       I merge work from the <literal>foo</literal> branch, the result
       will remain on the <literal>bar</literal> branch.</para>
 
     &interaction.branch-named.merge;
 
-    <para>To give a more concrete example, if I'm working on the
+    <para id="x_3a8">To give a more concrete example, if I'm working on the
       <literal>bleeding-edge</literal> branch, and I want to bring in
       the latest fixes from the <literal>stable</literal> branch,
       Mercurial will choose the <quote>right</quote>
@@ -501,17 +501,17 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Branch naming is generally useful</title>
 
-    <para>You shouldn't think of named branches as applicable only to
+    <para id="x_3a9">You shouldn't think of named branches as applicable only to
       situations where you have multiple long-lived branches
       cohabiting in a single repository.  They're very useful even in
       the one-branch-per-repository case.</para>
 
-    <para>In the simplest case, giving a name to each branch gives you
+    <para id="x_3aa">In the simplest case, giving a name to each branch gives you
       a permanent record of which branch a changeset originated on.
       This gives you more context when you're trying to follow the
       history of a long-lived branchy project.</para>
 
-    <para>If you're working with shared repositories, you can set up a
+    <para id="x_3ab">If you're working with shared repositories, you can set up a
       <literal role="hook">pretxnchangegroup</literal> hook on each
       that will block incoming changes that have the
       <quote>wrong</quote> branch name.  This provides a simple, but
--- a/en/ch08-undo.xml	Thu Mar 19 20:54:12 2009 -0700
+++ b/en/ch08-undo.xml	Thu Mar 19 21:18:52 2009 -0700
@@ -4,7 +4,7 @@
   <?dbhtml filename="finding-and-fixing-mistakes.html"?>
   <title>Finding and fixing mistakes</title>
 
-  <para>To err might be human, but to really handle the consequences
+  <para id="x_d2">To err might be human, but to really handle the consequences
     well takes a top-notch revision control system.  In this chapter,
     we'll discuss some of the techniques you can use when you find
     that a problem has crept into your project.  Mercurial has some
@@ -17,7 +17,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>The accidental commit</title>
 
-      <para>I have the occasional but persistent problem of typing
+      <para id="x_d3">I have the occasional but persistent problem of typing
 	rather more quickly than I can think, which sometimes results
 	in me committing a changeset that is either incomplete or
 	plain wrong.  In my case, the usual kind of incomplete
@@ -30,7 +30,7 @@
     <sect2 id="sec:undo:rollback">
       <title>Rolling back a transaction</title>
 
-      <para>In section <xref linkend="sec:concepts:txn"/>, I mentioned
+      <para id="x_d4">In section <xref linkend="sec:concepts:txn"/>, I mentioned
 	that Mercurial treats each modification of a repository as a
 	<emphasis>transaction</emphasis>.  Every time you commit a
 	changeset or pull changes from another repository, Mercurial
@@ -40,20 +40,20 @@
 	section <xref linkend="sec:undo:rollback-after-push"/> for an
 	important caveat about the use of this command.)</para>
 
-      <para>Here's a mistake that I often find myself making:
+      <para id="x_d5">Here's a mistake that I often find myself making:
 	committing a change in which I've created a new file, but
 	forgotten to <command role="hg-cmd">hg add</command>
 	it.</para>
 
       &interaction.rollback.commit;
 
-      <para>Looking at the output of <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+      <para id="x_d6">Looking at the output of <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	  status</command> after the commit immediately confirms the
 	error.</para>
 
       &interaction.rollback.status;
 
-      <para>The commit captured the changes to the file
+      <para id="x_d7">The commit captured the changes to the file
 	<filename>a</filename>, but not the new file
 	<filename>b</filename>.  If I were to push this changeset to a
 	repository that I shared with a colleague, the chances are
@@ -62,14 +62,14 @@
 	repository when they pulled my changes.  I would thus become
 	the object of some indignation.</para>
 
-      <para>However, luck is with me&emdash;I've caught my error
+      <para id="x_d8">However, luck is with me&emdash;I've caught my error
 	before I pushed the changeset.  I use the <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg rollback</command> command, and Mercurial
 	makes that last changeset vanish.</para>
 
       &interaction.rollback.rollback;
 
-      <para>Notice that the changeset is no longer present in the
+      <para id="x_d9">Notice that the changeset is no longer present in the
 	repository's history, and the working directory once again
 	thinks that the file <filename>a</filename> is modified.  The
 	commit and rollback have left the working directory exactly as
@@ -84,14 +84,14 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>The erroneous pull</title>
 
-      <para>It's common practice with Mercurial to maintain separate
+      <para id="x_da">It's common practice with Mercurial to maintain separate
 	development branches of a project in different repositories.
 	Your development team might have one shared repository for
 	your project's <quote>0.9</quote> release, and another,
 	containing different changes, for the <quote>1.0</quote>
 	release.</para>
 
-      <para>Given this, you can imagine that the consequences could be
+      <para id="x_db">Given this, you can imagine that the consequences could be
 	messy if you had a local <quote>0.9</quote> repository, and
 	accidentally pulled changes from the shared <quote>1.0</quote>
 	repository into it.  At worst, you could be paying
@@ -103,7 +103,7 @@
 	see it pull a suspiciously large number of changes into the
 	repository.</para>
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-cmd">hg rollback</command> command
+      <para id="x_dc">The <command role="hg-cmd">hg rollback</command> command
 	will work nicely to expunge all of the changesets that you
 	just pulled.  Mercurial groups all changes from one <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg pull</command> into a single transaction,
@@ -114,7 +114,7 @@
     <sect2 id="sec:undo:rollback-after-push">
       <title>Rolling back is useless once you've pushed</title>
 
-      <para>The value of the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+      <para id="x_dd">The value of the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	  rollback</command> command drops to zero once you've pushed
 	your changes to another repository.  Rolling back a change
 	makes it disappear entirely, but <emphasis>only</emphasis> in
@@ -123,7 +123,7 @@
 	eliminates history, there's no way for the disappearance of a
 	change to propagate between repositories.</para>
 
-      <para>If you've pushed a change to another
+      <para id="x_de">If you've pushed a change to another
 	repository&emdash;particularly if it's a shared
 	repository&emdash;it has essentially <quote>escaped into the
 	  wild,</quote> and you'll have to recover from your mistake
@@ -132,7 +132,7 @@
 	you pushed to, is that the changeset will reappear in your
 	repository.</para>
 
-      <para>(If you absolutely know for sure that the change you want
+      <para id="x_df">(If you absolutely know for sure that the change you want
 	to roll back is the most recent change in the repository that
 	you pushed to, <emphasis>and</emphasis> you know that nobody
 	else could have pulled it from that repository, you can roll
@@ -146,7 +146,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>You can only roll back once</title>
 
-      <para>Mercurial stores exactly one transaction in its
+      <para id="x_e0">Mercurial stores exactly one transaction in its
 	transaction log; that transaction is the most recent one that
 	occurred in the repository. This means that you can only roll
 	back one transaction.  If you expect to be able to roll back
@@ -155,7 +155,7 @@
 
       &interaction.rollback.twice;
 
-      <para>Once you've rolled back one transaction in a repository,
+      <para id="x_e1">Once you've rolled back one transaction in a repository,
 	you can't roll back again in that repository until you perform
 	another commit or pull.</para>
 
@@ -164,7 +164,7 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Reverting the mistaken change</title>
 
-    <para>If you make a modification to a file, and decide that you
+    <para id="x_e2">If you make a modification to a file, and decide that you
       really didn't want to change the file at all, and you haven't
       yet committed your changes, the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	revert</command> command is the one you'll need.  It looks at
@@ -173,42 +173,42 @@
       changeset. (That's a long-winded way of saying that, in the
       normal case, it undoes your modifications.)</para>
 
-    <para>Let's illustrate how the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+    <para id="x_e3">Let's illustrate how the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	revert</command> command works with yet another small example.
       We'll begin by modifying a file that Mercurial is already
       tracking.</para>
 
     &interaction.daily.revert.modify;
 
-    <para>If we don't
+    <para id="x_e4">If we don't
       want that change, we can simply <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	revert</command> the file.</para>
 
       &interaction.daily.revert.unmodify;
 
-    <para>The <command role="hg-cmd">hg revert</command> command
+    <para id="x_e5">The <command role="hg-cmd">hg revert</command> command
       provides us with an extra degree of safety by saving our
       modified file with a <filename>.orig</filename>
       extension.</para>
 
     &interaction.daily.revert.status;
 
-    <para>Here is a summary of the cases that the <command
+    <para id="x_e6">Here is a summary of the cases that the <command
 	role="hg-cmd">hg revert</command> command can deal with.  We
       will describe each of these in more detail in the section that
       follows.</para>
     <itemizedlist>
-      <listitem><para>If you modify a file, it will restore the file
+      <listitem><para id="x_e7">If you modify a file, it will restore the file
 	  to its unmodified state.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>If you <command role="hg-cmd">hg add</command> a
+      <listitem><para id="x_e8">If you <command role="hg-cmd">hg add</command> a
 	  file, it will undo the <quote>added</quote> state of the
 	  file, but leave the file itself untouched.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>If you delete a file without telling Mercurial,
+      <listitem><para id="x_e9">If you delete a file without telling Mercurial,
 	  it will restore the file to its unmodified contents.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>If you use the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+      <listitem><para id="x_ea">If you use the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	    remove</command> command to remove a file, it will undo
 	  the <quote>removed</quote> state of the file, and restore
 	  the file to its unmodified contents.</para>
@@ -217,13 +217,13 @@
     <sect2 id="sec:undo:mgmt">
       <title>File management errors</title>
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-cmd">hg revert</command> command is
+      <para id="x_eb">The <command role="hg-cmd">hg revert</command> command is
 	useful for more than just modified files.  It lets you reverse
 	the results of all of Mercurial's file management
 	commands&emdash;<command role="hg-cmd">hg add</command>,
 	<command role="hg-cmd">hg remove</command>, and so on.</para>
 
-      <para>If you <command role="hg-cmd">hg add</command> a file,
+      <para id="x_ec">If you <command role="hg-cmd">hg add</command> a file,
 	then decide that in fact you don't want Mercurial to track it,
 	use <command role="hg-cmd">hg revert</command> to undo the
 	add.  Don't worry; Mercurial will not modify the file in any
@@ -231,7 +231,7 @@
 
       &interaction.daily.revert.add;
 
-      <para>Similarly, if you ask Mercurial to <command
+      <para id="x_ed">Similarly, if you ask Mercurial to <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg remove</command> a file, you can use
 	<command role="hg-cmd">hg revert</command> to restore it to
 	the contents it had as of the parent of the working directory.
@@ -242,7 +242,7 @@
 
       &interaction.daily.revert.missing;
 
-      <para>If you revert a <command role="hg-cmd">hg copy</command>,
+      <para id="x_ee">If you revert a <command role="hg-cmd">hg copy</command>,
 	the copied-to file remains in your working directory
 	afterwards, untracked.  Since a copy doesn't affect the
 	copied-from file in any way, Mercurial doesn't do anything
@@ -253,7 +253,7 @@
       <sect3>
 	<title>A slightly special case: reverting a rename</title>
 
-	<para>If you <command role="hg-cmd">hg rename</command> a
+	<para id="x_ef">If you <command role="hg-cmd">hg rename</command> a
 	  file, there is one small detail that you should remember.
 	  When you <command role="hg-cmd">hg revert</command> a
 	  rename, it's not enough to provide the name of the
@@ -261,7 +261,7 @@
 
 	&interaction.daily.revert.rename;
 
-	<para>As you can see from the output of <command
+	<para id="x_f0">As you can see from the output of <command
 	    role="hg-cmd">hg status</command>, the renamed-to file is
 	  no longer identified as added, but the
 	  renamed-<emphasis>from</emphasis> file is still removed!
@@ -270,22 +270,22 @@
 
 	&interaction.daily.revert.rename-orig;
 
-	<para>So remember, to revert a <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+	<para id="x_f1">So remember, to revert a <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	    rename</command>, you must provide
 	  <emphasis>both</emphasis> the source and destination
 	  names.</para>
 
-	<para>% TODO: the output doesn't look like it will be
+	<para id="x_f2">% TODO: the output doesn't look like it will be
 	  removed!</para>
 
-	<para>(By the way, if you rename a file, then modify the
+	<para id="x_f3">(By the way, if you rename a file, then modify the
 	  renamed-to file, then revert both components of the rename,
 	  when Mercurial restores the file that was removed as part of
 	  the rename, it will be unmodified. If you need the
 	  modifications in the renamed-to file to show up in the
 	  renamed-from file, don't forget to copy them over.)</para>
 
-	<para>These fiddly aspects of reverting a rename arguably
+	<para id="x_f4">These fiddly aspects of reverting a rename arguably
 	  constitute a small bug in Mercurial.</para>
 
       </sect3>
@@ -294,13 +294,13 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Dealing with committed changes</title>
 
-    <para>Consider a case where you have committed a change $a$, and
+    <para id="x_f5">Consider a case where you have committed a change $a$, and
       another change $b$ on top of it; you then realise that change
       $a$ was incorrect.  Mercurial lets you <quote>back out</quote>
       an entire changeset automatically, and building blocks that let
       you reverse part of a changeset by hand.</para>
 
-    <para>Before you read this section, here's something to keep in
+    <para id="x_f6">Before you read this section, here's something to keep in
       mind: the <command role="hg-cmd">hg backout</command> command
       undoes changes by <emphasis>adding</emphasis> history, not by
       modifying or erasing it.  It's the right tool to use if you're
@@ -311,7 +311,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Backing out a changeset</title>
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-cmd">hg backout</command> command
+      <para id="x_f7">The <command role="hg-cmd">hg backout</command> command
 	lets you <quote>undo</quote> the effects of an entire
 	changeset in an automated fashion.  Because Mercurial's
 	history is immutable, this command <emphasis>does
@@ -320,14 +320,14 @@
 	<emphasis>reverses</emphasis> the effect of the to-be-undone
 	changeset.</para>
 
-      <para>The operation of the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+      <para id="x_f8">The operation of the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	  backout</command> command is a little intricate, so let's
 	illustrate it with some examples.  First, we'll create a
 	repository with some simple changes.</para>
 
       &interaction.backout.init;
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-cmd">hg backout</command> command
+      <para id="x_f9">The <command role="hg-cmd">hg backout</command> command
 	takes a single changeset ID as its argument; this is the
 	changeset to back out.  Normally, <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	  backout</command> will drop you into a text editor to write
@@ -340,12 +340,12 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Backing out the tip changeset</title>
 
-      <para>We're going to start by backing out the last changeset we
+      <para id="x_fa">We're going to start by backing out the last changeset we
 	committed.</para>
 
       &interaction.backout.simple;
 
-      <para>You can see that the second line from
+      <para id="x_fb">You can see that the second line from
 	<filename>myfile</filename> is no longer present.  Taking a
 	look at the output of <command role="hg-cmd">hg log</command>
 	gives us an idea of what the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
@@ -361,7 +361,7 @@
       <informalfigure id="fig:undo:backout">
 	<mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata
 				    fileref="undo-simple"/></imageobject><textobject><phrase>XXX 
-	      add text</phrase></textobject><caption><para>Backing out
+	      add text</phrase></textobject><caption><para id="x_fc">Backing out
 	      a change using the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 		backout</command>
 	      command</para></caption></mediaobject>
@@ -372,27 +372,27 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Backing out a non-tip change</title>
 
-      <para>If you want to back out a change other than the last one
+      <para id="x_fd">If you want to back out a change other than the last one
 	you committed, pass the <option
 	  role="hg-opt-backout">--merge</option> option to the
 	<command role="hg-cmd">hg backout</command> command.</para>
 
       &interaction.backout.non-tip.clone;
 
-      <para>This makes backing out any changeset a
+      <para id="x_fe">This makes backing out any changeset a
 	<quote>one-shot</quote> operation that's usually simple and
 	fast.</para>
 
       &interaction.backout.non-tip.backout;
 
-      <para>If you take a look at the contents of
+      <para id="x_ff">If you take a look at the contents of
 	<filename>myfile</filename> after the backout finishes, you'll
 	see that the first and third changes are present, but not the
 	second.</para>
 
       &interaction.backout.non-tip.cat;
 
-      <para>As the graphical history in figure <xref
+      <para id="x_100">As the graphical history in figure <xref
 	  linkend="fig:undo:backout-non-tip"/> illustrates, Mercurial
 	actually commits <emphasis>two</emphasis> changes in this kind
 	of situation (the box-shaped nodes are the ones that Mercurial
@@ -403,19 +403,19 @@
 	the previous parent of the working directory, and commits the
 	result of the merge.</para>
 
-      <para>% TODO: to me it looks like mercurial doesn't commit the
+      <para id="x_101">% TODO: to me it looks like mercurial doesn't commit the
 	second merge automatically!</para>
 
       <informalfigure id="fig:undo:backout-non-tip">
 	<mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata
 				    fileref="undo-non-tip"/></imageobject><textobject><phrase>XXX 
-	      add text</phrase></textobject><caption><para>Automated
+	      add text</phrase></textobject><caption><para id="x_102">Automated
 	      backout of a non-tip change using the <command
 		role="hg-cmd">hg backout</command>
 	      command</para></caption></mediaobject>
       </informalfigure>
 
-      <para>The result is that you end up <quote>back where you
+      <para id="x_103">The result is that you end up <quote>back where you
 	  were</quote>, only with some extra history that undoes the
 	effect of the changeset you wanted to back out.</para>
 
@@ -423,7 +423,7 @@
 	<title>Always use the <option
 	    role="hg-opt-backout">--merge</option> option</title>
 
-	<para>In fact, since the <option
+	<para id="x_104">In fact, since the <option
 	    role="hg-opt-backout">--merge</option> option will do the
 	  <quote>right thing</quote> whether or not the changeset
 	  you're backing out is the tip (i.e. it won't try to merge if
@@ -436,7 +436,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Gaining more control of the backout process</title>
 
-      <para>While I've recommended that you always use the <option
+      <para id="x_105">While I've recommended that you always use the <option
 	  role="hg-opt-backout">--merge</option> option when backing
 	out a change, the <command role="hg-cmd">hg backout</command>
 	command lets you decide how to merge a backout changeset.
@@ -449,13 +449,13 @@
 
       &interaction.backout.manual.clone;
 
-      <para>As with our
+      <para id="x_106">As with our
 	earlier example, We'll commit a third changeset, then back out
 	its parent, and see what happens.</para>
 
       &interaction.backout.manual.backout;
 
-      <para>Our new changeset is again a descendant of the changeset
+      <para id="x_107">Our new changeset is again a descendant of the changeset
 	we backout out; it's thus a new head, <emphasis>not</emphasis>
 	a descendant of the changeset that was the tip.  The <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg backout</command> command was quite
@@ -463,7 +463,7 @@
 
       &interaction.backout.manual.log;
 
-      <para>Again, it's easier to see what has happened by looking at
+      <para id="x_108">Again, it's easier to see what has happened by looking at
 	a graph of the revision history, in figure <xref
 	  linkend="fig:undo:backout-manual"/>.  This makes it clear
 	that when we use <command role="hg-cmd">hg backout</command>
@@ -474,25 +474,25 @@
       <informalfigure id="fig:undo:backout-manual">
 	<mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata
 				    fileref="undo-manual"/></imageobject><textobject><phrase>XXX 
-	      add text</phrase></textobject><caption><para>Backing out
+	      add text</phrase></textobject><caption><para id="x_109">Backing out
 	      a change using the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 		backout</command>
 	      command</para></caption></mediaobject>
 	
       </informalfigure>
 
-      <para>After the <command role="hg-cmd">hg backout</command>
+      <para id="x_10a">After the <command role="hg-cmd">hg backout</command>
 	command has completed, it leaves the new
 	<quote>backout</quote> changeset as the parent of the working
 	directory.</para>
 
       &interaction.backout.manual.parents;
 
-      <para>Now we have two isolated sets of changes.</para>
+      <para id="x_10b">Now we have two isolated sets of changes.</para>
 
       &interaction.backout.manual.heads;
 
-      <para>Let's think about what we expect to see as the contents of
+      <para id="x_10c">Let's think about what we expect to see as the contents of
 	<filename>myfile</filename> now.  The first change should be
 	present, because we've never backed it out.  The second change
 	should be missing, as that's the change we backed out.  Since
@@ -502,19 +502,19 @@
 
       &interaction.backout.manual.cat;
 
-      <para>To get the third change back into the file, we just do a
+      <para id="x_10d">To get the third change back into the file, we just do a
 	normal merge of our two heads.</para>
 
       &interaction.backout.manual.merge;
 
-      <para>Afterwards, the graphical history of our repository looks
+      <para id="x_10e">Afterwards, the graphical history of our repository looks
 	like figure
 	<xref linkend="fig:undo:backout-manual-merge"/>.</para>
 
       <informalfigure id="fig:undo:backout-manual-merge">
 	<mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata
 				    fileref="undo-manual-merge"/></imageobject><textobject><phrase>XXX 
-	      add text</phrase></textobject><caption><para>Manually
+	      add text</phrase></textobject><caption><para id="x_10f">Manually
 	      merging a backout change</para></caption></mediaobject>
 	
       </informalfigure>
@@ -524,43 +524,43 @@
       <title>Why <command role="hg-cmd">hg backout</command> works as
 	it does</title>
 
-      <para>Here's a brief description of how the <command
+      <para id="x_110">Here's a brief description of how the <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg backout</command> command works.</para>
       <orderedlist>
-	<listitem><para>It ensures that the working directory is
+	<listitem><para id="x_111">It ensures that the working directory is
 	    <quote>clean</quote>, i.e. that the output of <command
 	      role="hg-cmd">hg status</command> would be empty.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>It remembers the current parent of the working
+	<listitem><para id="x_112">It remembers the current parent of the working
 	    directory.  Let's call this changeset
 	    <literal>orig</literal></para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>It does the equivalent of a <command
+	<listitem><para id="x_113">It does the equivalent of a <command
 	      role="hg-cmd">hg update</command> to sync the working
 	    directory to the changeset you want to back out.  Let's
 	    call this changeset <literal>backout</literal></para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>It finds the parent of that changeset.  Let's
+	<listitem><para id="x_114">It finds the parent of that changeset.  Let's
 	    call that changeset <literal>parent</literal>.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>For each file that the
+	<listitem><para id="x_115">For each file that the
 	    <literal>backout</literal> changeset affected, it does the
 	    equivalent of a <command role="hg-cmd">hg revert -r
 	      parent</command> on that file, to restore it to the
 	    contents it had before that changeset was
 	    committed.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>It commits the result as a new changeset.
+	<listitem><para id="x_116">It commits the result as a new changeset.
 	    This changeset has <literal>backout</literal> as its
 	    parent.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>If you specify <option
+	<listitem><para id="x_117">If you specify <option
 	      role="hg-opt-backout">--merge</option> on the command
 	    line, it merges with <literal>orig</literal>, and commits
 	    the result of the merge.</para>
 	</listitem></orderedlist>
 
-      <para>An alternative way to implement the <command
+      <para id="x_118">An alternative way to implement the <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg backout</command> command would be to
 	<command role="hg-cmd">hg export</command> the
 	to-be-backed-out changeset as a diff, then use the <option
@@ -570,14 +570,14 @@
 	sounds much simpler, but it would not work nearly as
 	well.</para>
 
-      <para>The reason that <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+      <para id="x_119">The reason that <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	  backout</command> does an update, a commit, a merge, and
 	another commit is to give the merge machinery the best chance
 	to do a good job when dealing with all the changes
 	<emphasis>between</emphasis> the change you're backing out and
 	the current tip.</para>
 
-      <para>If you're backing out a changeset that's 100 revisions
+      <para id="x_11a">If you're backing out a changeset that's 100 revisions
 	back in your project's history, the chances that the
 	<command>patch</command> command will be able to apply a
 	reverse diff cleanly are not good, because intervening changes
@@ -596,13 +596,13 @@
   <sect1 id="sec:undo:aaaiiieee">
     <title>Changes that should never have been</title>
 
-    <para>Most of the time, the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+    <para id="x_11b">Most of the time, the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	backout</command> command is exactly what you need if you want
       to undo the effects of a change.  It leaves a permanent record
       of exactly what you did, both when committing the original
       changeset and when you cleaned up after it.</para>
 
-    <para>On rare occasions, though, you may find that you've
+    <para id="x_11c">On rare occasions, though, you may find that you've
       committed a change that really should not be present in the
       repository at all.  For example, it would be very unusual, and
       usually considered a mistake, to commit a software project's
@@ -611,12 +611,12 @@
       so they increase the size of the repository and the amount of
       time it takes to clone or pull changes.</para>
 
-    <para>Before I discuss the options that you have if you commit a
+    <para id="x_11d">Before I discuss the options that you have if you commit a
       <quote>brown paper bag</quote> change (the kind that's so bad
       that you want to pull a brown paper bag over your head), let me
       first discuss some approaches that probably won't work.</para>
 
-    <para>Since Mercurial treats history as accumulative&emdash;every
+    <para id="x_11e">Since Mercurial treats history as accumulative&emdash;every
       change builds on top of all changes that preceded it&emdash;you
       generally can't just make disastrous changes disappear.  The one
       exception is when you've just committed a change, and it hasn't
@@ -625,7 +625,7 @@
       command, as I detailed in section <xref
 	linkend="sec:undo:rollback"/>.</para>
 
-    <para>After you've pushed a bad change to another repository, you
+    <para id="x_11f">After you've pushed a bad change to another repository, you
       <emphasis>could</emphasis> still use <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	rollback</command> to make your local copy of the change
       disappear, but it won't have the consequences you want.  The
@@ -633,7 +633,7 @@
       will reappear in your local repository the next time you
       pull.</para>
 
-    <para>If a situation like this arises, and you know which
+    <para id="x_120">If a situation like this arises, and you know which
       repositories your bad change has propagated into, you can
       <emphasis>try</emphasis> to get rid of the changeefrom
       <emphasis>every</emphasis> one of those repositories.  This is,
@@ -641,13 +641,13 @@
       single repository while you're expunging, the change is still
       <quote>in the wild</quote>, and could propagate further.</para>
 
-    <para>If you've committed one or more changes
+    <para id="x_121">If you've committed one or more changes
       <emphasis>after</emphasis> the change that you'd like to see
       disappear, your options are further reduced. Mercurial doesn't
       provide a way to <quote>punch a hole</quote> in history, leaving
       changesets intact.</para>
 
-    <para>XXX This needs filling out.  The
+    <para id="x_122">XXX This needs filling out.  The
       <literal>hg-replay</literal> script in the
       <literal>examples</literal> directory works, but doesn't handle
       merge changesets.  Kind of an important omission.</para>
@@ -656,14 +656,14 @@
       <title>Protect yourself from <quote>escaped</quote>
 	changes</title>
 
-      <para>If you've committed some changes to your local repository
+      <para id="x_123">If you've committed some changes to your local repository
 	and they've been pushed or pulled somewhere else, this isn't
 	necessarily a disaster.  You can protect yourself ahead of
 	time against some classes of bad changeset.  This is
 	particularly easy if your team usually pulls changes from a
 	central repository.</para>
 
-      <para>By configuring some hooks on that repository to validate
+      <para id="x_124">By configuring some hooks on that repository to validate
 	incoming changesets (see chapter <xref linkend="chap:hook"/>),
 	you can
 	automatically prevent some kinds of bad changeset from being
@@ -673,7 +673,7 @@
 	propagate into the central repository.  Better yet, this
 	happens without any need for explicit intervention.</para>
 
-      <para>For instance, an incoming change hook that verifies that a
+      <para id="x_125">For instance, an incoming change hook that verifies that a
 	changeset will actually compile can prevent people from
 	inadvertantly <quote>breaking the build</quote>.</para>
 
@@ -682,14 +682,14 @@
   <sect1 id="sec:undo:bisect">
     <title>Finding the source of a bug</title>
 
-    <para>While it's all very well to be able to back out a changeset
+    <para id="x_126">While it's all very well to be able to back out a changeset
       that introduced a bug, this requires that you know which
       changeset to back out.  Mercurial provides an invaluable
       command, called <command role="hg-cmd">hg bisect</command>, that
       helps you to automate this process and accomplish it very
       efficiently.</para>
 
-    <para>The idea behind the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+    <para id="x_127">The idea behind the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	bisect</command> command is that a changeset has introduced
       some change of behaviour that you can identify with a simple
       binary test.  You don't know which piece of code introduced the
@@ -698,41 +698,41 @@
       test to direct its search for the changeset that introduced the
       code that caused the bug.</para>
 
-    <para>Here are a few scenarios to help you understand how you
+    <para id="x_128">Here are a few scenarios to help you understand how you
       might apply this command.</para>
     <itemizedlist>
-      <listitem><para>The most recent version of your software has a
+      <listitem><para id="x_129">The most recent version of your software has a
 	  bug that you remember wasn't present a few weeks ago, but
 	  you don't know when it was introduced.  Here, your binary
 	  test checks for the presence of that bug.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>You fixed a bug in a rush, and now it's time to
+      <listitem><para id="x_12a">You fixed a bug in a rush, and now it's time to
 	  close the entry in your team's bug database.  The bug
 	  database requires a changeset ID when you close an entry,
 	  but you don't remember which changeset you fixed the bug in.
 	  Once again, your binary test checks for the presence of the
 	  bug.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>Your software works correctly, but runs 15%
+      <listitem><para id="x_12b">Your software works correctly, but runs 15%
 	  slower than the last time you measured it.  You want to know
 	  which changeset introduced the performance regression.  In
 	  this case, your binary test measures the performance of your
 	  software, to see whether it's <quote>fast</quote> or
 	  <quote>slow</quote>.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>The sizes of the components of your project that
+      <listitem><para id="x_12c">The sizes of the components of your project that
 	  you ship exploded recently, and you suspect that something
 	  changed in the way you build your project.</para>
       </listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-    <para>From these examples, it should be clear that the <command
+    <para id="x_12d">From these examples, it should be clear that the <command
 	role="hg-cmd">hg bisect</command> command is not useful only
       for finding the sources of bugs.  You can use it to find any
       <quote>emergent property</quote> of a repository (anything that
       you can't find from a simple text search of the files in the
       tree) for which you can write a binary test.</para>
 
-    <para>We'll introduce a little bit of terminology here, just to
+    <para id="x_12e">We'll introduce a little bit of terminology here, just to
       make it clear which parts of the search process are your
       responsibility, and which are Mercurial's.  A
       <emphasis>test</emphasis> is something that
@@ -745,7 +745,7 @@
 	the <command role="hg-cmd">hg bisect</command>
 	command</quote>.</para>
 
-    <para>One simple way to automate the searching process would be
+    <para id="x_12f">One simple way to automate the searching process would be
       simply to probe every changeset.  However, this scales poorly.
       If it took ten minutes to test a single changeset, and you had
       10,000 changesets in your repository, the exhaustive approach
@@ -755,7 +755,7 @@
       your search to those, you'd still be looking at over 40 hours to
       find the changeset that introduced your bug.</para>
 
-    <para>What the <command role="hg-cmd">hg bisect</command> command
+    <para id="x_130">What the <command role="hg-cmd">hg bisect</command> command
       does is use its knowledge of the <quote>shape</quote> of your
       project's revision history to perform a search in time
       proportional to the <emphasis>logarithm</emphasis> of the number
@@ -766,7 +766,7 @@
       Limit your search to the last hundred changesets, and it will
       take only about an hour (roughly seven tests).</para>
 
-    <para>The <command role="hg-cmd">hg bisect</command> command is
+    <para id="x_131">The <command role="hg-cmd">hg bisect</command> command is
       aware of the <quote>branchy</quote> nature of a Mercurial
       project's revision history, so it has no problems dealing with
       branches, merges, or multiple heads in a repository.  It can
@@ -777,24 +777,24 @@
       <title>Using the <command role="hg-cmd">hg bisect</command>
 	command</title>
 
-      <para>Here's an example of <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+      <para id="x_132">Here's an example of <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	  bisect</command> in action.</para>
 
       <note>
-	<para>  In versions 0.9.5 and earlier of Mercurial, <command
+	<para id="x_133">  In versions 0.9.5 and earlier of Mercurial, <command
 	    role="hg-cmd">hg bisect</command> was not a core command:
 	  it was distributed with Mercurial as an extension. This
 	  section describes the built-in command, not the old
 	  extension.</para>
       </note>
 
-      <para>Now let's create a repository, so that we can try out the
+      <para id="x_134">Now let's create a repository, so that we can try out the
 	<command role="hg-cmd">hg bisect</command> command in
 	isolation.</para>
 
       &interaction.bisect.init;
 
-      <para>We'll simulate a project that has a bug in it in a
+      <para id="x_135">We'll simulate a project that has a bug in it in a
 	simple-minded way: create trivial changes in a loop, and
 	nominate one specific change that will have the
 	<quote>bug</quote>.  This loop creates 35 changesets, each
@@ -804,44 +804,44 @@
 
       &interaction.bisect.commits;
 
-      <para>The next thing that we'd like to do is figure out how to
+      <para id="x_136">The next thing that we'd like to do is figure out how to
 	use the <command role="hg-cmd">hg bisect</command> command.
 	We can use Mercurial's normal built-in help mechanism for
 	this.</para>
 
       &interaction.bisect.help;
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-cmd">hg bisect</command> command
+      <para id="x_137">The <command role="hg-cmd">hg bisect</command> command
 	works in steps.  Each step proceeds as follows.</para>
       <orderedlist>
-	<listitem><para>You run your binary test.</para>
+	<listitem><para id="x_138">You run your binary test.</para>
 	  <itemizedlist>
-	    <listitem><para>If the test succeeded, you tell <command
+	    <listitem><para id="x_139">If the test succeeded, you tell <command
 		  role="hg-cmd">hg bisect</command> by running the
 		<command role="hg-cmd">hg bisect good</command>
 		command.</para>
 	    </listitem>
-	    <listitem><para>If it failed, run the <command
+	    <listitem><para id="x_13a">If it failed, run the <command
 		  role="hg-cmd">hg bisect bad</command>
 		command.</para></listitem></itemizedlist>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>The command uses your information to decide
+	<listitem><para id="x_13b">The command uses your information to decide
 	    which changeset to test next.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>It updates the working directory to that
+	<listitem><para id="x_13c">It updates the working directory to that
 	    changeset, and the process begins again.</para>
 	</listitem></orderedlist>
-      <para>The process ends when <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+      <para id="x_13d">The process ends when <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	  bisect</command> identifies a unique changeset that marks
 	the point where your test transitioned from
 	<quote>succeeding</quote> to <quote>failing</quote>.</para>
 
-      <para>To start the search, we must run the <command
+      <para id="x_13e">To start the search, we must run the <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg bisect --reset</command> command.</para>
 
       &interaction.bisect.search.init;
 
-      <para>In our case, the binary test we use is simple: we check to
+      <para id="x_13f">In our case, the binary test we use is simple: we check to
 	see if any file in the repository contains the string <quote>i
 	  have a gub</quote>.  If it does, this changeset contains the
 	change that <quote>caused the bug</quote>.  By convention, a
@@ -849,14 +849,14 @@
 	<quote>bad</quote>, while one that doesn't is
 	<quote>good</quote>.</para>
 
-      <para>Most of the time, the revision to which the working
+      <para id="x_140">Most of the time, the revision to which the working
 	directory is synced (usually the tip) already exhibits the
 	problem introduced by the buggy change, so we'll mark it as
 	<quote>bad</quote>.</para>
 
       &interaction.bisect.search.bad-init;
 
-      <para>Our next task is to nominate a changeset that we know
+      <para id="x_141">Our next task is to nominate a changeset that we know
 	<emphasis>doesn't</emphasis> have the bug; the <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg bisect</command> command will
 	<quote>bracket</quote> its search between the first pair of
@@ -866,38 +866,38 @@
 
       &interaction.bisect.search.good-init;
 
-      <para>Notice that this command printed some output.</para>
+      <para id="x_142">Notice that this command printed some output.</para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para>It told us how many changesets it must
+	<listitem><para id="x_143">It told us how many changesets it must
 	    consider before it can identify the one that introduced
 	    the bug, and how many tests that will require.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>It updated the working directory to the next
+	<listitem><para id="x_144">It updated the working directory to the next
 	    changeset to test, and told us which changeset it's
 	    testing.</para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-      <para>We now run our test in the working directory.  We use the
+      <para id="x_145">We now run our test in the working directory.  We use the
 	<command>grep</command> command to see if our
 	<quote>bad</quote> file is present in the working directory.
 	If it is, this revision is bad; if not, this revision is good.
 	&interaction.bisect.search.step1;</para>
 
-      <para>This test looks like a perfect candidate for automation,
+      <para id="x_146">This test looks like a perfect candidate for automation,
 	so let's turn it into a shell function.</para>
       &interaction.bisect.search.mytest;
 
-      <para>We can now run an entire test step with a single command,
+      <para id="x_147">We can now run an entire test step with a single command,
 	<literal>mytest</literal>.</para>
 
       &interaction.bisect.search.step2;
 
-      <para>A few more invocations of our canned test step command,
+      <para id="x_148">A few more invocations of our canned test step command,
 	and we're done.</para>
 
       &interaction.bisect.search.rest;
 
-      <para>Even though we had 40 changesets to search through, the
+      <para id="x_149">Even though we had 40 changesets to search through, the
 	<command role="hg-cmd">hg bisect</command> command let us find
 	the changeset that introduced our <quote>bug</quote> with only
 	five tests.  Because the number of tests that the <command
@@ -910,7 +910,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Cleaning up after your search</title>
 
-      <para>When you're finished using the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+      <para id="x_14a">When you're finished using the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	  bisect</command> command in a repository, you can use the
 	<command role="hg-cmd">hg bisect reset</command> command to
 	drop the information it was using to drive your search.  The
@@ -930,7 +930,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Give consistent input</title>
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-cmd">hg bisect</command> command
+      <para id="x_14b">The <command role="hg-cmd">hg bisect</command> command
 	requires that you correctly report the result of every test
 	you perform.  If you tell it that a test failed when it really
 	succeeded, it <emphasis>might</emphasis> be able to detect the
@@ -944,7 +944,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Automate as much as possible</title>
 
-      <para>When I started using the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+      <para id="x_14c">When I started using the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	  bisect</command> command, I tried a few times to run my
 	tests by hand, on the command line.  This is an approach that
 	I, at least, am not suited to.  After a few tries, I found
@@ -952,7 +952,7 @@
 	my searches several times before finally getting correct
 	results.</para>
 
-      <para>My initial problems with driving the <command
+      <para id="x_14d">My initial problems with driving the <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg bisect</command> command by hand occurred
 	even with simple searches on small repositories; if the
 	problem you're looking for is more subtle, or the number of
@@ -961,14 +961,14 @@
 	the search is much higher.  Once I started automating my
 	tests, I had much better results.</para>
 
-      <para>The key to automated testing is twofold:</para>
+      <para id="x_14e">The key to automated testing is twofold:</para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para>always test for the same symptom, and</para>
+	<listitem><para id="x_14f">always test for the same symptom, and</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>always feed consistent input to the <command
+	<listitem><para id="x_150">always feed consistent input to the <command
 	      role="hg-cmd">hg bisect</command> command.</para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
-      <para>In my tutorial example above, the <command>grep</command>
+      <para id="x_151">In my tutorial example above, the <command>grep</command>
 	command tests for the symptom, and the <literal>if</literal>
 	statement takes the result of this check and ensures that we
 	always feed the same input to the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
@@ -980,21 +980,21 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Check your results</title>
 
-      <para>Because the output of a <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+      <para id="x_152">Because the output of a <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	  bisect</command> search is only as good as the input you
 	give it, don't take the changeset it reports as the absolute
 	truth.  A simple way to cross-check its report is to manually
 	run your test at each of the following changesets:</para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para>The changeset that it reports as the first bad
+	<listitem><para id="x_153">The changeset that it reports as the first bad
 	    revision.  Your test should still report this as
 	    bad.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>The parent of that changeset (either parent,
+	<listitem><para id="x_154">The parent of that changeset (either parent,
 	    if it's a merge). Your test should report this changeset
 	    as good.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>A child of that changeset.  Your test should
+	<listitem><para id="x_155">A child of that changeset.  Your test should
 	    report this changeset as bad.</para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
 
@@ -1002,7 +1002,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Beware interference between bugs</title>
 
-      <para>It's possible that your search for one bug could be
+      <para id="x_156">It's possible that your search for one bug could be
 	disrupted by the presence of another.  For example, let's say
 	your software crashes at revision 100, and worked correctly at
 	revision 50.  Unknown to you, someone else introduced a
@@ -1010,7 +1010,7 @@
 	revision 80.  This could distort your results in one of
 	several ways.</para>
 
-      <para>It is possible that this other bug completely
+      <para id="x_157">It is possible that this other bug completely
 	<quote>masks</quote> yours, which is to say that it occurs
 	before your bug has a chance to manifest itself.  If you can't
 	avoid that other bug (for example, it prevents your project
@@ -1020,14 +1020,14 @@
 	you can mark a changeset as untested by running <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg bisect --skip</command>.</para>
 
-      <para>A different problem could arise if your test for a bug's
+      <para id="x_158">A different problem could arise if your test for a bug's
 	presence is not specific enough.  If you check for <quote>my
 	  program crashes</quote>, then both your crashing bug and an
 	unrelated crashing bug that masks it will look like the same
 	thing, and mislead <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	  bisect</command>.</para>
 
-      <para>Another useful situation in which to use <command
+      <para id="x_159">Another useful situation in which to use <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg bisect --skip</command> is if you can't
 	test a revision because your project was in a broken and hence
 	untestable state at that revision, perhaps because someone
@@ -1038,7 +1038,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Bracket your search lazily</title>
 
-      <para>Choosing the first <quote>good</quote> and
+      <para id="x_15a">Choosing the first <quote>good</quote> and
 	<quote>bad</quote> changesets that will mark the end points of
 	your search is often easy, but it bears a little discussion
 	nevertheless.  From the perspective of <command
@@ -1046,7 +1046,7 @@
 	changeset is conventionally <quote>bad</quote>, and the older
 	changeset is <quote>good</quote>.</para>
 
-      <para>If you're having trouble remembering when a suitable
+      <para id="x_15b">If you're having trouble remembering when a suitable
 	<quote>good</quote> change was, so that you can tell <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg bisect</command>, you could do worse than
 	testing changesets at random.  Just remember to eliminate
@@ -1055,7 +1055,7 @@
 	where another problem masks the bug (as I discussed
 	above).</para>
 
-      <para>Even if you end up <quote>early</quote> by thousands of
+      <para id="x_15c">Even if you end up <quote>early</quote> by thousands of
 	changesets or months of history, you will only add a handful
 	of tests to the total number that <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	  bisect</command> must perform, thanks to its logarithmic
--- a/en/ch09-hook.xml	Thu Mar 19 20:54:12 2009 -0700
+++ b/en/ch09-hook.xml	Thu Mar 19 21:18:52 2009 -0700
@@ -4,12 +4,12 @@
   <?dbhtml filename="handling-repository-events-with-hooks.html"?>
   <title>Handling repository events with hooks</title>
 
-  <para>Mercurial offers a powerful mechanism to let you perform
+  <para id="x_1e6">Mercurial offers a powerful mechanism to let you perform
     automated actions in response to events that occur in a
     repository.  In some cases, you can even control Mercurial's
     response to those events.</para>
 
-  <para>The name Mercurial uses for one of these actions is a
+  <para id="x_1e7">The name Mercurial uses for one of these actions is a
     <emphasis>hook</emphasis>. Hooks are called
     <quote>triggers</quote> in some revision control systems, but the
     two names refer to the same idea.</para>
@@ -17,49 +17,49 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>An overview of hooks in Mercurial</title>
 
-    <para>Here is a brief list of the hooks that Mercurial supports.
+    <para id="x_1e8">Here is a brief list of the hooks that Mercurial supports.
       We will revisit each of these hooks in more detail later, in
       section <xref linkend="sec:hook:ref"/>.</para>
 
     <itemizedlist>
-      <listitem><para><literal role="hook">changegroup</literal>: This
+      <listitem><para id="x_1e9"><literal role="hook">changegroup</literal>: This
 	  is run after a group of changesets has been brought into the
 	  repository from elsewhere.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal role="hook">commit</literal>: This is
+      <listitem><para id="x_1ea"><literal role="hook">commit</literal>: This is
 	  run after a new changeset has been created in the local
 	  repository.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal role="hook">incoming</literal>: This is
+      <listitem><para id="x_1eb"><literal role="hook">incoming</literal>: This is
 	  run once for each new changeset that is brought into the
 	  repository from elsewhere.  Notice the difference from
 	  <literal role="hook">changegroup</literal>, which is run
 	  once per <emphasis>group</emphasis> of changesets brought
 	  in.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal role="hook">outgoing</literal>: This is
+      <listitem><para id="x_1ec"><literal role="hook">outgoing</literal>: This is
 	  run after a group of changesets has been transmitted from
 	  this repository.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal role="hook">prechangegroup</literal>:
+      <listitem><para id="x_1ed"><literal role="hook">prechangegroup</literal>:
 	  This is run before starting to bring a group of changesets
 	  into the repository.
 	</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal role="hook">precommit</literal>:
+      <listitem><para id="x_1ee"><literal role="hook">precommit</literal>:
 	  Controlling. This is run before starting a commit.
 	</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal role="hook">preoutgoing</literal>:
+      <listitem><para id="x_1ef"><literal role="hook">preoutgoing</literal>:
 	  Controlling. This is run before starting to transmit a group
 	  of changesets from this repository.
 	</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal role="hook">pretag</literal>:
+      <listitem><para id="x_1f0"><literal role="hook">pretag</literal>:
 	  Controlling. This is run before creating a tag.
 	</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal
+      <listitem><para id="x_1f1"><literal
 	    role="hook">pretxnchangegroup</literal>: Controlling. This
 	  is run after a group of changesets has been brought into the
 	  local repository from another, but before the transaction
@@ -67,27 +67,27 @@
 	  repository.
 	</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal role="hook">pretxncommit</literal>:
+      <listitem><para id="x_1f2"><literal role="hook">pretxncommit</literal>:
 	  Controlling. This is run after a new changeset has been
 	  created in the local repository, but before the transaction
 	  completes that will make it permanent.
 	</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal role="hook">preupdate</literal>:
+      <listitem><para id="x_1f3"><literal role="hook">preupdate</literal>:
 	  Controlling. This is run before starting an update or merge
 	  of the working directory.
 	</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal role="hook">tag</literal>: This is run
+      <listitem><para id="x_1f4"><literal role="hook">tag</literal>: This is run
 	  after a tag is created.
 	</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal role="hook">update</literal>: This is
+      <listitem><para id="x_1f5"><literal role="hook">update</literal>: This is
 	  run after an update or merge of the working directory has
 	  finished.
 	</para>
       </listitem></itemizedlist>
-    <para>Each of the hooks whose description begins with the word
+    <para id="x_1f6">Each of the hooks whose description begins with the word
       <quote>Controlling</quote> has the ability to determine whether
       an activity can proceed.  If the hook succeeds, the activity may
       proceed; if it fails, the activity is either not permitted or
@@ -101,7 +101,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Hooks are run with your privileges</title>
 
-      <para>When you run a Mercurial command in a repository, and the
+      <para id="x_1f7">When you run a Mercurial command in a repository, and the
 	command causes a hook to run, that hook runs on
 	<emphasis>your</emphasis> system, under
 	<emphasis>your</emphasis> user account, with
@@ -112,14 +112,14 @@
 	it does.
       </para>
 
-      <para>In some cases, you may be exposed to hooks that you did
+      <para id="x_1f8">In some cases, you may be exposed to hooks that you did
 	not install yourself.  If you work with Mercurial on an
 	unfamiliar system, Mercurial will run hooks defined in that
 	system's global <filename role="special">~/.hgrc</filename>
 	file.
       </para>
 
-      <para>If you are working with a repository owned by another
+      <para id="x_1f9">If you are working with a repository owned by another
 	user, Mercurial can run hooks defined in that user's
 	repository, but it will still run them as <quote>you</quote>.
 	For example, if you <command role="hg-cmd">hg pull</command>
@@ -131,7 +131,7 @@
       </para>
 
       <note>
-	<para>  This only applies if you are pulling from a repository
+	<para id="x_1fa">  This only applies if you are pulling from a repository
 	  on a local or network filesystem.  If you're pulling over
 	  http or ssh, any <literal role="hook">outgoing</literal>
 	  hook will run under whatever account is executing the server
@@ -139,7 +139,7 @@
 	</para>
       </note>
 
-      <para>XXX To see what hooks are defined in a repository, use the
+      <para id="x_1fb">XXX To see what hooks are defined in a repository, use the
 	<command role="hg-cmd">hg config hooks</command> command.  If
 	you are working in one repository, but talking to another that
 	you do not own (e.g. using <command role="hg-cmd">hg
@@ -152,27 +152,27 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Hooks do not propagate</title>
 
-      <para>In Mercurial, hooks are not revision controlled, and do
+      <para id="x_1fc">In Mercurial, hooks are not revision controlled, and do
 	not propagate when you clone, or pull from, a repository.  The
 	reason for this is simple: a hook is a completely arbitrary
 	piece of executable code.  It runs under your user identity,
 	with your privilege level, on your machine.
       </para>
 
-      <para>It would be extremely reckless for any distributed
+      <para id="x_1fd">It would be extremely reckless for any distributed
 	revision control system to implement revision-controlled
 	hooks, as this would offer an easily exploitable way to
 	subvert the accounts of users of the revision control system.
       </para>
 
-      <para>Since Mercurial does not propagate hooks, if you are
+      <para id="x_1fe">Since Mercurial does not propagate hooks, if you are
 	collaborating with other people on a common project, you
 	should not assume that they are using the same Mercurial hooks
 	as you are, or that theirs are correctly configured.  You
 	should document the hooks you expect people to use.
       </para>
 
-      <para>In a corporate intranet, this is somewhat easier to
+      <para id="x_1ff">In a corporate intranet, this is somewhat easier to
 	control, as you can for example provide a
 	<quote>standard</quote> installation of Mercurial on an NFS
 	filesystem, and use a site-wide <filename role="special">~/.hgrc</filename> file to define hooks that all users will
@@ -183,12 +183,12 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Hooks can be overridden</title>
 
-      <para>Mercurial allows you to override a hook definition by
+      <para id="x_200">Mercurial allows you to override a hook definition by
 	redefining the hook.  You can disable it by setting its value
 	to the empty string, or change its behaviour as you wish.
       </para>
 
-      <para>If you deploy a system- or site-wide <filename
+      <para id="x_201">If you deploy a system- or site-wide <filename
 	  role="special">~/.hgrc</filename> file that defines some
 	hooks, you should thus understand that your users can disable
 	or override those hooks.
@@ -198,7 +198,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Ensuring that critical hooks are run</title>
 
-      <para>Sometimes you may want to enforce a policy that you do not
+      <para id="x_202">Sometimes you may want to enforce a policy that you do not
 	want others to be able to work around.  For example, you may
 	have a requirement that every changeset must pass a rigorous
 	set of tests.  Defining this requirement via a hook in a
@@ -207,13 +207,13 @@
 	can subvert it at will by overriding the hook.
       </para>
 
-      <para>Instead, you can set up your policies for use of Mercurial
+      <para id="x_203">Instead, you can set up your policies for use of Mercurial
 	so that people are expected to propagate changes through a
 	well-known <quote>canonical</quote> server that you have
 	locked down and configured appropriately.
       </para>
 
-      <para>One way to do this is via a combination of social
+      <para id="x_204">One way to do this is via a combination of social
 	engineering and technology.  Set up a restricted-access
 	account; users can push changes over the network to
 	repositories managed by this account, but they cannot log into
@@ -222,7 +222,7 @@
 	they want.
       </para>
 
-      <para>When someone pushes a changeset to the server that
+      <para id="x_205">When someone pushes a changeset to the server that
 	everyone pulls from, the server will test the changeset before
 	it accepts it as permanent, and reject it if it fails to pass
 	the test suite.  If people only pull changes from this
@@ -236,19 +236,19 @@
     <title>Care with <literal>pretxn</literal> hooks in a
       shared-access repository</title>
 
-    <para>If you want to use hooks to do some automated work in a
+    <para id="x_206">If you want to use hooks to do some automated work in a
       repository that a number of people have shared access to, you
       need to be careful in how you do this.
     </para>
 
-    <para>Mercurial only locks a repository when it is writing to the
+    <para id="x_207">Mercurial only locks a repository when it is writing to the
       repository, and only the parts of Mercurial that write to the
       repository pay attention to locks.  Write locks are necessary to
       prevent multiple simultaneous writers from scribbling on each
       other's work, corrupting the repository.
     </para>
 
-    <para>Because Mercurial is careful with the order in which it
+    <para id="x_208">Because Mercurial is careful with the order in which it
       reads and writes data, it does not need to acquire a lock when
       it wants to read data from the repository.  The parts of
       Mercurial that read from the repository never pay attention to
@@ -256,14 +256,14 @@
       performance and concurrency.
     </para>
 
-    <para>With great performance comes a trade-off, though, one which
+    <para id="x_209">With great performance comes a trade-off, though, one which
       has the potential to cause you trouble unless you're aware of
       it.  To describe this requires a little detail about how
       Mercurial adds changesets to a repository and reads those
       changes.
     </para>
 
-    <para>When Mercurial <emphasis>writes</emphasis> metadata, it
+    <para id="x_20a">When Mercurial <emphasis>writes</emphasis> metadata, it
       writes it straight into the destination file.  It writes file
       data first, then manifest data (which contains pointers to the
       new file data), then changelog data (which contains pointers to
@@ -274,13 +274,13 @@
       before the transaction began.
     </para>
 
-    <para>When Mercurial <emphasis>reads</emphasis> metadata, it reads
+    <para id="x_20b">When Mercurial <emphasis>reads</emphasis> metadata, it reads
       the changelog first, then everything else.  Since a reader will
       only access parts of the manifest or file metadata that it can
       see in the changelog, it can never see partially written data.
     </para>
 
-    <para>Some controlling hooks (<literal
+    <para id="x_20c">Some controlling hooks (<literal
 	role="hook">pretxncommit</literal> and <literal
 	role="hook">pretxnchangegroup</literal>) run when a
       transaction is almost complete. All of the metadata has been
@@ -288,7 +288,7 @@
       cause the newly-written data to disappear.
     </para>
 
-    <para>If one of these hooks runs for long, it opens a window of
+    <para id="x_20d">If one of these hooks runs for long, it opens a window of
       time during which a reader can see the metadata for changesets
       that are not yet permanent, and should not be thought of as
       <quote>really there</quote>.  The longer the hook runs, the
@@ -298,7 +298,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>The problem illustrated</title>
 
-      <para>In principle, a good use for the <literal
+      <para id="x_20e">In principle, a good use for the <literal
 	  role="hook">pretxnchangegroup</literal> hook would be to
 	automatically build and test incoming changes before they are
 	accepted into a central repository.  This could let you
@@ -309,7 +309,7 @@
 	potentially breaking their build.
       </para>
 
-      <para>The safest technological answer to this challenge is to
+      <para id="x_20f">The safest technological answer to this challenge is to
 	set up such a <quote>gatekeeper</quote> repository as
 	<emphasis>unidirectional</emphasis>.  Let it take changes
 	pushed in from the outside, but do not allow anyone to pull
@@ -321,7 +321,7 @@
 	<emphasis>can</emphasis> pull from.
       </para>
 
-      <para>In practice, putting a centralised bottleneck like this in
+      <para id="x_210">In practice, putting a centralised bottleneck like this in
 	place is not often a good idea, and transaction visibility has
 	nothing to do with the problem.  As the size of a
 	project&emdash;and the time it takes to build and
@@ -332,7 +332,7 @@
 	involved.
       </para>
 
-      <para>An approach that scales better is to get people to build
+      <para id="x_211">An approach that scales better is to get people to build
 	and test before they push, then run automated builds and tests
 	centrally <emphasis>after</emphasis> a push, to be sure all is
 	well.  The advantage of this approach is that it does not
@@ -345,18 +345,18 @@
   <sect1 id="sec:hook:simple">
     <title>A short tutorial on using hooks</title>
 
-    <para>It is easy to write a Mercurial hook.  Let's start with a
+    <para id="x_212">It is easy to write a Mercurial hook.  Let's start with a
       hook that runs when you finish a <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	commit</command>, and simply prints the hash of the changeset
       you just created.  The hook is called <literal
 	role="hook">commit</literal>.
     </para>
 
-    <para>All hooks follow the pattern in this example.</para>
+    <para id="x_213">All hooks follow the pattern in this example.</para>
 
 &interaction.hook.simple.init;
 
-    <para>You add an entry to the <literal
+    <para id="x_214">You add an entry to the <literal
 	role="rc-hooks">hooks</literal> section of your <filename
 	role="special">~/.hgrc</filename>.  On the left is the name of
       the event to trigger on; on the right is the action to take.  As
@@ -368,12 +368,12 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Performing multiple actions per event</title>
 
-      <para>Quite often, you will want to define more than one hook
+      <para id="x_215">Quite often, you will want to define more than one hook
 	for a particular kind of event, as shown below.</para>
 
 &interaction.hook.simple.ext;
 
-      <para>Mercurial lets you do this by adding an
+      <para id="x_216">Mercurial lets you do this by adding an
 	<emphasis>extension</emphasis> to the end of a hook's name.
 	You extend a hook's name by giving the name of the hook,
 	followed by a full stop (the
@@ -384,7 +384,7 @@
 	<literal>commit</literal> event occurs.
       </para>
 
-      <para>To give a well-defined order of execution when there are
+      <para id="x_217">To give a well-defined order of execution when there are
 	multiple hooks defined for an event, Mercurial sorts hooks by
 	extension, and executes the hook commands in this sorted
 	order.  In the above example, it will execute
@@ -393,7 +393,7 @@
 	before both.
       </para>
 
-      <para>It is a good idea to use a somewhat descriptive extension
+      <para id="x_218">It is a good idea to use a somewhat descriptive extension
 	when you define a new hook.  This will help you to remember
 	what the hook was for.  If the hook fails, you'll get an error
 	message that contains the hook name and extension, so using a
@@ -406,20 +406,20 @@
     <sect2 id="sec:hook:perm">
       <title>Controlling whether an activity can proceed</title>
 
-      <para>In our earlier examples, we used the <literal
+      <para id="x_219">In our earlier examples, we used the <literal
 	  role="hook">commit</literal> hook, which is run after a
 	commit has completed.  This is one of several Mercurial hooks
 	that run after an activity finishes.  Such hooks have no way
 	of influencing the activity itself.
       </para>
 
-      <para>Mercurial defines a number of events that occur before an
+      <para id="x_21a">Mercurial defines a number of events that occur before an
 	activity starts; or after it starts, but before it finishes.
 	Hooks that trigger on these events have the added ability to
 	choose whether the activity can continue, or will abort.
       </para>
 
-      <para>The <literal role="hook">pretxncommit</literal> hook runs
+      <para id="x_21b">The <literal role="hook">pretxncommit</literal> hook runs
 	after a commit has all but completed.  In other words, the
 	metadata representing the changeset has been written out to
 	disk, but the transaction has not yet been allowed to
@@ -428,7 +428,7 @@
 	complete, or must be rolled back.
       </para>
 
-      <para>If the <literal role="hook">pretxncommit</literal> hook
+      <para id="x_21c">If the <literal role="hook">pretxncommit</literal> hook
 	exits with a status code of zero, the transaction is allowed
 	to complete; the commit finishes; and the <literal
 	  role="hook">commit</literal> hook is run.  If the <literal
@@ -440,7 +440,7 @@
 
 &interaction.hook.simple.pretxncommit;
 
-      <para>The hook in the example above checks that a commit comment
+      <para id="x_21d">The hook in the example above checks that a commit comment
 	contains a bug ID.  If it does, the commit can complete.  If
 	not, the commit is rolled back.
       </para>
@@ -450,7 +450,7 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Writing your own hooks</title>
 
-    <para>When you are writing a hook, you might find it useful to run
+    <para id="x_21e">When you are writing a hook, you might find it useful to run
       Mercurial either with the <option
 	role="hg-opt-global">-v</option> option, or the <envar
 	role="rc-item-ui">verbose</envar> config item set to
@@ -461,19 +461,19 @@
     <sect2 id="sec:hook:lang">
       <title>Choosing how your hook should run</title>
 
-      <para>You can write a hook either as a normal
+      <para id="x_21f">You can write a hook either as a normal
 	program&emdash;typically a shell script&emdash;or as a Python
 	function that is executed within the Mercurial process.
       </para>
 
-      <para>Writing a hook as an external program has the advantage
+      <para id="x_220">Writing a hook as an external program has the advantage
 	that it requires no knowledge of Mercurial's internals.  You
 	can call normal Mercurial commands to get any added
 	information you need.  The trade-off is that external hooks
 	are slower than in-process hooks.
       </para>
 
-      <para>An in-process Python hook has complete access to the
+      <para id="x_221">An in-process Python hook has complete access to the
 	Mercurial API, and does not <quote>shell out</quote> to
 	another process, so it is inherently faster than an external
 	hook.  It is also easier to obtain much of the information
@@ -481,7 +481,7 @@
 	running Mercurial commands.
       </para>
 
-      <para>If you are comfortable with Python, or require high
+      <para id="x_222">If you are comfortable with Python, or require high
 	performance, writing your hooks in Python may be a good
 	choice.  However, when you have a straightforward hook to
 	write and you don't need to care about performance (probably
@@ -492,13 +492,13 @@
     <sect2 id="sec:hook:param">
       <title>Hook parameters</title>
 
-      <para>Mercurial calls each hook with a set of well-defined
+      <para id="x_223">Mercurial calls each hook with a set of well-defined
 	parameters.  In Python, a parameter is passed as a keyword
 	argument to your hook function.  For an external program, a
 	parameter is passed as an environment variable.
       </para>
 
-      <para>Whether your hook is written in Python or as a shell
+      <para id="x_224">Whether your hook is written in Python or as a shell
 	script, the hook-specific parameter names and values will be
 	the same.  A boolean parameter will be represented as a
 	boolean value in Python, but as the number 1 (for
@@ -514,7 +514,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Hook return values and activity control</title>
 
-      <para>A hook that executes successfully must exit with a status
+      <para id="x_225">A hook that executes successfully must exit with a status
 	of zero if external, or return boolean <quote>false</quote> if
 	in-process.  Failure is indicated with a non-zero exit status
 	from an external hook, or an in-process hook returning boolean
@@ -522,7 +522,7 @@
 	exception, the hook is considered to have failed.
       </para>
 
-      <para>For a hook that controls whether an activity can proceed,
+      <para id="x_226">For a hook that controls whether an activity can proceed,
 	zero/false means <quote>allow</quote>, while
 	non-zero/true/exception means <quote>deny</quote>.
       </para>
@@ -531,23 +531,23 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Writing an external hook</title>
 
-      <para>When you define an external hook in your <filename
+      <para id="x_227">When you define an external hook in your <filename
 	  role="special">~/.hgrc</filename> and the hook is run, its
 	value is passed to your shell, which interprets it.  This
 	means that you can use normal shell constructs in the body of
 	the hook.
       </para>
 
-      <para>An executable hook is always run with its current
+      <para id="x_228">An executable hook is always run with its current
 	directory set to a repository's root directory.
       </para>
 
-      <para>Each hook parameter is passed in as an environment
+      <para id="x_229">Each hook parameter is passed in as an environment
 	variable; the name is upper-cased, and prefixed with the
 	string <quote><literal>HG_</literal></quote>.
       </para>
 
-      <para>With the exception of hook parameters, Mercurial does not
+      <para id="x_22a">With the exception of hook parameters, Mercurial does not
 	set or modify any environment variables when running a hook.
 	This is useful to remember if you are writing a site-wide hook
 	that may be run by a number of different users with differing
@@ -560,7 +560,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Telling Mercurial to use an in-process hook</title>
 
-      <para>The <filename role="special">~/.hgrc</filename> syntax
+      <para id="x_22b">The <filename role="special">~/.hgrc</filename> syntax
 	for defining an in-process hook is slightly different than for
 	an executable hook.  The value of the hook must start with the
 	text <quote><literal>python:</literal></quote>, and continue
@@ -568,19 +568,19 @@
 	the hook's value.
       </para>
 
-      <para>The module in which a hook lives is automatically imported
+      <para id="x_22c">The module in which a hook lives is automatically imported
 	when a hook is run.  So long as you have the module name and
 	<envar>PYTHONPATH</envar> right, it should <quote>just
 	  work</quote>.
       </para>
 
-      <para>The following <filename role="special">~/.hgrc</filename>
+      <para id="x_22d">The following <filename role="special">~/.hgrc</filename>
 	example snippet illustrates the syntax and meaning of the
 	notions we just described.
       </para>
       <programlisting>[hooks]
 commit.example = python:mymodule.submodule.myhook</programlisting>
-      <para>When Mercurial runs the <literal>commit.example</literal>
+      <para id="x_22e">When Mercurial runs the <literal>commit.example</literal>
 	hook, it imports <literal>mymodule.submodule</literal>, looks
 	for the callable object named <literal>myhook</literal>, and
 	calls it.
@@ -590,12 +590,12 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Writing an in-process hook</title>
 
-      <para>The simplest in-process hook does nothing, but illustrates
+      <para id="x_22f">The simplest in-process hook does nothing, but illustrates
 	the basic shape of the hook API:
       </para>
       <programlisting>def myhook(ui, repo, **kwargs):
     pass</programlisting>
-      <para>The first argument to a Python hook is always a <literal
+      <para id="x_230">The first argument to a Python hook is always a <literal
 	  role="py-mod-mercurial.ui">ui</literal> object.  The second
 	is a repository object; at the moment, it is always an
 	instance of <literal
@@ -615,7 +615,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Writing meaningful commit messages</title>
 
-      <para>It's hard to imagine a useful commit message being very
+      <para id="x_231">It's hard to imagine a useful commit message being very
 	short. The simple <literal role="hook">pretxncommit</literal>
 	hook of the example below will prevent you from committing a
 	changeset with a message that is less than ten bytes long.
@@ -627,7 +627,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Checking for trailing whitespace</title>
 
-      <para>An interesting use of a commit-related hook is to help you
+      <para id="x_232">An interesting use of a commit-related hook is to help you
 	to write cleaner code.  A simple example of <quote>cleaner
 	  code</quote> is the dictum that a change should not add any
 	new lines of text that contain <quote>trailing
@@ -638,7 +638,7 @@
 	prefer to get rid of it.
       </para>
 
-      <para>You can use either the <literal
+      <para id="x_233">You can use either the <literal
 	  role="hook">precommit</literal> or <literal
 	  role="hook">pretxncommit</literal> hook to tell whether you
 	have a trailing whitespace problem.  If you use the <literal
@@ -654,7 +654,7 @@
 	seem right.
       </para>
 
-      <para>Should you choose the <literal
+      <para id="x_234">Should you choose the <literal
 	  role="hook">pretxncommit</literal> hook, the check won't
 	occur until just before the transaction for the commit
 	completes.  This will allow you to check for problems only the
@@ -667,7 +667,7 @@
 
 &interaction.hook.ws.simple;
 
-      <para>In this example, we introduce a simple <literal
+      <para id="x_235">In this example, we introduce a simple <literal
 	  role="hook">pretxncommit</literal> hook that checks for
 	trailing whitespace.  This hook is short, but not very
 	helpful.  It exits with an error status if a change adds a
@@ -678,7 +678,7 @@
 	trailing whitespace cause problems.
       </para>
 
-      <para>The above version is much more complex, but also more
+      <para id="x_236">The above version is much more complex, but also more
 	useful.  It parses a unified diff to see if any lines add
 	trailing whitespace, and prints the name of the file and the
 	line number of each such occurrence.  Even better, if the
@@ -692,7 +692,7 @@
 
 &interaction.hook.ws.better;
 
-      <para>As a final aside, note in the example above the use of
+      <para id="x_237">As a final aside, note in the example above the use of
 	<command>perl</command>'s in-place editing feature to get rid
 	of trailing whitespace from a file.  This is concise and
 	useful enough that I will reproduce it here.
@@ -704,7 +704,7 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Bundled hooks</title>
 
-    <para>Mercurial ships with several bundled hooks.  You can find
+    <para id="x_238">Mercurial ships with several bundled hooks.  You can find
       them in the <filename class="directory">hgext</filename>
       directory of a Mercurial source tree.  If you are using a
       Mercurial binary package, the hooks will be located in the
@@ -716,7 +716,7 @@
       <title><literal role="hg-ext">acl</literal>&emdash;access
 	control for parts of a repository</title>
 
-      <para>The <literal role="hg-ext">acl</literal> extension lets
+      <para id="x_239">The <literal role="hg-ext">acl</literal> extension lets
 	you control which remote users are allowed to push changesets
 	to a networked server.  You can protect any portion of a
 	repository (including the entire repo), so that a specific
@@ -724,7 +724,7 @@
 	portion.
       </para>
 
-      <para>This extension implements access control based on the
+      <para id="x_23a">This extension implements access control based on the
 	identity of the user performing a push,
 	<emphasis>not</emphasis> on who committed the changesets
 	they're pushing.  It makes sense to use this hook only if you
@@ -737,7 +737,7 @@
 	<title>Configuring the <literal role="hook">acl</literal>
 	  hook</title>
 
-	<para>In order to manage incoming changesets, the <literal
+	<para id="x_23b">In order to manage incoming changesets, the <literal
 	    role="hg-ext">acl</literal> hook must be used as a
 	  <literal role="hook">pretxnchangegroup</literal> hook.  This
 	  lets it see which files are modified by each incoming
@@ -747,18 +747,18 @@
 	<programlisting>[hooks]
 pretxnchangegroup.acl = python:hgext.acl.hook</programlisting>
 
-	<para>The <literal role="hg-ext">acl</literal> extension is
+	<para id="x_23c">The <literal role="hg-ext">acl</literal> extension is
 	  configured using three sections.
 	</para>
 
-	<para>The <literal role="rc-acl">acl</literal> section has
+	<para id="x_23d">The <literal role="rc-acl">acl</literal> section has
 	  only one entry, <envar role="rc-item-acl">sources</envar>,
 	  which lists the sources of incoming changesets that the hook
 	  should pay attention to.  You don't normally need to
 	  configure this section.
 	</para>
 	<itemizedlist>
-	  <listitem><para><envar role="rc-item-acl">serve</envar>:
+	  <listitem><para id="x_23e"><envar role="rc-item-acl">serve</envar>:
 	      Control incoming changesets that are arriving from a
 	      remote repository over http or ssh.  This is the default
 	      value of <envar role="rc-item-acl">sources</envar>, and
@@ -766,23 +766,23 @@
 	      configuration item.
 	    </para>
 	  </listitem>
-	  <listitem><para><envar role="rc-item-acl">pull</envar>:
+	  <listitem><para id="x_23f"><envar role="rc-item-acl">pull</envar>:
 	      Control incoming changesets that are arriving via a pull
 	      from a local repository.
 	    </para>
 	  </listitem>
-	  <listitem><para><envar role="rc-item-acl">push</envar>:
+	  <listitem><para id="x_240"><envar role="rc-item-acl">push</envar>:
 	      Control incoming changesets that are arriving via a push
 	      from a local repository.
 	    </para>
 	  </listitem>
-	  <listitem><para><envar role="rc-item-acl">bundle</envar>:
+	  <listitem><para id="x_241"><envar role="rc-item-acl">bundle</envar>:
 	      Control incoming changesets that are arriving from
 	      another repository via a bundle.
 	    </para>
 	  </listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-	<para>The <literal role="rc-acl.allow">acl.allow</literal>
+	<para id="x_242">The <literal role="rc-acl.allow">acl.allow</literal>
 	  section controls the users that are allowed to add
 	  changesets to the repository.  If this section is not
 	  present, all users that are not explicitly denied are
@@ -791,13 +791,13 @@
 	  that all users are denied).
 	</para>
 
-	<para>The <literal role="rc-acl.deny">acl.deny</literal>
+	<para id="x_243">The <literal role="rc-acl.deny">acl.deny</literal>
 	  section determines which users are denied from adding
 	  changesets to the repository.  If this section is not
 	  present or is empty, no users are denied.
 	</para>
 
-	<para>The syntaxes for the <literal
+	<para id="x_244">The syntaxes for the <literal
 	    role="rc-acl.allow">acl.allow</literal> and <literal
 	    role="rc-acl.deny">acl.deny</literal> sections are
 	  identical.  On the left of each entry is a glob pattern that
@@ -805,7 +805,7 @@
 	  repository; on the right, a user name.
 	</para>
 
-	<para>In the following example, the user
+	<para id="x_245">In the following example, the user
 	  <literal>docwriter</literal> can only push changes to the
 	  <filename class="directory">docs</filename> subtree of the
 	  repository, while <literal>intern</literal> can push changes
@@ -821,7 +821,7 @@
       <sect3>
 	<title>Testing and troubleshooting</title>
 
-	<para>If you want to test the <literal
+	<para id="x_246">If you want to test the <literal
 	    role="hg-ext">acl</literal> hook, run it with Mercurial's
 	  debugging output enabled.  Since you'll probably be running
 	  it on a server where it's not convenient (or sometimes
@@ -832,7 +832,7 @@
 	</para>
 	<programlisting>[ui]
 debug = true</programlisting>
-	<para>With this enabled, the <literal
+	<para id="x_247">With this enabled, the <literal
 	    role="hg-ext">acl</literal> hook will print enough
 	  information to let you figure out why it is allowing or
 	  forbidding pushes from specific users.
@@ -845,14 +845,14 @@
 	  role="hg-ext">bugzilla</literal>&emdash;integration with
 	Bugzilla</title>
 
-      <para>The <literal role="hg-ext">bugzilla</literal> extension
+      <para id="x_248">The <literal role="hg-ext">bugzilla</literal> extension
 	adds a comment to a Bugzilla bug whenever it finds a reference
 	to that bug ID in a commit comment.  You can install this hook
 	on a shared server, so that any time a remote user pushes
 	changes to this server, the hook gets run.
       </para>
 
-      <para>It adds a comment to the bug that looks like this (you can
+      <para id="x_249">It adds a comment to the bug that looks like this (you can
 	configure the contents of the comment&emdash;see below):
       </para>
       <programlisting>Changeset aad8b264143a, made by Joe User
@@ -861,19 +861,19 @@
 	http://hg.domain.com/frobnitz?cmd=changeset;node=aad8b264143a
 	Changeset description: Fix bug 10483 by guarding against some
 	NULL pointers</programlisting>
-      <para>The value of this hook is that it automates the process of
+      <para id="x_24a">The value of this hook is that it automates the process of
 	updating a bug any time a changeset refers to it.  If you
 	configure the hook properly, it makes it easy for people to
 	browse straight from a Bugzilla bug to a changeset that refers
 	to that bug.
       </para>
 
-      <para>You can use the code in this hook as a starting point for
+      <para id="x_24b">You can use the code in this hook as a starting point for
 	some more exotic Bugzilla integration recipes.  Here are a few
 	possibilities:
       </para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para>Require that every changeset pushed to the
+	<listitem><para id="x_24c">Require that every changeset pushed to the
 	    server have a valid bug ID in its commit comment.  In this
 	    case, you'd want to configure the hook as a <literal
 	      role="hook">pretxncommit</literal> hook.  This would
@@ -881,7 +881,7 @@
 	    IDs.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>Allow incoming changesets to automatically
+	<listitem><para id="x_24d">Allow incoming changesets to automatically
 	    modify the <emphasis>state</emphasis> of a bug, as well as
 	    simply adding a comment.  For example, the hook could
 	    recognise the string <quote>fixed bug 31337</quote> as
@@ -894,7 +894,7 @@
 	<title>Configuring the <literal role="hook">bugzilla</literal>
 	  hook</title>
 
-	<para>You should configure this hook in your server's
+	<para id="x_24e">You should configure this hook in your server's
 	  <filename role="special">~/.hgrc</filename> as an <literal
 	    role="hook">incoming</literal> hook, for example as
 	  follows:
@@ -902,25 +902,25 @@
 	<programlisting>[hooks]
 incoming.bugzilla = python:hgext.bugzilla.hook</programlisting>
 
-	<para>Because of the specialised nature of this hook, and
+	<para id="x_24f">Because of the specialised nature of this hook, and
 	  because Bugzilla was not written with this kind of
 	  integration in mind, configuring this hook is a somewhat
 	  involved process.
 	</para>
 
-	<para>Before you begin, you must install the MySQL bindings
+	<para id="x_250">Before you begin, you must install the MySQL bindings
 	  for Python on the host(s) where you'll be running the hook.
 	  If this is not available as a binary package for your
 	  system, you can download it from
 	  <citation>web:mysql-python</citation>.
 	</para>
 
-	<para>Configuration information for this hook lives in the
+	<para id="x_251">Configuration information for this hook lives in the
 	  <literal role="rc-bugzilla">bugzilla</literal> section of
 	  your <filename role="special">~/.hgrc</filename>.
 	</para>
 	<itemizedlist>
-	  <listitem><para><envar
+	  <listitem><para id="x_252"><envar
 		role="rc-item-bugzilla">version</envar>: The version
 	      of Bugzilla installed on the server.  The database
 	      schema that Bugzilla uses changes occasionally, so this
@@ -929,14 +929,14 @@
 	      <literal>2.16</literal>.
 	    </para>
 	  </listitem>
-	  <listitem><para><envar role="rc-item-bugzilla">host</envar>:
+	  <listitem><para id="x_253"><envar role="rc-item-bugzilla">host</envar>:
 	      The hostname of the MySQL server that stores your
 	      Bugzilla data.  The database must be configured to allow
 	      connections from whatever host you are running the
 	      <literal role="hook">bugzilla</literal> hook on.
 	    </para>
 	  </listitem>
-	  <listitem><para><envar role="rc-item-bugzilla">user</envar>:
+	  <listitem><para id="x_254"><envar role="rc-item-bugzilla">user</envar>:
 	      The username with which to connect to the MySQL server.
 	      The database must be configured to allow this user to
 	      connect from whatever host you are running the <literal
@@ -947,7 +947,7 @@
 	      MySQL database.
 	    </para>
 	  </listitem>
-	  <listitem><para><envar
+	  <listitem><para id="x_255"><envar
 		role="rc-item-bugzilla">password</envar>: The MySQL
 	      password for the user you configured above.  This is
 	      stored as plain text, so you should make sure that
@@ -956,14 +956,14 @@
 	      store this information.
 	    </para>
 	  </listitem>
-	  <listitem><para><envar role="rc-item-bugzilla">db</envar>:
+	  <listitem><para id="x_256"><envar role="rc-item-bugzilla">db</envar>:
 	      The name of the Bugzilla database on the MySQL server.
 	      The default value of this item is
 	      <literal>bugs</literal>, which is the standard name of
 	      the MySQL database where Bugzilla stores its data.
 	    </para>
 	  </listitem>
-	  <listitem><para><envar
+	  <listitem><para id="x_257"><envar
 		role="rc-item-bugzilla">notify</envar>: If you want
 	      Bugzilla to send out a notification email to subscribers
 	      after this hook has added a comment to a bug, you will
@@ -976,7 +976,7 @@
 	    <programlisting>cd /var/www/html/bugzilla &amp;&amp;
 	      ./processmail %s nobody@nowhere.com</programlisting>
 	  </listitem>
-	  <listitem><para>  The Bugzilla
+	  <listitem><para id="x_258">  The Bugzilla
 	      <literal>processmail</literal> program expects to be
 	      given a bug ID (the hook replaces
 	      <quote><literal>%s</literal></quote> with the bug ID)
@@ -993,7 +993,7 @@
       <sect3>
 	<title>Mapping committer names to Bugzilla user names</title>
 
-	<para>By default, the <literal
+	<para id="x_259">By default, the <literal
 	    role="hg-ext">bugzilla</literal> hook tries to use the
 	  email address of a changeset's committer as the Bugzilla
 	  user name with which to update a bug.  If this does not suit
@@ -1002,14 +1002,14 @@
 	    role="rc-usermap">usermap</literal> section.
 	</para>
 
-	<para>Each item in the <literal
+	<para id="x_25a">Each item in the <literal
 	    role="rc-usermap">usermap</literal> section contains an
 	  email address on the left, and a Bugzilla user name on the
 	  right.
 	</para>
 	<programlisting>[usermap]
 jane.user@example.com = jane</programlisting>
-	<para>You can either keep the <literal
+	<para id="x_25b">You can either keep the <literal
 	    role="rc-usermap">usermap</literal> data in a normal
 	  <filename role="special">~/.hgrc</filename>, or tell the
 	  <literal role="hg-ext">bugzilla</literal> hook to read the
@@ -1025,7 +1025,7 @@
 	<programlisting># regular hgrc file refers to external usermap file
 [bugzilla]
 usermap = /home/hg/repos/userdata/bugzilla-usermap.conf</programlisting>
-	<para>While the <filename>usermap</filename> file that it
+	<para id="x_25c">While the <filename>usermap</filename> file that it
 	  refers to might look like this:
 	</para>
 	<programlisting># bugzilla-usermap.conf - inside a hg repository
@@ -1035,14 +1035,14 @@
       <sect3>
 	<title>Configuring the text that gets added to a bug</title>
 
-	<para>You can configure the text that this hook adds as a
+	<para id="x_25d">You can configure the text that this hook adds as a
 	  comment; you specify it in the form of a Mercurial template.
 	  Several <filename role="special">~/.hgrc</filename> entries
 	  (still in the <literal role="rc-bugzilla">bugzilla</literal>
 	  section) control this behaviour.
 	</para>
 	<itemizedlist>
-	  <listitem><para><literal>strip</literal>: The number of
+	  <listitem><para id="x_25e"><literal>strip</literal>: The number of
 	      leading path elements to strip from a repository's path
 	      name to construct a partial path for a URL. For example,
 	      if the repositories on your server live under <filename
@@ -1056,7 +1056,7 @@
 	      expanding a template, as <literal>webroot</literal>.
 	    </para>
 	  </listitem>
-	  <listitem><para><literal>template</literal>: The text of the
+	  <listitem><para id="x_25f"><literal>template</literal>: The text of the
 	      template to use.  In addition to the usual
 	      changeset-related variables, this template can use
 	      <literal>hgweb</literal> (the value of the
@@ -1066,7 +1066,7 @@
 	    </para>
 	  </listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-	<para>In addition, you can add a <envar
+	<para id="x_260">In addition, you can add a <envar
 	    role="rc-item-web">baseurl</envar> item to the <literal
 	    role="rc-web">web</literal> section of your <filename
 	    role="special">~/.hgrc</filename>.  The <literal
@@ -1078,7 +1078,7 @@
 	<programlisting>[web]
 baseurl = http://hg.domain.com/</programlisting>
 
-	<para>Here is an example set of <literal
+	<para id="x_261">Here is an example set of <literal
 	    role="hg-ext">bugzilla</literal> hook config information.
 	</para>
 
@@ -1088,13 +1088,13 @@
       <sect3>
 	<title>Testing and troubleshooting</title>
 
-	<para>The most common problems with configuring the <literal
+	<para id="x_262">The most common problems with configuring the <literal
 	    role="hg-ext">bugzilla</literal> hook relate to running
 	  Bugzilla's <filename>processmail</filename> script and
 	  mapping committer names to user names.
 	</para>
 
-	<para>Recall from section <xref
+	<para id="x_263">Recall from section <xref
 	    linkend="sec:hook:bugzilla:config"/> above that the user
 	  that runs the Mercurial process on the server is also the
 	  one that will run the <filename>processmail</filename>
@@ -1105,19 +1105,19 @@
 	  under.
 	</para>
 
-	<para>You can cause <filename>processmail</filename> to be run
+	<para id="x_264">You can cause <filename>processmail</filename> to be run
 	  with the suitable user's identity using the
 	  <command>sudo</command> command.  Here is an example entry
 	  for a <filename>sudoers</filename> file.
 	</para>
 	<programlisting>hg_user = (httpd_user)
 NOPASSWD: /var/www/html/bugzilla/processmail-wrapper %s</programlisting>
-	<para>This allows the <literal>hg_user</literal> user to run a
+	<para id="x_265">This allows the <literal>hg_user</literal> user to run a
 	  <filename>processmail-wrapper</filename> program under the
 	  identity of <literal>httpd_user</literal>.
 	</para>
 
-	<para>This indirection through a wrapper script is necessary,
+	<para id="x_266">This indirection through a wrapper script is necessary,
 	  because <filename>processmail</filename> expects to be run
 	  with its current directory set to wherever you installed
 	  Bugzilla; you can't specify that kind of constraint in a
@@ -1126,18 +1126,18 @@
 	</para>
 	<programlisting>#!/bin/sh
 cd `dirname $0` &amp;&amp; ./processmail "$1" nobody@example.com</programlisting>
-	<para>It doesn't seem to matter what email address you pass to
+	<para id="x_267">It doesn't seem to matter what email address you pass to
 	  <filename>processmail</filename>.
 	</para>
 
-	<para>If your <literal role="rc-usermap">usermap</literal> is
+	<para id="x_268">If your <literal role="rc-usermap">usermap</literal> is
 	  not set up correctly, users will see an error message from
 	  the <literal role="hg-ext">bugzilla</literal> hook when they
 	  push changes to the server.  The error message will look
 	  like this:
 	</para>
 	<programlisting>cannot find bugzilla user id for john.q.public@example.com</programlisting>
-	<para>What this means is that the committer's address,
+	<para id="x_269">What this means is that the committer's address,
 	  <literal>john.q.public@example.com</literal>, is not a valid
 	  Bugzilla user name, nor does it have an entry in your
 	  <literal role="rc-usermap">usermap</literal> that maps it to
@@ -1150,7 +1150,7 @@
       <title><literal role="hg-ext">notify</literal>&emdash;send email
 	notifications</title>
 
-      <para>Although Mercurial's built-in web server provides RSS
+      <para id="x_26a">Although Mercurial's built-in web server provides RSS
 	feeds of changes in every repository, many people prefer to
 	receive change notifications via email.  The <literal
 	  role="hg-ext">notify</literal> hook lets you send out
@@ -1158,13 +1158,13 @@
 	arrive that those subscribers are interested in.
       </para>
 
-      <para>As with the <literal role="hg-ext">bugzilla</literal>
+      <para id="x_26b">As with the <literal role="hg-ext">bugzilla</literal>
 	hook, the <literal role="hg-ext">notify</literal> hook is
 	template-driven, so you can customise the contents of the
 	notification messages that it sends.
       </para>
 
-      <para>By default, the <literal role="hg-ext">notify</literal>
+      <para id="x_26c">By default, the <literal role="hg-ext">notify</literal>
 	hook includes a diff of every changeset that it sends out; you
 	can limit the size of the diff, or turn this feature off
 	entirely.  It is useful for letting subscribers review changes
@@ -1175,7 +1175,7 @@
 	<title>Configuring the <literal role="hg-ext">notify</literal>
 	  hook</title>
 
-	<para>You can set up the <literal
+	<para id="x_26d">You can set up the <literal
 	    role="hg-ext">notify</literal> hook to send one email
 	  message per incoming changeset, or one per incoming group of
 	  changesets (all those that arrived in a single pull or
@@ -1187,12 +1187,12 @@
 # send one email per change
 incoming.notify = python:hgext.notify.hook</programlisting>
 
-	<para>Configuration information for this hook lives in the
+	<para id="x_26e">Configuration information for this hook lives in the
 	  <literal role="rc-notify">notify</literal> section of a
 	  <filename role="special">~/.hgrc</filename> file.
 	</para>
 	<itemizedlist>
-	  <listitem><para><envar role="rc-item-notify">test</envar>:
+	  <listitem><para id="x_26f"><envar role="rc-item-notify">test</envar>:
 	      By default, this hook does not send out email at all;
 	      instead, it prints the message that it
 	      <emphasis>would</emphasis> send.  Set this item to
@@ -1204,7 +1204,7 @@
 	      notifications while you debug your configuration.
 	    </para>
 	  </listitem>
-	  <listitem><para><envar role="rc-item-notify">config</envar>:
+	  <listitem><para id="x_270"><envar role="rc-item-notify">config</envar>:
 	      The path to a configuration file that contains
 	      subscription information.  This is kept separate from
 	      the main <filename role="special">~/.hgrc</filename> so
@@ -1213,7 +1213,7 @@
 	      subscriptions, and push the changes back to your server.
 	    </para>
 	  </listitem>
-	  <listitem><para><envar role="rc-item-notify">strip</envar>:
+	  <listitem><para id="x_271"><envar role="rc-item-notify">strip</envar>:
 	      The number of leading path separator characters to strip
 	      from a repository's path, when deciding whether a
 	      repository has subscribers.  For example, if the
@@ -1230,13 +1230,13 @@
 	      match subscribers against that.
 	    </para>
 	  </listitem>
-	  <listitem><para><envar
+	  <listitem><para id="x_272"><envar
 		role="rc-item-notify">template</envar>: The template
 	      text to use when sending messages.  This specifies both
 	      the contents of the message header and its body.
 	    </para>
 	  </listitem>
-	  <listitem><para><envar
+	  <listitem><para id="x_273"><envar
 		role="rc-item-notify">maxdiff</envar>: The maximum
 	      number of lines of diff data to append to the end of a
 	      message.  If a diff is longer than this, it is
@@ -1245,7 +1245,7 @@
 	      emails.
 	    </para>
 	  </listitem>
-	  <listitem><para><envar
+	  <listitem><para id="x_274"><envar
 		role="rc-item-notify">sources</envar>: A list of
 	      sources of changesets to consider.  This lets you limit
 	      <literal role="hg-ext">notify</literal> to only sending
@@ -1257,19 +1257,19 @@
 	    </para>
 	  </listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-	<para>If you set the <envar role="rc-item-web">baseurl</envar>
+	<para id="x_275">If you set the <envar role="rc-item-web">baseurl</envar>
 	  item in the <literal role="rc-web">web</literal> section,
 	  you can use it in a template; it will be available as
 	  <literal>webroot</literal>.
 	</para>
 
-	<para>Here is an example set of <literal
+	<para id="x_276">Here is an example set of <literal
 	    role="hg-ext">notify</literal> configuration information.
 	</para>
 
 	&ch10-notify-config.lst;
 
-	<para>This will produce a message that looks like the
+	<para id="x_277">This will produce a message that looks like the
 	  following:
 	</para>
 
@@ -1279,7 +1279,7 @@
       <sect3>
 	<title>Testing and troubleshooting</title>
 
-	<para>Do not forget that by default, the <literal
+	<para id="x_278">Do not forget that by default, the <literal
 		role="hg-ext">notify</literal> extension <emphasis>will not
 	  send any mail</emphasis> until you explicitly configure it to do so,
 	  by setting <envar role="rc-item-notify">test</envar> to
@@ -1296,11 +1296,11 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>In-process hook execution</title>
 
-      <para>An in-process hook is called with arguments of the
+      <para id="x_279">An in-process hook is called with arguments of the
 	following form:
       </para>
       <programlisting>def myhook(ui, repo, **kwargs): pass</programlisting>
-      <para>The <literal>ui</literal> parameter is a <literal
+      <para id="x_27a">The <literal>ui</literal> parameter is a <literal
 	  role="py-mod-mercurial.ui">ui</literal> object. The
 	<literal>repo</literal> parameter is a <literal
 	  role="py-mod-mercurial.localrepo">localrepository</literal>
@@ -1309,38 +1309,38 @@
 	being invoked, with the following common features:
       </para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para>If a parameter is named
+	<listitem><para id="x_27b">If a parameter is named
 	    <literal>node</literal> or <literal>parentN</literal>, it
 	    will contain a hexadecimal changeset ID. The empty string
 	    is used to represent <quote>null changeset ID</quote>
 	    instead of a string of zeroes.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>If a parameter is named
+	<listitem><para id="x_27c">If a parameter is named
 	    <literal>url</literal>, it will contain the URL of a
 	    remote repository, if that can be determined.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>Boolean-valued parameters are represented as
+	<listitem><para id="x_27d">Boolean-valued parameters are represented as
 	    Python <literal>bool</literal> objects.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-      <para>An in-process hook is called without a change to the
+      <para id="x_27e">An in-process hook is called without a change to the
 	process's working directory (unlike external hooks, which are
 	run in the root of the repository).  It must not change the
 	process's working directory, or it will cause any calls it
 	makes into the Mercurial API to fail.
       </para>
 
-      <para>If a hook returns a boolean <quote>false</quote> value, it
+      <para id="x_27f">If a hook returns a boolean <quote>false</quote> value, it
 	is considered to have succeeded.  If it returns a boolean
 	<quote>true</quote> value or raises an exception, it is
 	considered to have failed.  A useful way to think of the
 	calling convention is <quote>tell me if you fail</quote>.
       </para>
 
-      <para>Note that changeset IDs are passed into Python hooks as
+      <para id="x_280">Note that changeset IDs are passed into Python hooks as
 	hexadecimal strings, not the binary hashes that Mercurial's
 	APIs normally use.  To convert a hash from hex to binary, use
 	the <literal>bin</literal> function.
@@ -1350,7 +1350,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>External hook execution</title>
 
-      <para>An external hook is passed to the shell of the user
+      <para id="x_281">An external hook is passed to the shell of the user
 	running Mercurial. Features of that shell, such as variable
 	substitution and command redirection, are available.  The hook
 	is run in the root directory of the repository (unlike
@@ -1358,7 +1358,7 @@
 	Mercurial was run in).
       </para>
 
-      <para>Hook parameters are passed to the hook as environment
+      <para id="x_282">Hook parameters are passed to the hook as environment
 	variables.  Each environment variable's name is converted in
 	upper case and prefixed with the string
 	<quote><literal>HG_</literal></quote>.  For example, if the
@@ -1367,7 +1367,7 @@
 	parameter will be <quote><literal>HG_NODE</literal></quote>.
       </para>
 
-      <para>A boolean parameter is represented as the string
+      <para id="x_283">A boolean parameter is represented as the string
 	<quote><literal>1</literal></quote> for <quote>true</quote>,
 	<quote><literal>0</literal></quote> for <quote>false</quote>.
 	If an environment variable is named <envar>HG_NODE</envar>,
@@ -1379,7 +1379,7 @@
 	URL of a remote repository, if that can be determined.
       </para>
 
-      <para>If a hook exits with a status of zero, it is considered to
+      <para id="x_284">If a hook exits with a status of zero, it is considered to
 	have succeeded.  If it exits with a non-zero status, it is
 	considered to have failed.
       </para>
@@ -1388,7 +1388,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Finding out where changesets come from</title>
 
-      <para>A hook that involves the transfer of changesets between a
+      <para id="x_285">A hook that involves the transfer of changesets between a
 	local repository and another may be able to find out
 	information about the <quote>far side</quote>.  Mercurial
 	knows <emphasis>how</emphasis> changes are being transferred,
@@ -1399,7 +1399,7 @@
       <sect3 id="sec:hook:sources">
 	<title>Sources of changesets</title>
 
-	<para>Mercurial will tell a hook what means are, or were, used
+	<para id="x_286">Mercurial will tell a hook what means are, or were, used
 	  to transfer changesets between repositories.  This is
 	  provided by Mercurial in a Python parameter named
 	  <literal>source</literal>, or an environment variable named
@@ -1407,22 +1407,22 @@
 	</para>
 
 	<itemizedlist>
-	  <listitem><para><literal>serve</literal>: Changesets are
+	  <listitem><para id="x_287"><literal>serve</literal>: Changesets are
 	      transferred to or from a remote repository over http or
 	      ssh.
 	    </para>
 	  </listitem>
-	  <listitem><para><literal>pull</literal>: Changesets are
+	  <listitem><para id="x_288"><literal>pull</literal>: Changesets are
 	      being transferred via a pull from one repository into
 	      another.
 	    </para>
 	  </listitem>
-	  <listitem><para><literal>push</literal>: Changesets are
+	  <listitem><para id="x_289"><literal>push</literal>: Changesets are
 	      being transferred via a push from one repository into
 	      another.
 	    </para>
 	  </listitem>
-	  <listitem><para><literal>bundle</literal>: Changesets are
+	  <listitem><para id="x_28a"><literal>bundle</literal>: Changesets are
 	      being transferred to or from a bundle.
 	    </para>
 	  </listitem></itemizedlist>
@@ -1432,7 +1432,7 @@
 	<title>Where changes are going&emdash;remote repository
 	  URLs</title>
 
-	<para>When possible, Mercurial will tell a hook the location
+	<para id="x_28b">When possible, Mercurial will tell a hook the location
 	  of the <quote>far side</quote> of an activity that transfers
 	  changeset data between repositories.  This is provided by
 	  Mercurial in a Python parameter named
@@ -1440,26 +1440,26 @@
 	  <envar>HG_URL</envar>.
 	</para>
 
-	<para>This information is not always known.  If a hook is
+	<para id="x_28c">This information is not always known.  If a hook is
 	  invoked in a repository that is being served via http or
 	  ssh, Mercurial cannot tell where the remote repository is,
 	  but it may know where the client is connecting from.  In
 	  such cases, the URL will take one of the following forms:
 	</para>
 	<itemizedlist>
-	  <listitem><para><literal>remote:ssh:1.2.3.4</literal>&emdash;remote 
+	  <listitem><para id="x_28d"><literal>remote:ssh:1.2.3.4</literal>&emdash;remote 
 	      ssh client, at the IP address
 	      <literal>1.2.3.4</literal>.
 	    </para>
 	  </listitem>
-	  <listitem><para><literal>remote:http:1.2.3.4</literal>&emdash;remote 
+	  <listitem><para id="x_28e"><literal>remote:http:1.2.3.4</literal>&emdash;remote 
 	      http client, at the IP address
 	      <literal>1.2.3.4</literal>.  If the client is using SSL,
 	      this will be of the form
 	      <literal>remote:https:1.2.3.4</literal>.
 	    </para>
 	  </listitem>
-	  <listitem><para>Empty&emdash;no information could be
+	  <listitem><para id="x_28f">Empty&emdash;no information could be
 	      discovered about the remote client.
 	    </para>
 	  </listitem></itemizedlist>
@@ -1474,7 +1474,7 @@
       <title><literal role="hook">changegroup</literal>&emdash;after
 	remote changesets added</title>
 
-      <para>This hook is run after a group of pre-existing changesets
+      <para id="x_290">This hook is run after a group of pre-existing changesets
 	has been added to the repository, for example via a <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg pull</command> or <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	  unbundle</command>.  This hook is run once per operation
@@ -1484,16 +1484,16 @@
 	arrive in a group.
       </para>
 
-      <para>Some possible uses for this hook include kicking off an
+      <para id="x_291">Some possible uses for this hook include kicking off an
 	automated build or test of the added changesets, updating a
 	bug database, or notifying subscribers that a repository
 	contains new changes.
       </para>
 
-      <para>Parameters to this hook:
+      <para id="x_292">Parameters to this hook:
       </para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para><literal>node</literal>: A changeset ID.  The
+	<listitem><para id="x_293"><literal>node</literal>: A changeset ID.  The
 	    changeset ID of the first changeset in the group that was
 	    added.  All changesets between this and
 	    <literal role="tag">tip</literal>, inclusive, were added by a single
@@ -1502,19 +1502,19 @@
 	      role="hg-cmd">hg unbundle</command>.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><literal>source</literal>: A string.  The
+	<listitem><para id="x_294"><literal>source</literal>: A string.  The
 	    source of these changes.  See section <xref
 	      linkend="sec:hook:sources"/> for details.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><literal>url</literal>: A URL.  The location
+	<listitem><para id="x_295"><literal>url</literal>: A URL.  The location
 	    of the remote repository, if known.  See section <xref
 	      linkend="sec:hook:url"/> for more
 	    information.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-      <para>See also: <literal role="hook">incoming</literal> (section
+      <para id="x_296">See also: <literal role="hook">incoming</literal> (section
 	<xref linkend="sec:hook:incoming"/>), <literal
 	  role="hook">prechangegroup</literal> (section <xref
 	  linkend="sec:hook:prechangegroup"/>), <literal
@@ -1527,28 +1527,28 @@
       <title><literal role="hook">commit</literal>&emdash;after a new
 	changeset is created</title>
 
-      <para>This hook is run after a new changeset has been created.
+      <para id="x_297">This hook is run after a new changeset has been created.
       </para>
 
-      <para>Parameters to this hook:
+      <para id="x_298">Parameters to this hook:
       </para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para><literal>node</literal>: A changeset ID.  The
+	<listitem><para id="x_299"><literal>node</literal>: A changeset ID.  The
 	    changeset ID of the newly committed changeset.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><literal>parent1</literal>: A changeset ID.
+	<listitem><para id="x_29a"><literal>parent1</literal>: A changeset ID.
 	    The changeset ID of the first parent of the newly
 	    committed changeset.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><literal>parent2</literal>: A changeset ID.
+	<listitem><para id="x_29b"><literal>parent2</literal>: A changeset ID.
 	    The changeset ID of the second parent of the newly
 	    committed changeset.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-      <para>See also: <literal role="hook">precommit</literal>
+      <para id="x_29c">See also: <literal role="hook">precommit</literal>
 	(section <xref linkend="sec:hook:precommit"/>), <literal
 	  role="hook">pretxncommit</literal> (section <xref
 	  linkend="sec:hook:pretxncommit"/>)
@@ -1559,40 +1559,40 @@
       <title><literal role="hook">incoming</literal>&emdash;after one
 	remote changeset is added</title>
 
-      <para>This hook is run after a pre-existing changeset has been
+      <para id="x_29d">This hook is run after a pre-existing changeset has been
 	added to the repository, for example via a <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg push</command>.  If a group of changesets
 	was added in a single operation, this hook is called once for
 	each added changeset.
       </para>
 
-      <para>You can use this hook for the same purposes as the
+      <para id="x_29e">You can use this hook for the same purposes as the
 	<literal role="hook">changegroup</literal> hook (section <xref
 	  linkend="sec:hook:changegroup"/>); it's simply
 	more convenient sometimes to run a hook once per group of
 	changesets, while other times it's handier once per changeset.
       </para>
 
-      <para>Parameters to this hook:
+      <para id="x_29f">Parameters to this hook:
       </para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para><literal>node</literal>: A changeset ID.  The
+	<listitem><para id="x_2a0"><literal>node</literal>: A changeset ID.  The
 	    ID of the newly added changeset.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><literal>source</literal>: A string.  The
+	<listitem><para id="x_2a1"><literal>source</literal>: A string.  The
 	    source of these changes.  See section <xref
 	      linkend="sec:hook:sources"/> for details.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><literal>url</literal>: A URL.  The location
+	<listitem><para id="x_2a2"><literal>url</literal>: A URL.  The location
 	    of the remote repository, if known.  See section <xref
 	      linkend="sec:hook:url"/> for more
 	    information.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-      <para>See also: <literal role="hook">changegroup</literal>
+      <para id="x_2a3">See also: <literal role="hook">changegroup</literal>
 	(section <xref linkend="sec:hook:changegroup"/>) <literal
 	  role="hook">prechangegroup</literal> (section <xref
 	  linkend="sec:hook:prechangegroup"/>), <literal
@@ -1605,25 +1605,25 @@
       <title><literal role="hook">outgoing</literal>&emdash;after
 	changesets are propagated</title>
 
-      <para>This hook is run after a group of changesets has been
+      <para id="x_2a4">This hook is run after a group of changesets has been
 	propagated out of this repository, for example by a <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg push</command> or <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	  bundle</command> command.
       </para>
 
-      <para>One possible use for this hook is to notify administrators
+      <para id="x_2a5">One possible use for this hook is to notify administrators
 	that changes have been pulled.
       </para>
 
-      <para>Parameters to this hook:
+      <para id="x_2a6">Parameters to this hook:
       </para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para><literal>node</literal>: A changeset ID.  The
+	<listitem><para id="x_2a7"><literal>node</literal>: A changeset ID.  The
 	    changeset ID of the first changeset of the group that was
 	    sent.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><literal>source</literal>: A string.  The
+	<listitem><para id="x_2a8"><literal>source</literal>: A string.  The
 	    source of the of the operation (see section <xref
 	      linkend="sec:hook:sources"/>).  If a remote
 	    client pulled changes from this repository,
@@ -1636,14 +1636,14 @@
 	    client performed.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><literal>url</literal>: A URL.  The location
+	<listitem><para id="x_2a9"><literal>url</literal>: A URL.  The location
 	    of the remote repository, if known.  See section <xref
 	      linkend="sec:hook:url"/> for more
 	    information.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-      <para>See also: <literal role="hook">preoutgoing</literal>
+      <para id="x_2aa">See also: <literal role="hook">preoutgoing</literal>
 	(section <xref linkend="sec:hook:preoutgoing"/>)
       </para>
 
@@ -1653,39 +1653,39 @@
 	  role="hook">prechangegroup</literal>&emdash;before starting
 	to add remote changesets</title>
 
-      <para>This controlling hook is run before Mercurial begins to
+      <para id="x_2ab">This controlling hook is run before Mercurial begins to
 	add a group of changesets from another repository.
       </para>
 
-      <para>This hook does not have any information about the
+      <para id="x_2ac">This hook does not have any information about the
 	changesets to be added, because it is run before transmission
 	of those changesets is allowed to begin.  If this hook fails,
 	the changesets will not be transmitted.
       </para>
 
-      <para>One use for this hook is to prevent external changes from
+      <para id="x_2ad">One use for this hook is to prevent external changes from
 	being added to a repository.  For example, you could use this
 	to <quote>freeze</quote> a server-hosted branch temporarily or
 	permanently so that users cannot push to it, while still
 	allowing a local administrator to modify the repository.
       </para>
 
-      <para>Parameters to this hook:
+      <para id="x_2ae">Parameters to this hook:
       </para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para><literal>source</literal>: A string.  The
+	<listitem><para id="x_2af"><literal>source</literal>: A string.  The
 	    source of these changes.  See section <xref
 	      linkend="sec:hook:sources"/> for details.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><literal>url</literal>: A URL.  The location
+	<listitem><para id="x_2b0"><literal>url</literal>: A URL.  The location
 	    of the remote repository, if known.  See section <xref
 	      linkend="sec:hook:url"/> for more
 	    information.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-      <para>See also: <literal role="hook">changegroup</literal>
+      <para id="x_2b1">See also: <literal role="hook">changegroup</literal>
 	(section <xref linkend="sec:hook:changegroup"/>), <literal
 	  role="hook">incoming</literal> (section <xref
 	  linkend="sec:hook:incoming"/>), , <literal
@@ -1698,36 +1698,36 @@
       <title><literal role="hook">precommit</literal>&emdash;before
 	starting to commit a changeset</title>
 
-      <para>This hook is run before Mercurial begins to commit a new
+      <para id="x_2b2">This hook is run before Mercurial begins to commit a new
 	changeset. It is run before Mercurial has any of the metadata
 	for the commit, such as the files to be committed, the commit
 	message, or the commit date.
       </para>
 
-      <para>One use for this hook is to disable the ability to commit
+      <para id="x_2b3">One use for this hook is to disable the ability to commit
 	new changesets, while still allowing incoming changesets.
 	Another is to run a build or test, and only allow the commit
 	to begin if the build or test succeeds.
       </para>
 
-      <para>Parameters to this hook:
+      <para id="x_2b4">Parameters to this hook:
       </para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para><literal>parent1</literal>: A changeset ID.
+	<listitem><para id="x_2b5"><literal>parent1</literal>: A changeset ID.
 	    The changeset ID of the first parent of the working
 	    directory.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><literal>parent2</literal>: A changeset ID.
+	<listitem><para id="x_2b6"><literal>parent2</literal>: A changeset ID.
 	    The changeset ID of the second parent of the working
 	    directory.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
-      <para>If the commit proceeds, the parents of the working
+      <para id="x_2b7">If the commit proceeds, the parents of the working
 	directory will become the parents of the new changeset.
       </para>
 
-      <para>See also: <literal role="hook">commit</literal> (section
+      <para id="x_2b8">See also: <literal role="hook">commit</literal> (section
 	<xref linkend="sec:hook:commit"/>), <literal
 	  role="hook">pretxncommit</literal> (section <xref
 	  linkend="sec:hook:pretxncommit"/>)
@@ -1738,18 +1738,18 @@
       <title><literal role="hook">preoutgoing</literal>&emdash;before
 	starting to propagate changesets</title>
 
-      <para>This hook is invoked before Mercurial knows the identities
+      <para id="x_2b9">This hook is invoked before Mercurial knows the identities
 	of the changesets to be transmitted.
       </para>
 
-      <para>One use for this hook is to prevent changes from being
+      <para id="x_2ba">One use for this hook is to prevent changes from being
 	transmitted to another repository.
       </para>
 
-      <para>Parameters to this hook:
+      <para id="x_2bb">Parameters to this hook:
       </para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para><literal>source</literal>: A string.  The
+	<listitem><para id="x_2bc"><literal>source</literal>: A string.  The
 	    source of the operation that is attempting to obtain
 	    changes from this repository (see section <xref
 	      linkend="sec:hook:sources"/>).  See the documentation
@@ -1760,14 +1760,14 @@
 	    this parameter.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><literal>url</literal>: A URL.  The location
+	<listitem><para id="x_2bd"><literal>url</literal>: A URL.  The location
 	    of the remote repository, if known.  See section <xref
 	      linkend="sec:hook:url"/> for more
 	    information.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-      <para>See also: <literal role="hook">outgoing</literal> (section
+      <para id="x_2be">See also: <literal role="hook">outgoing</literal> (section
 	<xref linkend="sec:hook:outgoing"/>)
       </para>
 
@@ -1776,38 +1776,38 @@
       <title><literal role="hook">pretag</literal>&emdash;before
 	tagging a changeset</title>
 
-      <para>This controlling hook is run before a tag is created.  If
+      <para id="x_2bf">This controlling hook is run before a tag is created.  If
 	the hook succeeds, creation of the tag proceeds.  If the hook
 	fails, the tag is not created.
       </para>
 
-      <para>Parameters to this hook:
+      <para id="x_2c0">Parameters to this hook:
       </para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para><literal>local</literal>: A boolean.  Whether
+	<listitem><para id="x_2c1"><literal>local</literal>: A boolean.  Whether
 	    the tag is local to this repository instance (i.e. stored
 	    in <filename role="special">.hg/localtags</filename>) or
 	    managed by Mercurial (stored in <filename
 	      role="special">.hgtags</filename>).
 	  </para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><literal>node</literal>: A changeset ID.  The
+	<listitem><para id="x_2c2"><literal>node</literal>: A changeset ID.  The
 	    ID of the changeset to be tagged.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><literal>tag</literal>: A string.  The name of
+	<listitem><para id="x_2c3"><literal>tag</literal>: A string.  The name of
 	    the tag to be created.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-      <para>If the tag to be created is revision-controlled, the
+      <para id="x_2c4">If the tag to be created is revision-controlled, the
 	<literal role="hook">precommit</literal> and <literal
 	  role="hook">pretxncommit</literal> hooks (sections <xref
 	  linkend="sec:hook:commit"/> and <xref
 	  linkend="sec:hook:pretxncommit"/>) will also be run.
       </para>
 
-      <para>See also: <literal role="hook">tag</literal> (section
+      <para id="x_2c5">See also: <literal role="hook">tag</literal> (section
 	<xref linkend="sec:hook:tag"/>)
       </para>
     </sect2>
@@ -1816,7 +1816,7 @@
 	  role="hook">pretxnchangegroup</literal>&emdash;before
 	completing addition of remote changesets</title>
 
-      <para>This controlling hook is run before a
+      <para id="x_2c6">This controlling hook is run before a
 	transaction&emdash;that manages the addition of a group of new
 	changesets from outside the repository&emdash;completes.  If
 	the hook succeeds, the transaction completes, and all of the
@@ -1825,28 +1825,28 @@
 	the changesets is erased.
       </para>
 
-      <para>This hook can access the metadata associated with the
+      <para id="x_2c7">This hook can access the metadata associated with the
 	almost-added changesets, but it should not do anything
 	permanent with this data. It must also not modify the working
 	directory.
       </para>
 
-      <para>While this hook is running, if other Mercurial processes
+      <para id="x_2c8">While this hook is running, if other Mercurial processes
 	access this repository, they will be able to see the
 	almost-added changesets as if they are permanent.  This may
 	lead to race conditions if you do not take steps to avoid
 	them.
       </para>
 
-      <para>This hook can be used to automatically vet a group of
+      <para id="x_2c9">This hook can be used to automatically vet a group of
 	changesets.  If the hook fails, all of the changesets are
 	<quote>rejected</quote> when the transaction rolls back.
       </para>
 
-      <para>Parameters to this hook:
+      <para id="x_2ca">Parameters to this hook:
       </para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para><literal>node</literal>: A changeset ID.  The
+	<listitem><para id="x_2cb"><literal>node</literal>: A changeset ID.  The
 	    changeset ID of the first changeset in the group that was
 	    added.  All changesets between this and
 	    <literal role="tag">tip</literal>,
@@ -1856,19 +1856,19 @@
 	      role="hg-cmd">hg unbundle</command>.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><literal>source</literal>: A string.  The
+	<listitem><para id="x_2cc"><literal>source</literal>: A string.  The
 	    source of these changes.  See section <xref
 	      linkend="sec:hook:sources"/> for details.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><literal>url</literal>: A URL.  The location
+	<listitem><para id="x_2cd"><literal>url</literal>: A URL.  The location
 	    of the remote repository, if known.  See section <xref
 	      linkend="sec:hook:url"/> for more
 	    information.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-      <para>See also: <literal role="hook">changegroup</literal>
+      <para id="x_2ce">See also: <literal role="hook">changegroup</literal>
 	(section <xref linkend="sec:hook:changegroup"/>), <literal
 	  role="hook">incoming</literal> (section <xref
 	  linkend="sec:hook:incoming"/>), <literal
@@ -1881,7 +1881,7 @@
       <title><literal role="hook">pretxncommit</literal>&emdash;before
 	completing commit of new changeset</title>
 
-      <para>This controlling hook is run before a
+      <para id="x_2cf">This controlling hook is run before a
 	transaction&emdash;that manages a new commit&emdash;completes.
 	If the hook succeeds, the transaction completes and the
 	changeset becomes permanent within this repository.  If the
@@ -1889,37 +1889,37 @@
 	data is erased.
       </para>
 
-      <para>This hook can access the metadata associated with the
+      <para id="x_2d0">This hook can access the metadata associated with the
 	almost-new changeset, but it should not do anything permanent
 	with this data.  It must also not modify the working
 	directory.
       </para>
 
-      <para>While this hook is running, if other Mercurial processes
+      <para id="x_2d1">While this hook is running, if other Mercurial processes
 	access this repository, they will be able to see the
 	almost-new changeset as if it is permanent.  This may lead to
 	race conditions if you do not take steps to avoid them.
       </para>
 
-      <para>Parameters to this hook:
+      <para id="x_2d2">Parameters to this hook:
       </para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para><literal>node</literal>: A changeset ID.  The
+	<listitem><para id="x_2d3"><literal>node</literal>: A changeset ID.  The
 	    changeset ID of the newly committed changeset.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><literal>parent1</literal>: A changeset ID.
+	<listitem><para id="x_2d4"><literal>parent1</literal>: A changeset ID.
 	    The changeset ID of the first parent of the newly
 	    committed changeset.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><literal>parent2</literal>: A changeset ID.
+	<listitem><para id="x_2d5"><literal>parent2</literal>: A changeset ID.
 	    The changeset ID of the second parent of the newly
 	    committed changeset.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-      <para>See also: <literal role="hook">precommit</literal>
+      <para id="x_2d6">See also: <literal role="hook">precommit</literal>
 	(section <xref linkend="sec:hook:precommit"/>)
       </para>
 
@@ -1928,30 +1928,30 @@
       <title><literal role="hook">preupdate</literal>&emdash;before
 	updating or merging working directory</title>
 
-      <para>This controlling hook is run before an update or merge of
+      <para id="x_2d7">This controlling hook is run before an update or merge of
 	the working directory begins.  It is run only if Mercurial's
 	normal pre-update checks determine that the update or merge
 	can proceed.  If the hook succeeds, the update or merge may
 	proceed; if it fails, the update or merge does not start.
       </para>
 
-      <para>Parameters to this hook:
+      <para id="x_2d8">Parameters to this hook:
       </para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para><literal>parent1</literal>: A changeset ID.
+	<listitem><para id="x_2d9"><literal>parent1</literal>: A changeset ID.
 	    The ID of the parent that the working directory is to be
 	    updated to.  If the working directory is being merged, it
 	    will not change this parent.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><literal>parent2</literal>: A changeset ID.
+	<listitem><para id="x_2da"><literal>parent2</literal>: A changeset ID.
 	    Only set if the working directory is being merged.  The ID
 	    of the revision that the working directory is being merged
 	    with.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-      <para>See also: <literal role="hook">update</literal> (section
+      <para id="x_2db">See also: <literal role="hook">update</literal> (section
 	<xref linkend="sec:hook:update"/>)
       </para>
 
@@ -1960,13 +1960,13 @@
       <title><literal role="hook">tag</literal>&emdash;after tagging a
 	changeset</title>
 
-      <para>This hook is run after a tag has been created.
+      <para id="x_2dc">This hook is run after a tag has been created.
       </para>
 
-      <para>Parameters to this hook:
+      <para id="x_2dd">Parameters to this hook:
       </para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para><literal>local</literal>: A boolean.  Whether
+	<listitem><para id="x_2de"><literal>local</literal>: A boolean.  Whether
 	    the new tag is local to this repository instance (i.e.
 	    stored in <filename
 	      role="special">.hg/localtags</filename>) or managed by
@@ -1974,21 +1974,21 @@
 	      role="special">.hgtags</filename>).
 	  </para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><literal>node</literal>: A changeset ID.  The
+	<listitem><para id="x_2df"><literal>node</literal>: A changeset ID.  The
 	    ID of the changeset that was tagged.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><literal>tag</literal>: A string.  The name of
+	<listitem><para id="x_2e0"><literal>tag</literal>: A string.  The name of
 	    the tag that was created.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-      <para>If the created tag is revision-controlled, the <literal
+      <para id="x_2e1">If the created tag is revision-controlled, the <literal
 	  role="hook">commit</literal> hook (section <xref
 	  linkend="sec:hook:commit"/>) is run before this hook.
       </para>
 
-      <para>See also: <literal role="hook">pretag</literal> (section
+      <para id="x_2e2">See also: <literal role="hook">pretag</literal> (section
 	<xref linkend="sec:hook:pretag"/>)
       </para>
 
@@ -1997,7 +1997,7 @@
       <title><literal role="hook">update</literal>&emdash;after
 	updating or merging working directory</title>
 
-      <para>This hook is run after an update or merge of the working
+      <para id="x_2e3">This hook is run after an update or merge of the working
 	directory completes.  Since a merge can fail (if the external
 	<command>hgmerge</command> command fails to resolve conflicts
 	in a file), this hook communicates whether the update or merge
@@ -2005,24 +2005,24 @@
       </para>
 
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para><literal>error</literal>: A boolean.
+	<listitem><para id="x_2e4"><literal>error</literal>: A boolean.
 	    Indicates whether the update or merge completed
 	    successfully.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><literal>parent1</literal>: A changeset ID.
+	<listitem><para id="x_2e5"><literal>parent1</literal>: A changeset ID.
 	    The ID of the parent that the working directory was
 	    updated to.  If the working directory was merged, it will
 	    not have changed this parent.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><literal>parent2</literal>: A changeset ID.
+	<listitem><para id="x_2e6"><literal>parent2</literal>: A changeset ID.
 	    Only set if the working directory was merged.  The ID of
 	    the revision that the working directory was merged with.
 	  </para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-      <para>See also: <literal role="hook">preupdate</literal>
+      <para id="x_2e7">See also: <literal role="hook">preupdate</literal>
 	(section <xref linkend="sec:hook:preupdate"/>)
       </para>
 
--- a/en/ch10-template.xml	Thu Mar 19 20:54:12 2009 -0700
+++ b/en/ch10-template.xml	Thu Mar 19 21:18:52 2009 -0700
@@ -4,7 +4,7 @@
   <?dbhtml filename="customizing-the-output-of-mercurial.html"?>
   <title>Customising the output of Mercurial</title>
 
-  <para>Mercurial provides a powerful mechanism to let you control how
+  <para id="x_578">Mercurial provides a powerful mechanism to let you control how
     it displays information.  The mechanism is based on templates.
     You can use templates to generate specific output for a single
     command, or to customise the entire appearance of the built-in web
@@ -13,37 +13,37 @@
   <sect1 id="sec:style">
     <title>Using precanned output styles</title>
 
-    <para>Packaged with Mercurial are some output styles that you can
+    <para id="x_579">Packaged with Mercurial are some output styles that you can
       use immediately.  A style is simply a precanned template that
       someone wrote and installed somewhere that Mercurial can
       find.</para>
 
-    <para>Before we take a look at Mercurial's bundled styles, let's
+    <para id="x_57a">Before we take a look at Mercurial's bundled styles, let's
       review its normal output.</para>
 
     &interaction.template.simple.normal;
 
-    <para>This is somewhat informative, but it takes up a lot of
+    <para id="x_57b">This is somewhat informative, but it takes up a lot of
       space&emdash;five lines of output per changeset.  The
       <literal>compact</literal> style reduces this to three lines,
       presented in a sparse manner.</para>
 
     &interaction.template.simple.compact;
 
-    <para>The <literal>changelog</literal> style hints at the
+    <para id="x_57c">The <literal>changelog</literal> style hints at the
       expressive power of Mercurial's templating engine.  This style
       attempts to follow the GNU Project's changelog
       guidelines<citation>web:changelog</citation>.</para>
 
     &interaction.template.simple.changelog;
 
-    <para>You will not be shocked to learn that Mercurial's default
+    <para id="x_57d">You will not be shocked to learn that Mercurial's default
       output style is named <literal>default</literal>.</para>
 
     <sect2>
       <title>Setting a default style</title>
 
-      <para>You can modify the output style that Mercurial will use
+      <para id="x_57e">You can modify the output style that Mercurial will use
 	for every command by editing your <filename
 	  role="special">~/.hgrc</filename> file, naming the style
 	you would prefer to use.</para>
@@ -51,7 +51,7 @@
       <programlisting>[ui]
 style = compact</programlisting>
 
-      <para>If you write a style of your own, you can use it by either
+      <para id="x_57f">If you write a style of your own, you can use it by either
 	providing the path to your style file, or copying your style
 	file into a location where Mercurial can find it (typically
 	the <literal>templates</literal> subdirectory of your
@@ -62,14 +62,14 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Commands that support styles and templates</title>
 
-    <para>All of Mercurial's
+    <para id="x_580">All of Mercurial's
       <quote><literal>log</literal>-like</quote> commands let you use
       styles and templates: <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	incoming</command>, <command role="hg-cmd">hg log</command>,
       <command role="hg-cmd">hg outgoing</command>, and <command
 	role="hg-cmd">hg tip</command>.</para>
 
-    <para>As I write this manual, these are so far the only commands
+    <para id="x_581">As I write this manual, these are so far the only commands
       that support styles and templates.  Since these are the most
       important commands that need customisable output, there has been
       little pressure from the Mercurial user community to add style
@@ -79,22 +79,22 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>The basics of templating</title>
 
-    <para>At its simplest, a Mercurial template is a piece of text.
+    <para id="x_582">At its simplest, a Mercurial template is a piece of text.
       Some of the text never changes, while other parts are
       <emphasis>expanded</emphasis>, or replaced with new text, when
       necessary.</para>
 
-    <para>Before we continue, let's look again at a simple example of
+    <para id="x_583">Before we continue, let's look again at a simple example of
       Mercurial's normal output.</para>
 
     &interaction.template.simple.normal;
 
-    <para>Now, let's run the same command, but using a template to
+    <para id="x_584">Now, let's run the same command, but using a template to
       change its output.</para>
 
     &interaction.template.simple.simplest;
 
-    <para>The example above illustrates the simplest possible
+    <para id="x_585">The example above illustrates the simplest possible
       template; it's just a piece of static text, printed once for
       each changeset.  The <option
 	role="hg-opt-log">--template</option> option to the <command
@@ -102,7 +102,7 @@
       the given text as the template when printing each
       changeset.</para>
 
-    <para>Notice that the template string above ends with the text
+    <para id="x_586">Notice that the template string above ends with the text
       <quote><literal>\n</literal></quote>.  This is an
       <emphasis>escape sequence</emphasis>, telling Mercurial to print
       a newline at the end of each template item.  If you omit this
@@ -110,13 +110,13 @@
       section <xref linkend="sec:template:escape"/> for more details
       of escape sequences.</para>
 
-    <para>A template that prints a fixed string of text all the time
+    <para id="x_587">A template that prints a fixed string of text all the time
       isn't very useful; let's try something a bit more
       complex.</para>
 
     &interaction.template.simple.simplesub;
 
-    <para>As you can see, the string
+    <para id="x_588">As you can see, the string
       <quote><literal>{desc}</literal></quote> in the template has
       been replaced in the output with the description of each
       changeset.  Every time Mercurial finds text enclosed in curly
@@ -131,21 +131,21 @@
   <sect1 id="sec:template:keyword">
     <title>Common template keywords</title>
 
-    <para>You can start writing simple templates immediately using the
+    <para id="x_589">You can start writing simple templates immediately using the
       keywords below.</para>
 
     <itemizedlist>
-      <listitem><para><literal
+      <listitem><para id="x_58a"><literal
 	    role="template-keyword">author</literal>: String.  The
 	  unmodified author of the changeset.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal
+      <listitem><para id="x_58b"><literal
 	    role="template-keyword">branches</literal>: String.  The
 	  name of the branch on which the changeset was committed.
 	  Will be empty if the branch name was
 	  <literal>default</literal>.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal role="template-keyword">date</literal>:
+      <listitem><para id="x_58c"><literal role="template-keyword">date</literal>:
 	  Date information.  The date when the changeset was
 	  committed.  This is <emphasis>not</emphasis> human-readable;
 	  you must pass it through a filter that will render it
@@ -156,45 +156,45 @@
 	  1, 1970); the second is the offset of the committer's
 	  timezone from UTC, in seconds.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal role="template-keyword">desc</literal>:
+      <listitem><para id="x_58d"><literal role="template-keyword">desc</literal>:
 	  String.  The text of the changeset description.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal
+      <listitem><para id="x_58e"><literal
 	    role="template-keyword">files</literal>: List of strings.
 	  All files modified, added, or removed by this
 	  changeset.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal
+      <listitem><para id="x_58f"><literal
 	    role="template-keyword">file_adds</literal>: List of
 	  strings.  Files added by this changeset.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal
+      <listitem><para id="x_590"><literal
 	    role="template-keyword">file_dels</literal>: List of
 	  strings.  Files removed by this changeset.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal role="template-keyword">node</literal>:
+      <listitem><para id="x_591"><literal role="template-keyword">node</literal>:
 	  String.  The changeset identification hash, as a
 	  40-character hexadecimal string.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal
+      <listitem><para id="x_592"><literal
 	    role="template-keyword">parents</literal>: List of
 	  strings.  The parents of the changeset.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal role="template-keyword">rev</literal>:
+      <listitem><para id="x_593"><literal role="template-keyword">rev</literal>:
 	  Integer.  The repository-local changeset revision
 	  number.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal role="template-keyword">tags</literal>:
+      <listitem><para id="x_594"><literal role="template-keyword">tags</literal>:
 	  List of strings.  Any tags associated with the
 	  changeset.</para>
       </listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-    <para>A few simple experiments will show us what to expect when we
+    <para id="x_595">A few simple experiments will show us what to expect when we
       use these keywords; you can see the results below.</para>
 
 &interaction.template.simple.keywords;
 
-    <para>As we noted above, the date keyword does not produce
+    <para id="x_596">As we noted above, the date keyword does not produce
       human-readable output, so we must treat it specially.  This
       involves using a <emphasis>filter</emphasis>, about which more
       in section <xref
@@ -206,39 +206,39 @@
   <sect1 id="sec:template:escape">
     <title>Escape sequences</title>
 
-    <para>Mercurial's templating engine recognises the most commonly
+    <para id="x_597">Mercurial's templating engine recognises the most commonly
       used escape sequences in strings.  When it sees a backslash
       (<quote><literal>\</literal></quote>) character, it looks at the
       following character and substitutes the two characters with a
       single replacement, as described below.</para>
 
     <itemizedlist>
-      <listitem><para><literal>\</literal>:
+      <listitem><para id="x_598"><literal>\</literal>:
 	  Backslash, <quote><literal>\</literal></quote>, ASCII
 	  134.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal>\n</literal>: Newline,
+      <listitem><para id="x_599"><literal>\n</literal>: Newline,
 	  ASCII 12.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal>\r</literal>: Carriage
+      <listitem><para id="x_59a"><literal>\r</literal>: Carriage
 	  return, ASCII 15.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal>\t</literal>: Tab, ASCII
+      <listitem><para id="x_59b"><literal>\t</literal>: Tab, ASCII
 	  11.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal>\v</literal>: Vertical
+      <listitem><para id="x_59c"><literal>\v</literal>: Vertical
 	  tab, ASCII 13.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal>{</literal>: Open curly
+      <listitem><para id="x_59d"><literal>{</literal>: Open curly
 	  brace, <quote><literal>{</literal></quote>, ASCII
 	  173.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal>}</literal>: Close curly
+      <listitem><para id="x_59e"><literal>}</literal>: Close curly
 	  brace, <quote><literal>}</literal></quote>, ASCII
 	  175.</para>
       </listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-    <para>As indicated above, if you want the expansion of a template
+    <para id="x_59f">As indicated above, if you want the expansion of a template
       to contain a literal <quote><literal>\</literal></quote>,
       <quote><literal>{</literal></quote>, or
       <quote><literal>{</literal></quote> character, you must escape
@@ -248,35 +248,35 @@
   <sect1 id="sec:template:filter">
     <title>Filtering keywords to change their results</title>
 
-    <para>Some of the results of template expansion are not
+    <para id="x_5a0">Some of the results of template expansion are not
       immediately easy to use.  Mercurial lets you specify an optional
       chain of <emphasis>filters</emphasis> to modify the result of
       expanding a keyword.  You have already seen a common filter,
       <literal role="template-kw-filt-date">isodate</literal>, in
       action above, to make a date readable.</para>
 
-    <para>Below is a list of the most commonly used filters that
+    <para id="x_5a1">Below is a list of the most commonly used filters that
       Mercurial supports.  While some filters can be applied to any
       text, others can only be used in specific circumstances.  The
       name of each filter is followed first by an indication of where
       it can be used, then a description of its effect.</para>
 
     <itemizedlist>
-      <listitem><para><literal
+      <listitem><para id="x_5a2"><literal
 	    role="template-filter">addbreaks</literal>: Any text. Add
 	  an XHTML <quote><literal>&lt;br/&gt;</literal></quote> tag
 	  before the end of every line except the last.  For example,
 	  <quote><literal>foo\nbar</literal></quote> becomes
 	  <quote><literal>foo&lt;br/&gt;\nbar</literal></quote>.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal
+      <listitem><para id="x_5a3"><literal
 	    role="template-kw-filt-date">age</literal>: <literal
 	    role="template-keyword">date</literal> keyword.  Render
 	  the age of the date, relative to the current time.  Yields a
 	  string like <quote><literal>10
 	      minutes</literal></quote>.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal
+      <listitem><para id="x_5a4"><literal
 	    role="template-filter">basename</literal>: Any text, but
 	  most useful for the <literal
 	    role="template-keyword">files</literal> keyword and its
@@ -285,7 +285,7 @@
 	  <quote><literal>foo/bar/baz</literal></quote> becomes
 	  <quote><literal>baz</literal></quote>.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal
+      <listitem><para id="x_5a5"><literal
 	    role="template-kw-filt-date">date</literal>: <literal
 	    role="template-keyword">date</literal> keyword.  Render a
 	  date in a similar format to the Unix <literal
@@ -293,7 +293,7 @@
 	  timezone included.  Yields a string like <quote><literal>Mon
 	      Sep 04 15:13:13 2006 -0700</literal></quote>.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal
+      <listitem><para id="x_5a6"><literal
 	    role="template-kw-filt-author">domain</literal>: Any text,
 	  but most useful for the <literal
 	    role="template-keyword">author</literal> keyword.  Finds
@@ -303,7 +303,7 @@
 	      &lt;bos@serpentine.com&gt;</literal></quote> becomes
 	  <quote><literal>serpentine.com</literal></quote>.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal
+      <listitem><para id="x_5a7"><literal
 	    role="template-kw-filt-author">email</literal>: Any text,
 	  but most useful for the <literal
 	    role="template-keyword">author</literal> keyword.  Extract
@@ -312,7 +312,7 @@
 	      &lt;bos@serpentine.com&gt;</literal></quote> becomes
 	  <quote><literal>bos@serpentine.com</literal></quote>.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal
+      <listitem><para id="x_5a8"><literal
 	    role="template-filter">escape</literal>: Any text.
 	  Replace the special XML/XHTML characters
 	  <quote><literal>&amp;</literal></quote>,
@@ -320,7 +320,7 @@
 	  <quote><literal>&gt;</literal></quote> with XML
 	  entities.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal
+      <listitem><para id="x_5a9"><literal
 	    role="template-filter">fill68</literal>: Any text.  Wrap
 	  the text to fit in 68 columns.  This is useful before you
 	  pass text through the <literal
@@ -328,30 +328,30 @@
 	  still want it to fit in an 80-column fixed-font
 	  window.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal
+      <listitem><para id="x_5aa"><literal
 	    role="template-filter">fill76</literal>: Any text.  Wrap
 	  the text to fit in 76 columns.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal
+      <listitem><para id="x_5ab"><literal
 	    role="template-filter">firstline</literal>: Any text.
 	  Yield the first line of text, without any trailing
 	  newlines.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal
+      <listitem><para id="x_5ac"><literal
 	    role="template-kw-filt-date">hgdate</literal>: <literal
 	    role="template-keyword">date</literal> keyword.  Render
 	  the date as a pair of readable numbers.  Yields a string
 	  like <quote><literal>1157407993
 	      25200</literal></quote>.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal
+      <listitem><para id="x_5ad"><literal
 	    role="template-kw-filt-date">isodate</literal>: <literal
 	    role="template-keyword">date</literal> keyword.  Render
 	  the date as a text string in ISO 8601 format.  Yields a
 	  string like <quote><literal>2006-09-04 15:13:13
 	      -0700</literal></quote>.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal
+      <listitem><para id="x_5ae"><literal
 	    role="template-filter">obfuscate</literal>: Any text, but
 	  most useful for the <literal
 	    role="template-keyword">author</literal> keyword.  Yield
@@ -359,7 +359,7 @@
 	  helps to defeat some particularly stupid screen-scraping
 	  email harvesting spambots.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal
+      <listitem><para id="x_5af"><literal
 	    role="template-kw-filt-author">person</literal>: Any text,
 	  but most useful for the <literal
 	    role="template-keyword">author</literal> keyword.  Yield
@@ -368,41 +368,41 @@
 	      &lt;bos@serpentine.com&gt;</literal></quote> becomes
 	  <quote><literal>Bryan O'Sullivan</literal></quote>.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal
+      <listitem><para id="x_5b0"><literal
 	    role="template-kw-filt-date">rfc822date</literal>:
 	  <literal role="template-keyword">date</literal> keyword.
 	  Render a date using the same format used in email headers.
 	  Yields a string like <quote><literal>Mon, 04 Sep 2006
 	      15:13:13 -0700</literal></quote>.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal
+      <listitem><para id="x_5b1"><literal
 	    role="template-kw-filt-node">short</literal>: Changeset
 	  hash.  Yield the short form of a changeset hash, i.e. a
 	  12-character hexadecimal string.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal
+      <listitem><para id="x_5b2"><literal
 	    role="template-kw-filt-date">shortdate</literal>: <literal
 	    role="template-keyword">date</literal> keyword.  Render
 	  the year, month, and day of the date.  Yields a string like
 	  <quote><literal>2006-09-04</literal></quote>.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal role="template-filter">strip</literal>:
+      <listitem><para id="x_5b3"><literal role="template-filter">strip</literal>:
 	  Any text.  Strip all leading and trailing whitespace from
 	  the string.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal
+      <listitem><para id="x_5b4"><literal
 	    role="template-filter">tabindent</literal>: Any text.
 	  Yield the text, with every line except the first starting
 	  with a tab character.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal
+      <listitem><para id="x_5b5"><literal
 	    role="template-filter">urlescape</literal>: Any text.
 	  Escape all characters that are considered
 	  <quote>special</quote> by URL parsers.  For example,
 	  <literal>foo bar</literal> becomes
 	  <literal>foo%20bar</literal>.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para><literal
+      <listitem><para id="x_5b6"><literal
 	    role="template-kw-filt-author">user</literal>: Any text,
 	  but most useful for the <literal
 	    role="template-keyword">author</literal> keyword.  Return
@@ -415,7 +415,7 @@
 &interaction.template.simple.manyfilters;
 
     <note>
-      <para>  If you try to apply a filter to a piece of data that it
+      <para id="x_5b7">  If you try to apply a filter to a piece of data that it
 	cannot process, Mercurial will fail and print a Python
 	exception.  For example, trying to run the output of the
 	<literal role="template-keyword">desc</literal> keyword into
@@ -426,7 +426,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Combining filters</title>
 
-      <para>It is easy to combine filters to yield output in the form
+      <para id="x_5b8">It is easy to combine filters to yield output in the form
 	you would like.  The following chain of filters tidies up a
 	description, then makes sure that it fits cleanly into 68
 	columns, then indents it by a further 8 characters (at least
@@ -435,13 +435,13 @@
 
       &interaction.template.simple.combine;
 
-      <para>Note the use of <quote><literal>\t</literal></quote> (a
+      <para id="x_5b9">Note the use of <quote><literal>\t</literal></quote> (a
 	tab character) in the template to force the first line to be
 	indented; this is necessary since <literal
 	  role="template-keyword">tabindent</literal> indents all
 	lines <emphasis>except</emphasis> the first.</para>
 
-      <para>Keep in mind that the order of filters in a chain is
+      <para id="x_5ba">Keep in mind that the order of filters in a chain is
 	significant.  The first filter is applied to the result of the
 	keyword; the second to the result of the first filter; and so
 	on.  For example, using <literal>fill68|tabindent</literal>
@@ -454,12 +454,12 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>From templates to styles</title>
 
-    <para>A command line template provides a quick and simple way to
+    <para id="x_5bb">A command line template provides a quick and simple way to
       format some output.  Templates can become verbose, though, and
       it's useful to be able to give a template a name.  A style file
       is a template with a name, stored in a file.</para>
 
-    <para>More than that, using a style file unlocks the power of
+    <para id="x_5bc">More than that, using a style file unlocks the power of
       Mercurial's templating engine in ways that are not possible
       using the command line <option
 	role="hg-opt-log">--template</option> option.</para>
@@ -467,11 +467,11 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>The simplest of style files</title>
 
-      <para>Our simple style file contains just one line:</para>
+      <para id="x_5bd">Our simple style file contains just one line:</para>
 
       &interaction.template.simple.rev;
 
-      <para>This tells Mercurial, <quote>if you're printing a
+      <para id="x_5be">This tells Mercurial, <quote>if you're printing a
 	  changeset, use the text on the right as the
 	  template</quote>.</para>
 
@@ -479,38 +479,38 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Style file syntax</title>
 
-      <para>The syntax rules for a style file are simple.</para>
+      <para id="x_5bf">The syntax rules for a style file are simple.</para>
 
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para>The file is processed one line at a
+	<listitem><para id="x_5c0">The file is processed one line at a
 	    time.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>Leading and trailing white space are
+	<listitem><para id="x_5c1">Leading and trailing white space are
 	    ignored.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>Empty lines are skipped.</para>
+	<listitem><para id="x_5c2">Empty lines are skipped.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>If a line starts with either of the characters
+	<listitem><para id="x_5c3">If a line starts with either of the characters
 	    <quote><literal>#</literal></quote> or
 	    <quote><literal>;</literal></quote>, the entire line is
 	    treated as a comment, and skipped as if empty.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>A line starts with a keyword.  This must start
+	<listitem><para id="x_5c4">A line starts with a keyword.  This must start
 	    with an alphabetic character or underscore, and can
 	    subsequently contain any alphanumeric character or
 	    underscore.  (In regexp notation, a keyword must match
 	    <literal>[A-Za-z_][A-Za-z0-9_]*</literal>.)</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>The next element must be an
+	<listitem><para id="x_5c5">The next element must be an
 	    <quote><literal>=</literal></quote> character, which can
 	    be preceded or followed by an arbitrary amount of white
 	    space.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>If the rest of the line starts and ends with
+	<listitem><para id="x_5c6">If the rest of the line starts and ends with
 	    matching quote characters (either single or double quote),
 	    it is treated as a template body.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>If the rest of the line <emphasis>does
+	<listitem><para id="x_5c7">If the rest of the line <emphasis>does
 	      not</emphasis> start with a quote character, it is
 	    treated as the name of a file; the contents of this file
 	    will be read and used as a template body.</para>
@@ -521,7 +521,7 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Style files by example</title>
 
-    <para>To illustrate how to write a style file, we will construct a
+    <para id="x_5c8">To illustrate how to write a style file, we will construct a
       few by example.  Rather than provide a complete style file and
       walk through it, we'll mirror the usual process of developing a
       style file by starting with something very simple, and walking
@@ -530,40 +530,40 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Identifying mistakes in style files</title>
 
-      <para>If Mercurial encounters a problem in a style file you are
+      <para id="x_5c9">If Mercurial encounters a problem in a style file you are
 	working on, it prints a terse error message that, once you
 	figure out what it means, is actually quite useful.</para>
 
 &interaction.template.svnstyle.syntax.input;
 
-      <para>Notice that <filename>broken.style</filename> attempts to
+      <para id="x_5ca">Notice that <filename>broken.style</filename> attempts to
 	define a <literal>changeset</literal> keyword, but forgets to
 	give any content for it. When instructed to use this style
 	file, Mercurial promptly complains.</para>
 
       &interaction.template.svnstyle.syntax.error;
 
-      <para>This error message looks intimidating, but it is not too
+      <para id="x_5cb">This error message looks intimidating, but it is not too
 	hard to follow.</para>
 
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para>The first component is simply Mercurial's way
+	<listitem><para id="x_5cc">The first component is simply Mercurial's way
 	    of saying <quote>I am giving up</quote>.</para>
 	  <programlisting>___abort___: broken.style:1: parse error</programlisting>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>Next comes the name of the style file that
+	<listitem><para id="x_5cd">Next comes the name of the style file that
 	    contains the error.</para>
 	  <programlisting>abort: ___broken.style___:1: parse error</programlisting>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>Following the file name is the line number
+	<listitem><para id="x_5ce">Following the file name is the line number
 	    where the error was encountered.</para>
 	  <programlisting>abort: broken.style:___1___: parse error</programlisting>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>Finally, a description of what went
+	<listitem><para id="x_5cf">Finally, a description of what went
 	    wrong.</para>
 	  <programlisting>abort: broken.style:1: ___parse error___</programlisting>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>The description of the problem is not always
+	<listitem><para id="x_5d0">The description of the problem is not always
 	    clear (as in this case), but even when it is cryptic, it
 	    is almost always trivial to visually inspect the offending
 	    line in the style file and see what is wrong.</para>
@@ -573,32 +573,32 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Uniquely identifying a repository</title>
 
-      <para>If you would like to be able to identify a Mercurial
+      <para id="x_5d1">If you would like to be able to identify a Mercurial
 	repository <quote>fairly uniquely</quote> using a short string
 	as an identifier, you can use the first revision in the
 	repository.</para>
 
       &interaction.template.svnstyle.id;
 
-      <para>This is not guaranteed to be unique, but it is
+      <para id="x_5d2">This is not guaranteed to be unique, but it is
 	nevertheless useful in many cases.</para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para>It will not work in a completely empty
+	<listitem><para id="x_5d3">It will not work in a completely empty
 	    repository, because such a repository does not have a
 	    revision zero.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>Neither will it work in the (extremely rare)
+	<listitem><para id="x_5d4">Neither will it work in the (extremely rare)
 	    case where a repository is a merge of two or more formerly
 	    independent repositories, and you still have those
 	    repositories around.</para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
-      <para>Here are some uses to which you could put this
+      <para id="x_5d5">Here are some uses to which you could put this
 	identifier:</para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para>As a key into a table for a database that
+	<listitem><para id="x_5d6">As a key into a table for a database that
 	    manages repositories on a server.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>As half of a {<emphasis>repository
+	<listitem><para id="x_5d7">As half of a {<emphasis>repository
 	      ID</emphasis>, <emphasis>revision ID</emphasis>} tuple.
 	    Save this information away when you run an automated build
 	    or other activity, so that you can <quote>replay</quote>
@@ -609,29 +609,29 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Mimicking Subversion's output</title>
 
-      <para>Let's try to emulate the default output format used by
+      <para id="x_5d8">Let's try to emulate the default output format used by
 	another revision control tool, Subversion.</para>
 
       &interaction.template.svnstyle.short;
 
-      <para>Since Subversion's output style is fairly simple, it is
+      <para id="x_5d9">Since Subversion's output style is fairly simple, it is
 	easy to copy-and-paste a hunk of its output into a file, and
 	replace the text produced above by Subversion with the
 	template values we'd like to see expanded.</para>
 
       &interaction.template.svnstyle.template;
 
-      <para>There are a few small ways in which this template deviates
+      <para id="x_5da">There are a few small ways in which this template deviates
 	from the output produced by Subversion.</para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para>Subversion prints a <quote>readable</quote>
+	<listitem><para id="x_5db">Subversion prints a <quote>readable</quote>
 	    date (the <quote><literal>Wed, 27 Sep 2006</literal></quote> in the
 	    example output above) in parentheses.  Mercurial's
 	    templating engine does not provide a way to display a date
 	    in this format without also printing the time and time
 	    zone.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>We emulate Subversion's printing of
+	<listitem><para id="x_5dc">We emulate Subversion's printing of
 	    <quote>separator</quote> lines full of
 	    <quote><literal>-</literal></quote> characters by ending
 	    the template with such a line. We use the templating
@@ -640,20 +640,20 @@
 	    output (see below), thus achieving similar output to
 	    Subversion.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>Subversion's output includes a count in the
+	<listitem><para id="x_5dd">Subversion's output includes a count in the
 	    header of the number of lines in the commit message.  We
 	    cannot replicate this in Mercurial; the templating engine
 	    does not currently provide a filter that counts the number
 	    of lines the template generates.</para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
-      <para>It took me no more than a minute or two of work to replace
+      <para id="x_5de">It took me no more than a minute or two of work to replace
 	literal text from an example of Subversion's output with some
 	keywords and filters to give the template above.  The style
 	file simply refers to the template.</para>
 
       &interaction.template.svnstyle.style;
 
-      <para>We could have included the text of the template file
+      <para id="x_5df">We could have included the text of the template file
 	directly in the style file by enclosing it in quotes and
 	replacing the newlines with
 	<quote><literal>\n</literal></quote> sequences, but it would
--- a/en/ch11-mq.xml	Thu Mar 19 20:54:12 2009 -0700
+++ b/en/ch11-mq.xml	Thu Mar 19 21:18:52 2009 -0700
@@ -7,7 +7,7 @@
   <sect1 id="sec:mq:patch-mgmt">
     <title>The patch management problem</title>
 
-    <para>Here is a common scenario: you need to install a software
+    <para id="x_3ac">Here is a common scenario: you need to install a software
       package from source, but you find a bug that you must fix in the
       source before you can start using the package.  You make your
       changes, forget about the package for a while, and a few months
@@ -17,24 +17,24 @@
       the newer version.  This is a tedious task, and it's easy to
       make mistakes.</para>
 
-    <para>This is a simple case of the <quote>patch management</quote>
+    <para id="x_3ad">This is a simple case of the <quote>patch management</quote>
       problem.  You have an <quote>upstream</quote> source tree that
       you can't change; you need to make some local changes on top of
       the upstream tree; and you'd like to be able to keep those
       changes separate, so that you can apply them to newer versions
       of the upstream source.</para>
 
-    <para>The patch management problem arises in many situations.
+    <para id="x_3ae">The patch management problem arises in many situations.
       Probably the most visible is that a user of an open source
       software project will contribute a bug fix or new feature to the
       project's maintainers in the form of a patch.</para>
 
-    <para>Distributors of operating systems that include open source
+    <para id="x_3af">Distributors of operating systems that include open source
       software often need to make changes to the packages they
       distribute so that they will build properly in their
       environments.</para>
 
-    <para>When you have few changes to maintain, it is easy to manage
+    <para id="x_3b0">When you have few changes to maintain, it is easy to manage
       a single patch using the standard <command>diff</command> and
       <command>patch</command> programs (see section <xref
 	linkend="sec:mq:patch"/> for a discussion of these
@@ -49,14 +49,14 @@
       your fix in a subsequent release, you can simply drop that
       single patch when you're updating to the newer release.</para>
 
-    <para>Maintaining a single patch against an upstream tree is a
+    <para id="x_3b1">Maintaining a single patch against an upstream tree is a
       little tedious and error-prone, but not difficult.  However, the
       complexity of the problem grows rapidly as the number of patches
       you have to maintain increases.  With more than a tiny number of
       patches in hand, understanding which ones you have applied and
       maintaining them moves from messy to overwhelming.</para>
 
-    <para>Fortunately, Mercurial includes a powerful extension,
+    <para id="x_3b2">Fortunately, Mercurial includes a powerful extension,
       Mercurial Queues (or simply <quote>MQ</quote>), that massively
       simplifies the patch management problem.</para>
 
@@ -64,13 +64,13 @@
   <sect1 id="sec:mq:history">
     <title>The prehistory of Mercurial Queues</title>
 
-    <para>During the late 1990s, several Linux kernel developers
+    <para id="x_3b3">During the late 1990s, several Linux kernel developers
       started to maintain <quote>patch series</quote> that modified
       the behaviour of the Linux kernel.  Some of these series were
       focused on stability, some on feature coverage, and others were
       more speculative.</para>
 
-    <para>The sizes of these patch series grew rapidly.  In 2002,
+    <para id="x_3b4">The sizes of these patch series grew rapidly.  In 2002,
       Andrew Morton published some shell scripts he had been using to
       automate the task of managing his patch queues.  Andrew was
       successfully using these scripts to manage hundreds (sometimes
@@ -79,7 +79,7 @@
     <sect2 id="sec:mq:quilt">
       <title>A patchwork quilt</title>
 
-      <para>In early 2003, Andreas Gruenbacher and Martin Quinson
+      <para id="x_3b5">In early 2003, Andreas Gruenbacher and Martin Quinson
 	borrowed the approach of Andrew's scripts and published a tool
 	called <quote>patchwork quilt</quote>
 	<citation>web:quilt</citation>, or simply <quote>quilt</quote>
@@ -88,7 +88,7 @@
 	management, it rapidly gained a large following among open
 	source software developers.</para>
 
-      <para>Quilt manages a <emphasis>stack of patches</emphasis> on
+      <para id="x_3b6">Quilt manages a <emphasis>stack of patches</emphasis> on
 	top of a directory tree. To begin, you tell quilt to manage a
 	directory tree, and tell it which files you want to manage; it
 	stores away the names and contents of those files.  To fix a
@@ -96,14 +96,14 @@
 	files you need to fix, then <quote>refresh</quote> the
 	patch.</para>
 
-      <para>The refresh step causes quilt to scan the directory tree;
+      <para id="x_3b7">The refresh step causes quilt to scan the directory tree;
 	it updates the patch with all of the changes you have made.
 	You can create another patch on top of the first, which will
 	track the changes required to modify the tree from <quote>tree
 	  with one patch applied</quote> to <quote>tree with two
 	  patches applied</quote>.</para>
 
-      <para>You can <emphasis>change</emphasis> which patches are
+      <para id="x_3b8">You can <emphasis>change</emphasis> which patches are
 	applied to the tree.  If you <quote>pop</quote> a patch, the
 	changes made by that patch will vanish from the directory
 	tree.  Quilt remembers which patches you have popped, though,
@@ -115,7 +115,7 @@
 	any time, change both which patches are applied and what
 	modifications those patches make.</para>
 
-      <para>Quilt knows nothing about revision control tools, so it
+      <para id="x_3b9">Quilt knows nothing about revision control tools, so it
 	works equally well on top of an unpacked tarball or a
 	Subversion working copy.</para>
 
@@ -123,17 +123,17 @@
     <sect2 id="sec:mq:quilt-mq">
       <title>From patchwork quilt to Mercurial Queues</title>
 
-      <para>In mid-2005, Chris Mason took the features of quilt and
+      <para id="x_3ba">In mid-2005, Chris Mason took the features of quilt and
 	wrote an extension that he called Mercurial Queues, which
 	added quilt-like behaviour to Mercurial.</para>
 
-      <para>The key difference between quilt and MQ is that quilt
+      <para id="x_3bb">The key difference between quilt and MQ is that quilt
 	knows nothing about revision control systems, while MQ is
 	<emphasis>integrated</emphasis> into Mercurial.  Each patch
 	that you push is represented as a Mercurial changeset.  Pop a
 	patch, and the changeset goes away.</para>
 
-      <para>Because quilt does not care about revision control tools,
+      <para id="x_3bc">Because quilt does not care about revision control tools,
 	it is still a tremendously useful piece of software to know
 	about for situations where you cannot use Mercurial and
 	MQ.</para>
@@ -143,16 +143,16 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>The huge advantage of MQ</title>
 
-    <para>I cannot overstate the value that MQ offers through the
+    <para id="x_3bd">I cannot overstate the value that MQ offers through the
       unification of patches and revision control.</para>
 
-    <para>A major reason that patches have persisted in the free
+    <para id="x_3be">A major reason that patches have persisted in the free
       software and open source world&emdash;in spite of the
       availability of increasingly capable revision control tools over
       the years&emdash;is the <emphasis>agility</emphasis> they
       offer.</para>
 
-    <para>Traditional revision control tools make a permanent,
+    <para id="x_3bf">Traditional revision control tools make a permanent,
       irreversible record of everything that you do.  While this has
       great value, it's also somewhat stifling.  If you want to
       perform a wild-eyed experiment, you have to be careful in how
@@ -160,7 +160,7 @@
       misleading or destabilising&emdash;traces of your missteps and
       errors in the permanent revision record.</para>
 
-    <para>By contrast, MQ's marriage of distributed revision control
+    <para id="x_3c0">By contrast, MQ's marriage of distributed revision control
       with patches makes it much easier to isolate your work.  Your
       patches live on top of normal revision history, and you can make
       them disappear or reappear at will.  If you don't like a patch,
@@ -168,7 +168,7 @@
       simply fix it&emdash;as many times as you need to, until you
       have refined it into the form you desire.</para>
 
-    <para>As an example, the integration of patches with revision
+    <para id="x_3c1">As an example, the integration of patches with revision
       control makes understanding patches and debugging their
       effects&emdash;and their interplay with the code they're based
       on&emdash;<emphasis>enormously</emphasis> easier. Since every
@@ -186,11 +186,11 @@
   <sect1 id="sec:mq:patch">
     <title>Understanding patches</title>
 
-    <para>Because MQ doesn't hide its patch-oriented nature, it is
+    <para id="x_3c2">Because MQ doesn't hide its patch-oriented nature, it is
       helpful to understand what patches are, and a little about the
       tools that work with them.</para>
 
-    <para>The traditional Unix <command>diff</command> command
+    <para id="x_3c3">The traditional Unix <command>diff</command> command
       compares two files, and prints a list of differences between
       them. The <command>patch</command> command understands these
       differences as <emphasis>modifications</emphasis> to make to a
@@ -199,20 +199,20 @@
 
 &interaction.mq.dodiff.diff;
 
-    <para>The type of file that <command>diff</command> generates (and
+    <para id="x_3c4">The type of file that <command>diff</command> generates (and
       <command>patch</command> takes as input) is called a
       <quote>patch</quote> or a <quote>diff</quote>; there is no
       difference between a patch and a diff.  (We'll use the term
       <quote>patch</quote>, since it's more commonly used.)</para>
 
-    <para>A patch file can start with arbitrary text; the
+    <para id="x_3c5">A patch file can start with arbitrary text; the
       <command>patch</command> command ignores this text, but MQ uses
       it as the commit message when creating changesets.  To find the
       beginning of the patch content, <command>patch</command>
       searches for the first line that starts with the string
       <quote><literal>diff -</literal></quote>.</para>
 
-    <para>MQ works with <emphasis>unified</emphasis> diffs
+    <para id="x_3c6">MQ works with <emphasis>unified</emphasis> diffs
       (<command>patch</command> can accept several other diff formats,
       but MQ doesn't).  A unified diff contains two kinds of header.
       The <emphasis>file header</emphasis> describes the file being
@@ -220,7 +220,7 @@
       <command>patch</command> sees a new file header, it looks for a
       file with that name to start modifying.</para>
 
-    <para>After the file header comes a series of
+    <para id="x_3c7">After the file header comes a series of
       <emphasis>hunks</emphasis>.  Each hunk starts with a header;
       this identifies the range of line numbers within the file that
       the hunk should modify.  Following the header, a hunk starts and
@@ -232,7 +232,7 @@
       runs the hunks together, with a few lines of context between
       modifications.</para>
 
-    <para>Each line of context begins with a space character.  Within
+    <para id="x_3c8">Each line of context begins with a space character.  Within
       the hunk, a line that begins with
       <quote><literal>-</literal></quote> means <quote>remove this
 	line,</quote> while a line that begins with
@@ -240,7 +240,7 @@
 	line.</quote>  For example, a line that is modified is
       represented by one deletion and one insertion.</para>
 
-    <para>We will return to some of the more subtle aspects of patches
+    <para id="x_3c9">We will return to some of the more subtle aspects of patches
       later (in section <xref linkend="sec:mq:adv-patch"/>), but you
       should have
       enough information now to use MQ.</para>
@@ -249,7 +249,7 @@
   <sect1 id="sec:mq:start">
     <title>Getting started with Mercurial Queues</title>
 
-    <para>Because MQ is implemented as an extension, you must
+    <para id="x_3ca">Because MQ is implemented as an extension, you must
       explicitly enable before you can use it.  (You don't need to
       download anything; MQ ships with the standard Mercurial
       distribution.)  To enable MQ, edit your <filename
@@ -259,7 +259,7 @@
     <programlisting>[extensions]
 hgext.mq =</programlisting>
 
-    <para>Once the extension is enabled, it will make a number of new
+    <para id="x_3cb">Once the extension is enabled, it will make a number of new
       commands available.  To verify that the extension is working,
       you can use <command role="hg-cmd">hg help</command> to see if
       the <command role="hg-ext-mq">qinit</command> command is now
@@ -267,14 +267,14 @@
 
 &interaction.mq.qinit-help.help;
 
-    <para>You can use MQ with <emphasis>any</emphasis> Mercurial
+    <para id="x_3cc">You can use MQ with <emphasis>any</emphasis> Mercurial
       repository, and its commands only operate within that
       repository.  To get started, simply prepare the repository using
       the <command role="hg-ext-mq">qinit</command> command.</para>
 
 &interaction.mq.tutorial.qinit;
 
-    <para>This command creates an empty directory called <filename
+    <para id="x_3cd">This command creates an empty directory called <filename
 	role="special" class="directory">.hg/patches</filename>, where
       MQ will keep its metadata.  As with many Mercurial commands, the
       <command role="hg-ext-mq">qinit</command> command prints nothing
@@ -283,18 +283,18 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Creating a new patch</title>
 
-      <para>To begin work on a new patch, use the <command
+      <para id="x_3ce">To begin work on a new patch, use the <command
 	  role="hg-ext-mq">qnew</command> command.  This command takes
 	one argument, the name of the patch to create.</para>
 
-      <para>MQ will use this as the name of an actual file in the
+      <para id="x_3cf">MQ will use this as the name of an actual file in the
 	<filename role="special"
 	  class="directory">.hg/patches</filename> directory, as you
 	can see below.</para>
 
 &interaction.mq.tutorial.qnew;
 
-      <para>Also newly present in the <filename role="special"
+      <para id="x_3d0">Also newly present in the <filename role="special"
 	  class="directory">.hg/patches</filename> directory are two
 	other files, <filename role="special">series</filename> and
 	<filename role="special">status</filename>.  The <filename
@@ -306,7 +306,7 @@
 	<emphasis>applied</emphasis> in this repository.</para>
 
       <note>
-	<para>  You may sometimes want to edit the <filename
+	<para id="x_3d1">  You may sometimes want to edit the <filename
 	    role="special">series</filename> file by hand; for
 	  example, to change the sequence in which some patches are
 	  applied.  However, manually editing the <filename
@@ -315,7 +315,7 @@
 	  happening.</para>
       </note>
 
-      <para>Once you have created your new patch, you can edit files
+      <para id="x_3d2">Once you have created your new patch, you can edit files
 	in the working directory as you usually would.  All of the
 	normal Mercurial commands, such as <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	  diff</command> and <command role="hg-cmd">hg
@@ -325,17 +325,17 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Refreshing a patch</title>
 
-      <para>When you reach a point where you want to save your work,
+      <para id="x_3d3">When you reach a point where you want to save your work,
 	use the <command role="hg-ext-mq">qrefresh</command> command
 	to update the patch you are working on.</para>
 
 &interaction.mq.tutorial.qrefresh;
 
-      <para>This command folds the changes you have made in the
+      <para id="x_3d4">This command folds the changes you have made in the
 	working directory into your patch, and updates its
 	corresponding changeset to contain those changes.</para>
 
-      <para>You can run <command role="hg-ext-mq">qrefresh</command>
+      <para id="x_3d5">You can run <command role="hg-ext-mq">qrefresh</command>
 	as often as you like, so it's a good way to
 	<quote>checkpoint</quote> your work.  Refresh your patch at an
 	opportune time; try an experiment; and if the experiment
@@ -348,19 +348,19 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Stacking and tracking patches</title>
 
-      <para>Once you have finished working on a patch, or need to work
+      <para id="x_3d6">Once you have finished working on a patch, or need to work
 	on another, you can use the <command
 	  role="hg-ext-mq">qnew</command> command again to create a
 	new patch. Mercurial will apply this patch on top of your
 	existing patch.</para>
 
 &interaction.mq.tutorial.qnew2;
-      <para>Notice that the patch contains the changes in our prior
+      <para id="x_3d7">Notice that the patch contains the changes in our prior
 	patch as part of its context (you can see this more clearly in
 	the output of <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	  annotate</command>).</para>
 
-      <para>So far, with the exception of <command
+      <para id="x_3d8">So far, with the exception of <command
 	  role="hg-ext-mq">qnew</command> and <command
 	  role="hg-ext-mq">qrefresh</command>, we've been careful to
 	only use regular Mercurial commands.  However, MQ provides
@@ -370,13 +370,13 @@
 &interaction.mq.tutorial.qseries;
 
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para>The <command
+	<listitem><para id="x_3d9">The <command
 	      role="hg-ext-mq">qseries</command> command lists every
 	    patch that MQ knows about in this repository, from oldest
 	    to newest (most recently
 	    <emphasis>created</emphasis>).</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>The <command
+	<listitem><para id="x_3da">The <command
 	      role="hg-ext-mq">qapplied</command> command lists every
 	    patch that MQ has <emphasis>applied</emphasis> in this
 	    repository, again from oldest to newest (most recently
@@ -387,12 +387,12 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Manipulating the patch stack</title>
 
-      <para>The previous discussion implied that there must be a
+      <para id="x_3db">The previous discussion implied that there must be a
 	difference between <quote>known</quote> and
 	<quote>applied</quote> patches, and there is.  MQ can manage a
 	patch without it being applied in the repository.</para>
 
-      <para>An <emphasis>applied</emphasis> patch has a corresponding
+      <para id="x_3dc">An <emphasis>applied</emphasis> patch has a corresponding
 	changeset in the repository, and the effects of the patch and
 	changeset are visible in the working directory.  You can undo
 	the application of a patch using the <command
@@ -407,12 +407,12 @@
       <informalfigure id="fig:mq:stack">
 	<mediaobject><imageobject><imagedata
 				    fileref="mq-stack"/></imageobject><textobject><phrase>XXX 
-	      add text</phrase></textobject><caption><para>Applied and
+	      add text</phrase></textobject><caption><para id="x_3dd">Applied and
 	      unapplied patches in the MQ patch
 	      stack</para></caption></mediaobject>
       </informalfigure>
 
-      <para>You can reapply an unapplied, or popped, patch using the
+      <para id="x_3de">You can reapply an unapplied, or popped, patch using the
 	<command role="hg-ext-mq">qpush</command> command.  This
 	creates a new changeset to correspond to the patch, and the
 	patch's changes once again become present in the working
@@ -421,7 +421,7 @@
 	  role="hg-ext-mq">qpush</command> in action.</para>
 &interaction.mq.tutorial.qpop;
 
-      <para>Notice that once we have popped a patch or two patches,
+      <para id="x_3df">Notice that once we have popped a patch or two patches,
 	the output of <command role="hg-ext-mq">qseries</command>
 	remains the same, while that of <command
 	  role="hg-ext-mq">qapplied</command> has changed.</para>
@@ -431,7 +431,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Pushing and popping many patches</title>
 
-      <para>While <command role="hg-ext-mq">qpush</command> and
+      <para id="x_3e0">While <command role="hg-ext-mq">qpush</command> and
 	<command role="hg-ext-mq">qpop</command> each operate on a
 	single patch at a time by default, you can push and pop many
 	patches in one go.  The <option
@@ -450,7 +450,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Safety checks, and overriding them</title>
 
-      <para>Several MQ commands check the working directory before
+      <para id="x_3e1">Several MQ commands check the working directory before
 	they do anything, and fail if they find any modifications.
 	They do this to ensure that you won't lose any changes that
 	you have made, but not yet incorporated into a patch.  The
@@ -462,7 +462,7 @@
 
 &interaction.mq.tutorial.add;
 
-      <para>Commands that check the working directory all take an
+      <para id="x_3e2">Commands that check the working directory all take an
 	<quote>I know what I'm doing</quote> option, which is always
 	named <option>-f</option>.  The exact meaning of
 	<option>-f</option> depends on the command.  For example,
@@ -479,14 +479,14 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Working on several patches at once</title>
 
-      <para>The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qrefresh</command> command
+      <para id="x_3e3">The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qrefresh</command> command
 	always refreshes the <emphasis>topmost</emphasis> applied
 	patch.  This means that you can suspend work on one patch (by
 	refreshing it), pop or push to make a different patch the top,
 	and work on <emphasis>that</emphasis> patch for a
 	while.</para>
 
-      <para>Here's an example that illustrates how you can use this
+      <para id="x_3e4">Here's an example that illustrates how you can use this
 	ability. Let's say you're developing a new feature as two
 	patches.  The first is a change to the core of your software,
 	and the second&emdash;layered on top of the
@@ -505,7 +505,7 @@
   <sect1 id="sec:mq:adv-patch">
     <title>More about patches</title>
 
-    <para>MQ uses the GNU <command>patch</command> command to apply
+    <para id="x_3e5">MQ uses the GNU <command>patch</command> command to apply
       patches, so it's helpful to know a few more detailed aspects of
       how <command>patch</command> works, and about patches
       themselves.</para>
@@ -513,14 +513,14 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>The strip count</title>
 
-      <para>If you look at the file headers in a patch, you will
+      <para id="x_3e6">If you look at the file headers in a patch, you will
 	notice that the pathnames usually have an extra component on
 	the front that isn't present in the actual path name.  This is
 	a holdover from the way that people used to generate patches
 	(people still do this, but it's somewhat rare with modern
 	revision control tools).</para>
 
-      <para>Alice would unpack a tarball, edit her files, then decide
+      <para id="x_3e7">Alice would unpack a tarball, edit her files, then decide
 	that she wanted to create a patch.  So she'd rename her
 	working directory, unpack the tarball again (hence the need
 	for the rename), and use the <option
@@ -533,7 +533,7 @@
 	header, and the name of the modified directory would be at the
 	front of the right-hand path.</para>
 
-      <para>Since someone receiving a patch from the Alices of the net
+      <para id="x_3e8">Since someone receiving a patch from the Alices of the net
 	would be unlikely to have unmodified and modified directories
 	with exactly the same names, the <command>patch</command>
 	command has a <option role="cmd-opt-patch">-p</option> option
@@ -541,7 +541,7 @@
 	strip when trying to apply a patch.  This number is called the
 	<emphasis>strip count</emphasis>.</para>
 
-      <para>An option of <quote><literal>-p1</literal></quote> means
+      <para id="x_3e9">An option of <quote><literal>-p1</literal></quote> means
 	<quote>use a strip count of one</quote>.  If
 	<command>patch</command> sees a file name
 	<filename>foo/bar/baz</filename> in a file header, it will
@@ -554,7 +554,7 @@
 	but <filename>/foo/bar</filename> (notice the extra leading
 	slash) into <filename>foo/bar</filename>.)</para>
 
-      <para>The <quote>standard</quote> strip count for patches is
+      <para id="x_3ea">The <quote>standard</quote> strip count for patches is
 	one; almost all patches contain one leading path name
 	component that needs to be stripped. Mercurial's <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg diff</command> command generates path names
@@ -562,7 +562,7 @@
 	  import</command> command and MQ expect patches to have a
 	strip count of one.</para>
 
-      <para>If you receive a patch from someone that you want to add
+      <para id="x_3eb">If you receive a patch from someone that you want to add
 	to your patch queue, and the patch needs a strip count other
 	than one, you cannot just <command
 	  role="hg-ext-mq">qimport</command> the patch, because
@@ -583,14 +583,14 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Strategies for applying a patch</title>
 
-      <para>When <command>patch</command> applies a hunk, it tries a
+      <para id="x_3ec">When <command>patch</command> applies a hunk, it tries a
 	handful of successively less accurate strategies to try to
 	make the hunk apply. This falling-back technique often makes
 	it possible to take a patch that was generated against an old
 	version of a file, and apply it against a newer version of
 	that file.</para>
 
-      <para>First, <command>patch</command> tries an exact match,
+      <para id="x_3ed">First, <command>patch</command> tries an exact match,
 	where the line numbers, the context, and the text to be
 	modified must apply exactly.  If it cannot make an exact
 	match, it tries to find an exact match for the context,
@@ -599,7 +599,7 @@
 	applied, but at some <emphasis>offset</emphasis> from the
 	original line number.</para>
 
-      <para>If a context-only match fails, <command>patch</command>
+      <para id="x_3ee">If a context-only match fails, <command>patch</command>
 	removes the first and last lines of the context, and tries a
 	<emphasis>reduced</emphasis> context-only match.  If the hunk
 	with reduced context succeeds, it prints a message saying that
@@ -608,7 +608,7 @@
 	context <command>patch</command> had to trim before the patch
 	applied).</para>
 
-      <para>When neither of these techniques works,
+      <para id="x_3ef">When neither of these techniques works,
 	<command>patch</command> prints a message saying that the hunk
 	in question was rejected.  It saves rejected hunks (also
 	simply called <quote>rejects</quote>) to a file with the same
@@ -628,36 +628,36 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Some quirks of patch representation</title>
 
-      <para>There are a few useful things to know about how
+      <para id="x_3f0">There are a few useful things to know about how
 	<command>patch</command> works with files.</para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para>This should already be obvious, but
+	<listitem><para id="x_3f1">This should already be obvious, but
 	    <command>patch</command> cannot handle binary
 	    files.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>Neither does it care about the executable bit;
+	<listitem><para id="x_3f2">Neither does it care about the executable bit;
 	    it creates new files as readable, but not
 	    executable.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><command>patch</command> treats the removal of
+	<listitem><para id="x_3f3"><command>patch</command> treats the removal of
 	    a file as a diff between the file to be removed and the
 	    empty file.  So your idea of <quote>I deleted this
 	      file</quote> looks like <quote>every line of this file
 	      was deleted</quote> in a patch.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>It treats the addition of a file as a diff
+	<listitem><para id="x_3f4">It treats the addition of a file as a diff
 	    between the empty file and the file to be added.  So in a
 	    patch, your idea of <quote>I added this file</quote> looks
 	    like <quote>every line of this file was
 	      added</quote>.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>It treats a renamed file as the removal of the
+	<listitem><para id="x_3f5">It treats a renamed file as the removal of the
 	    old name, and the addition of the new name.  This means
 	    that renamed files have a big footprint in patches.  (Note
 	    also that Mercurial does not currently try to infer when
 	    files have been renamed or copied in a patch.)</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para><command>patch</command> cannot represent
+	<listitem><para id="x_3f6"><command>patch</command> cannot represent
 	    empty files, so you cannot use a patch to represent the
 	    notion <quote>I added this empty file to the
 	      tree</quote>.</para>
@@ -666,7 +666,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Beware the fuzz</title>
 
-      <para>While applying a hunk at an offset, or with a fuzz factor,
+      <para id="x_3f7">While applying a hunk at an offset, or with a fuzz factor,
 	will often be completely successful, these inexact techniques
 	naturally leave open the possibility of corrupting the patched
 	file.  The most common cases typically involve applying a
@@ -676,7 +676,7 @@
 	fuzz factor, you should make sure that the modified files are
 	correct afterwards.</para>
 
-      <para>It's often a good idea to refresh a patch that has applied
+      <para id="x_3f8">It's often a good idea to refresh a patch that has applied
 	with an offset or fuzz factor; refreshing the patch generates
 	new context information that will make it apply cleanly.  I
 	say <quote>often,</quote> not <quote>always,</quote> because
@@ -691,30 +691,30 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Handling rejection</title>
 
-      <para>If <command role="hg-ext-mq">qpush</command> fails to
+      <para id="x_3f9">If <command role="hg-ext-mq">qpush</command> fails to
 	apply a patch, it will print an error message and exit.  If it
 	has left <filename role="special">.rej</filename> files
 	behind, it is usually best to fix up the rejected hunks before
 	you push more patches or do any further work.</para>
 
-      <para>If your patch <emphasis>used to</emphasis> apply cleanly,
+      <para id="x_3fa">If your patch <emphasis>used to</emphasis> apply cleanly,
 	and no longer does because you've changed the underlying code
 	that your patches are based on, Mercurial Queues can help; see
 	section <xref
 	  linkend="sec:mq:merge"/> for details.</para>
 
-      <para>Unfortunately, there aren't any great techniques for
+      <para id="x_3fb">Unfortunately, there aren't any great techniques for
 	dealing with rejected hunks.  Most often, you'll need to view
 	the <filename role="special">.rej</filename> file and edit the
 	target file, applying the rejected hunks by hand.</para>
 
-      <para>If you're feeling adventurous, Neil Brown, a Linux kernel
+      <para id="x_3fc">If you're feeling adventurous, Neil Brown, a Linux kernel
 	hacker, wrote a tool called <command>wiggle</command>
 	<citation>web:wiggle</citation>, which is more vigorous than
 	<command>patch</command> in its attempts to make a patch
 	apply.</para>
 
-      <para>Another Linux kernel hacker, Chris Mason (the author of
+      <para id="x_3fd">Another Linux kernel hacker, Chris Mason (the author of
 	Mercurial Queues), wrote a similar tool called
 	<command>mpatch</command> <citation>web:mpatch</citation>,
 	which takes a simple approach to automating the application of
@@ -723,21 +723,21 @@
 	reasons that a hunk may be rejected:</para>
 
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para>The context in the middle of a hunk has
+	<listitem><para id="x_3fe">The context in the middle of a hunk has
 	    changed.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>A hunk is missing some context at the
+	<listitem><para id="x_3ff">A hunk is missing some context at the
 	    beginning or end.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>A large hunk might apply better&emdash;either
+	<listitem><para id="x_400">A large hunk might apply better&emdash;either
 	    entirely or in part&emdash;if it was broken up into
 	    smaller hunks.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>A hunk removes lines with slightly different
+	<listitem><para id="x_401">A hunk removes lines with slightly different
 	    content than those currently present in the file.</para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-      <para>If you use <command>wiggle</command> or
+      <para id="x_402">If you use <command>wiggle</command> or
 	<command>mpatch</command>, you should be doubly careful to
 	check your results when you're done.  In fact,
 	<command>mpatch</command> enforces this method of
@@ -751,7 +751,7 @@
   <sect1 id="sec:mq:perf">
     <title>Getting the best performance out of MQ</title>
 
-    <para>MQ is very efficient at handling a large number of patches.
+    <para id="x_403">MQ is very efficient at handling a large number of patches.
       I ran some performance experiments in mid-2006 for a talk that I
       gave at the 2006 EuroPython conference
       <citation>web:europython</citation>.  I used as my data set the
@@ -760,7 +760,7 @@
       all 27,472 revisions between Linux 2.6.12-rc2 and Linux
       2.6.17.</para>
 
-    <para>On my old, slow laptop, I was able to <command
+    <para id="x_404">On my old, slow laptop, I was able to <command
 	role="hg-cmd">hg qpush <option
 	  role="hg-ext-mq-cmd-qpush-opt">hg -a</option></command> all
       1,738 patches in 3.5 minutes, and <command role="hg-cmd">hg qpop
@@ -771,11 +771,11 @@
       (which made 22,779 lines of changes to 287 files) in 6.6
       seconds.</para>
 
-    <para>Clearly, MQ is well suited to working in large trees, but
+    <para id="x_405">Clearly, MQ is well suited to working in large trees, but
       there are a few tricks you can use to get the best performance
       of it.</para>
 
-    <para>First of all, try to <quote>batch</quote> operations
+    <para id="x_406">First of all, try to <quote>batch</quote> operations
       together.  Every time you run <command
 	role="hg-ext-mq">qpush</command> or <command
 	role="hg-ext-mq">qpop</command>, these commands scan the
@@ -786,7 +786,7 @@
       medium-sized tree (containing tens of thousands of files), it
       can take a second or more.</para>
 
-    <para>The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qpush</command> and <command
+    <para id="x_407">The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qpush</command> and <command
 	role="hg-ext-mq">qpop</command> commands allow you to push and
       pop multiple patches at a time.  You can identify the
       <quote>destination patch</quote> that you want to end up at.
@@ -796,7 +796,7 @@
 	role="hg-ext-mq">qpop</command> to a destination, MQ will pop
       patches until the destination patch is at the top.</para>
 
-    <para>You can identify a destination patch using either the name
+    <para id="x_408">You can identify a destination patch using either the name
       of the patch, or by number.  If you use numeric addressing,
       patches are counted from zero; this means that the first patch
       is zero, the second is one, and so on.</para>
@@ -806,7 +806,7 @@
     <title>Updating your patches when the underlying code
       changes</title>
 
-    <para>It's common to have a stack of patches on top of an
+    <para id="x_409">It's common to have a stack of patches on top of an
       underlying repository that you don't modify directly.  If you're
       working on changes to third-party code, or on a feature that is
       taking longer to develop than the rate of change of the code
@@ -815,7 +815,7 @@
       This is called <emphasis>rebasing</emphasis> your patch
       series.</para>
 
-    <para>The simplest way to do this is to <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+    <para id="x_40a">The simplest way to do this is to <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	qpop <option role="hg-ext-mq-cmd-qpop-opt">hg
 	  -a</option></command> your patches, then <command
 	role="hg-cmd">hg pull</command> changes into the underlying
@@ -827,26 +827,26 @@
       affected patch, and continue pushing until you have fixed your
       entire stack.</para>
 
-    <para>This approach is easy to use and works well if you don't
+    <para id="x_40b">This approach is easy to use and works well if you don't
       expect changes to the underlying code to affect how well your
       patches apply. If your patch stack touches code that is modified
       frequently or invasively in the underlying repository, however,
       fixing up rejected hunks by hand quickly becomes
       tiresome.</para>
 
-    <para>It's possible to partially automate the rebasing process.
+    <para id="x_40c">It's possible to partially automate the rebasing process.
       If your patches apply cleanly against some revision of the
       underlying repo, MQ can use this information to help you to
       resolve conflicts between your patches and a different
       revision.</para>
 
-    <para>The process is a little involved.</para>
+    <para id="x_40d">The process is a little involved.</para>
     <orderedlist>
-      <listitem><para>To begin, <command role="hg-cmd">hg qpush
+      <listitem><para id="x_40e">To begin, <command role="hg-cmd">hg qpush
 	    -a</command> all of your patches on top of the revision
 	  where you know that they apply cleanly.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>Save a backup copy of your patch directory using
+      <listitem><para id="x_40f">Save a backup copy of your patch directory using
 	  <command role="hg-cmd">hg qsave <option
 	      role="hg-ext-mq-cmd-qsave-opt">hg -e</option> <option
 	      role="hg-ext-mq-cmd-qsave-opt">hg -c</option></command>.
@@ -860,17 +860,17 @@
 	  states of the <filename role="special">series</filename> and
 	  <filename role="special">status</filename> files.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>Use <command role="hg-cmd">hg pull</command> to
+      <listitem><para id="x_410">Use <command role="hg-cmd">hg pull</command> to
 	  bring new changes into the underlying repository.  (Don't
 	  run <command role="hg-cmd">hg pull -u</command>; see below
 	  for why.)</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>Update to the new tip revision, using <command
+      <listitem><para id="x_411">Update to the new tip revision, using <command
 	    role="hg-cmd">hg update <option
 	      role="hg-opt-update">-C</option></command> to override
 	  the patches you have pushed.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>Merge all patches using <command>hg qpush -m
+      <listitem><para id="x_412">Merge all patches using <command>hg qpush -m
 	    -a</command>.  The <option
 	    role="hg-ext-mq-cmd-qpush-opt">-m</option> option to
 	  <command role="hg-ext-mq">qpush</command> tells MQ to
@@ -878,7 +878,7 @@
 	  apply.</para>
       </listitem></orderedlist>
 
-    <para>During the <command role="hg-cmd">hg qpush <option
+    <para id="x_413">During the <command role="hg-cmd">hg qpush <option
 	  role="hg-ext-mq-cmd-qpush-opt">hg -m</option></command>,
       each patch in the <filename role="special">series</filename>
       file is applied normally.  If a patch applies with fuzz or
@@ -888,10 +888,10 @@
       Mercurial's normal merge machinery, so it may pop up a GUI merge
       tool to help you to resolve problems.</para>
 
-    <para>When you finish resolving the effects of a patch, MQ
+    <para id="x_414">When you finish resolving the effects of a patch, MQ
       refreshes your patch based on the result of the merge.</para>
 
-    <para>At the end of this process, your repository will have one
+    <para id="x_415">At the end of this process, your repository will have one
       extra head from the old patch queue, and a copy of the old patch
       queue will be in <filename role="special"
 	class="directory">.hg/patches.N</filename>. You can remove the
@@ -905,26 +905,26 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Identifying patches</title>
 
-    <para>MQ commands that work with patches let you refer to a patch
+    <para id="x_416">MQ commands that work with patches let you refer to a patch
       either by using its name or by a number.  By name is obvious
       enough; pass the name <filename>foo.patch</filename> to <command
 	role="hg-ext-mq">qpush</command>, for example, and it will
       push patches until <filename>foo.patch</filename> is
       applied.</para>
 
-    <para>As a shortcut, you can refer to a patch using both a name
+    <para id="x_417">As a shortcut, you can refer to a patch using both a name
       and a numeric offset; <literal>foo.patch-2</literal> means
       <quote>two patches before <literal>foo.patch</literal></quote>,
       while <literal>bar.patch+4</literal> means <quote>four patches
 	after <literal>bar.patch</literal></quote>.</para>
 
-    <para>Referring to a patch by index isn't much different.  The
+    <para id="x_418">Referring to a patch by index isn't much different.  The
       first patch printed in the output of <command
 	role="hg-ext-mq">qseries</command> is patch zero (yes, it's
       one of those start-at-zero counting systems); the second is
       patch one; and so on.</para>
 
-    <para>MQ also makes it easy to work with patches when you are
+    <para id="x_419">MQ also makes it easy to work with patches when you are
       using normal Mercurial commands.  Every command that accepts a
       changeset ID will also accept the name of an applied patch.  MQ
       augments the tags normally in the repository with an eponymous
@@ -934,28 +934,28 @@
       the <quote>bottom-most</quote> and topmost applied patches,
       respectively.</para>
 
-    <para>These additions to Mercurial's normal tagging capabilities
+    <para id="x_41a">These additions to Mercurial's normal tagging capabilities
       make dealing with patches even more of a breeze.</para>
     <itemizedlist>
-      <listitem><para>Want to patchbomb a mailing list with your
+      <listitem><para id="x_41b">Want to patchbomb a mailing list with your
 	  latest series of changes?</para>
 	<programlisting>hg email qbase:qtip</programlisting>
-	<para>  (Don't know what <quote>patchbombing</quote> is?  See
+	<para id="x_41c">  (Don't know what <quote>patchbombing</quote> is?  See
 	  section <xref linkend="sec:hgext:patchbomb"/>.)</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>Need to see all of the patches since
+      <listitem><para id="x_41d">Need to see all of the patches since
 	  <literal>foo.patch</literal> that have touched files in a
 	  subdirectory of your tree?</para>
 	<programlisting>hg log -r foo.patch:qtip subdir</programlisting>
       </listitem>
     </itemizedlist>
 
-    <para>Because MQ makes the names of patches available to the rest
+    <para id="x_41e">Because MQ makes the names of patches available to the rest
       of Mercurial through its normal internal tag machinery, you
       don't need to type in the entire name of a patch when you want
       to identify it by name.</para>
 
-    <para>Another nice consequence of representing patch names as tags
+    <para id="x_41f">Another nice consequence of representing patch names as tags
       is that when you run the <command role="hg-cmd">hg log</command>
       command, it will display a patch's name as a tag, simply as part
       of its normal output.  This makes it easy to visually
@@ -970,12 +970,12 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Useful things to know about</title>
 
-    <para>There are a number of aspects of MQ usage that don't fit
+    <para id="x_420">There are a number of aspects of MQ usage that don't fit
       tidily into sections of their own, but that are good to know.
       Here they are, in one place.</para>
 
     <itemizedlist>
-      <listitem><para>Normally, when you <command
+      <listitem><para id="x_421">Normally, when you <command
 	    role="hg-ext-mq">qpop</command> a patch and <command
 	    role="hg-ext-mq">qpush</command> it again, the changeset
 	  that represents the patch after the pop/push will have a
@@ -984,7 +984,7 @@
 	    linkend="sec:mqref:cmd:qpush"/> for
 	  information as to why this is.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>It's not a good idea to <command
+      <listitem><para id="x_422">It's not a good idea to <command
 	    role="hg-cmd">hg merge</command> changes from another
 	  branch with a patch changeset, at least if you want to
 	  maintain the <quote>patchiness</quote> of that changeset and
@@ -997,13 +997,13 @@
   <sect1 id="sec:mq:repo">
     <title>Managing patches in a repository</title>
 
-    <para>Because MQ's <filename role="special"
+    <para id="x_423">Because MQ's <filename role="special"
 	class="directory">.hg/patches</filename> directory resides
       outside a Mercurial repository's working directory, the
       <quote>underlying</quote> Mercurial repository knows nothing
       about the management or presence of patches.</para>
 
-    <para>This presents the interesting possibility of managing the
+    <para id="x_424">This presents the interesting possibility of managing the
       contents of the patch directory as a Mercurial repository in its
       own right.  This can be a useful way to work.  For example, you
       can work on a patch for a while, <command
@@ -1012,7 +1012,7 @@
       patch.  This lets you <quote>roll back</quote> to that version
       of the patch later on.</para>
 
-    <para>You can then share different versions of the same patch
+    <para id="x_425">You can then share different versions of the same patch
       stack among multiple underlying repositories.  I use this when I
       am developing a Linux kernel feature.  I have a pristine copy of
       my kernel sources for each of several CPU architectures, and a
@@ -1022,7 +1022,7 @@
       associated with that kernel tree, pop and push all of my
       patches, and build and test that kernel.</para>
 
-    <para>Managing patches in a repository makes it possible for
+    <para id="x_426">Managing patches in a repository makes it possible for
       multiple developers to work on the same patch series without
       colliding with each other, all on top of an underlying source
       base that they may or may not control.</para>
@@ -1030,7 +1030,7 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>MQ support for patch repositories</title>
 
-      <para>MQ helps you to work with the <filename role="special"
+      <para id="x_427">MQ helps you to work with the <filename role="special"
 	  class="directory">.hg/patches</filename> directory as a
 	repository; when you prepare a repository for working with
 	patches using <command role="hg-ext-mq">qinit</command>, you
@@ -1040,7 +1040,7 @@
 	Mercurial repository.</para>
 
       <note>
-	<para>  If you forget to use the <option
+	<para id="x_428">  If you forget to use the <option
 	    role="hg-ext-mq-cmd-qinit-opt">hg -c</option> option, you
 	  can simply go into the <filename role="special"
 	    class="directory">.hg/patches</filename> directory at any
@@ -1049,25 +1049,25 @@
 	    role="special">status</filename> file to the <filename
 	    role="special">.hgignore</filename> file, though</para>
 
-	<para>  (<command role="hg-cmd">hg qinit <option
+	<para id="x_429">  (<command role="hg-cmd">hg qinit <option
 	      role="hg-ext-mq-cmd-qinit-opt">hg -c</option></command>
 	  does this for you automatically); you
 	  <emphasis>really</emphasis> don't want to manage the
 	  <filename role="special">status</filename> file.</para>
       </note>
 
-      <para>As a convenience, if MQ notices that the <filename
+      <para id="x_42a">As a convenience, if MQ notices that the <filename
 	  class="directory">.hg/patches</filename> directory is a
 	repository, it will automatically <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	  add</command> every patch that you create and import.</para>
 
-      <para>MQ provides a shortcut command, <command
+      <para id="x_42b">MQ provides a shortcut command, <command
 	  role="hg-ext-mq">qcommit</command>, that runs <command
 	  role="hg-cmd">hg commit</command> in the <filename
 	  role="special" class="directory">.hg/patches</filename>
 	directory.  This saves some bothersome typing.</para>
 
-      <para>Finally, as a convenience to manage the patch directory,
+      <para id="x_42c">Finally, as a convenience to manage the patch directory,
 	you can define the alias <command>mq</command> on Unix
 	systems. For example, on Linux systems using the
 	<command>bash</command> shell, you can include the following
@@ -1076,17 +1076,17 @@
 
       <programlisting>alias mq=`hg -R $(hg root)/.hg/patches'</programlisting>
 
-      <para>You can then issue commands of the form <command>mq
+      <para id="x_42d">You can then issue commands of the form <command>mq
 	  pull</command> from the main repository.</para>
 
     </sect2>
     <sect2>
       <title>A few things to watch out for</title>
 
-      <para>MQ's support for working with a repository full of patches
+      <para id="x_42e">MQ's support for working with a repository full of patches
 	is limited in a few small respects.</para>
 
-      <para>MQ cannot automatically detect changes that you make to
+      <para id="x_42f">MQ cannot automatically detect changes that you make to
 	the patch directory.  If you <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	  pull</command>, manually edit, or <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	  update</command> changes to patches or the <filename
@@ -1104,11 +1104,11 @@
   <sect1 id="sec:mq:tools">
     <title>Third party tools for working with patches</title>
 
-    <para>Once you've been working with patches for a while, you'll
+    <para id="x_430">Once you've been working with patches for a while, you'll
       find yourself hungry for tools that will help you to understand
       and manipulate the patches you're dealing with.</para>
 
-    <para>The <command>diffstat</command> command
+    <para id="x_431">The <command>diffstat</command> command
       <citation>web:diffstat</citation> generates a histogram of the
       modifications made to each file in a patch.  It provides a good
       way to <quote>get a sense of</quote> a patch&emdash;which files
@@ -1122,7 +1122,7 @@
 
 &interaction.mq.tools.tools;
 
-    <para>The <literal role="package">patchutils</literal> package
+    <para id="x_432">The <literal role="package">patchutils</literal> package
       <citation>web:patchutils</citation> is invaluable. It provides a
       set of small utilities that follow the <quote>Unix
 	philosophy;</quote> each does one useful thing with a patch.
@@ -1140,13 +1140,13 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Good ways to work with patches</title>
 
-    <para>Whether you are working on a patch series to submit to a
+    <para id="x_433">Whether you are working on a patch series to submit to a
       free software or open source project, or a series that you
       intend to treat as a sequence of regular changesets when you're
       done, you can use some simple techniques to keep your work well
       organised.</para>
 
-    <para>Give your patches descriptive names.  A good name for a
+    <para id="x_434">Give your patches descriptive names.  A good name for a
       patch might be <filename>rework-device-alloc.patch</filename>,
       because it will immediately give you a hint what the purpose of
       the patch is.  Long names shouldn't be a problem; you won't be
@@ -1158,7 +1158,7 @@
       to work with, or if you are juggling a number of different tasks
       and your patches only get a fraction of your attention.</para>
 
-    <para>Be aware of what patch you're working on.  Use the <command
+    <para id="x_435">Be aware of what patch you're working on.  Use the <command
 	role="hg-ext-mq">qtop</command> command and skim over the text
       of your patches frequently&emdash;for example, using <command
 	role="hg-cmd">hg tip <option
@@ -1168,7 +1168,7 @@
       one I intended, and it's often tricky to migrate changes into
       the right patch after making them in the wrong one.</para>
 
-    <para>For this reason, it is very much worth investing a little
+    <para id="x_436">For this reason, it is very much worth investing a little
       time to learn how to use some of the third-party tools I
       described in section <xref linkend="sec:mq:tools"/>,
       particularly
@@ -1184,28 +1184,28 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Manage <quote>trivial</quote> patches</title>
 
-      <para>Because the overhead of dropping files into a new
+      <para id="x_437">Because the overhead of dropping files into a new
 	Mercurial repository is so low, it makes a lot of sense to
 	manage patches this way even if you simply want to make a few
 	changes to a source tarball that you downloaded.</para>
 
-      <para>Begin by downloading and unpacking the source tarball, and
+      <para id="x_438">Begin by downloading and unpacking the source tarball, and
 	turning it into a Mercurial repository.</para>
 
       &interaction.mq.tarball.download;
 
-      <para>Continue by creating a patch stack and making your
+      <para id="x_439">Continue by creating a patch stack and making your
 	changes.</para>
 
       &interaction.mq.tarball.qinit;
 
-      <para>Let's say a few weeks or months pass, and your package
+      <para id="x_43a">Let's say a few weeks or months pass, and your package
 	author releases a new version.  First, bring their changes
 	into the repository.</para>
 
       &interaction.mq.tarball.newsource;
 
-      <para>The pipeline starting with <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+      <para id="x_43b">The pipeline starting with <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	  locate</command> above deletes all files in the working
 	directory, so that <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	  commit</command>'s <option
@@ -1213,7 +1213,7 @@
 	actually tell which files have really been removed in the
 	newer version of the source.</para>
 
-      <para>Finally, you can apply your patches on top of the new
+      <para id="x_43c">Finally, you can apply your patches on top of the new
 	tree.</para>
 
       &interaction.mq.tarball.repush;
@@ -1222,7 +1222,7 @@
     <sect2 id="sec:mq:combine">
       <title>Combining entire patches</title>
 
-      <para>MQ provides a command, <command
+      <para id="x_43d">MQ provides a command, <command
 	  role="hg-ext-mq">qfold</command> that lets you combine
 	entire patches.  This <quote>folds</quote> the patches you
 	name, in the order you name them, into the topmost applied
@@ -1230,7 +1230,7 @@
 	description.  The patches that you fold must be unapplied
 	before you fold them.</para>
 
-      <para>The order in which you fold patches matters.  If your
+      <para id="x_43e">The order in which you fold patches matters.  If your
 	topmost applied patch is <literal>foo</literal>, and you
 	<command role="hg-ext-mq">qfold</command>
 	<literal>bar</literal> and <literal>quux</literal> into it,
@@ -1243,11 +1243,11 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Merging part of one patch into another</title>
 
-      <para>Merging <emphasis>part</emphasis> of one patch into
+      <para id="x_43f">Merging <emphasis>part</emphasis> of one patch into
 	another is more difficult than combining entire
 	patches.</para>
 
-      <para>If you want to move changes to entire files, you can use
+      <para id="x_440">If you want to move changes to entire files, you can use
 	<command>filterdiff</command>'s <option
 	  role="cmd-opt-filterdiff">-i</option> and <option
 	  role="cmd-opt-filterdiff">-x</option> options to choose the
@@ -1260,7 +1260,7 @@
 	<command role="hg-ext-mq">qrefresh</command> the patch to drop
 	the duplicate hunks.</para>
 
-      <para>If you have a patch that has multiple hunks modifying a
+      <para id="x_441">If you have a patch that has multiple hunks modifying a
 	file, and you only want to move a few of those hunks, the job
 	becomes more messy, but you can still partly automate it.  Use
 	<command>lsdiff -nvv</command> to print some metadata about
@@ -1268,21 +1268,21 @@
 
       &interaction.mq.tools.lsdiff;
 
-      <para>This command prints three different kinds of
+      <para id="x_442">This command prints three different kinds of
 	number:</para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para>(in the first column) a <emphasis>file
+	<listitem><para id="x_443">(in the first column) a <emphasis>file
 	      number</emphasis> to identify each file modified in the
 	    patch;</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>(on the next line, indented) the line number
+	<listitem><para id="x_444">(on the next line, indented) the line number
 	    within a modified file where a hunk starts; and</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>(on the same line) a <emphasis>hunk
+	<listitem><para id="x_445">(on the same line) a <emphasis>hunk
 	      number</emphasis> to identify that hunk.</para>
 	</listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-      <para>You'll have to use some visual inspection, and reading of
+      <para id="x_446">You'll have to use some visual inspection, and reading of
 	the patch, to identify the file and hunk numbers you'll want,
 	but you can then pass them to to
 	<command>filterdiff</command>'s <option
@@ -1290,7 +1290,7 @@
 	  role="cmd-opt-filterdiff">--hunks</option> options, to
 	select exactly the file and hunk you want to extract.</para>
 
-      <para>Once you have this hunk, you can concatenate it onto the
+      <para id="x_447">Once you have this hunk, you can concatenate it onto the
 	end of your destination patch and continue with the remainder
 	of section <xref linkend="sec:mq:combine"/>.</para>
 
@@ -1299,11 +1299,11 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Differences between quilt and MQ</title>
 
-    <para>If you are already familiar with quilt, MQ provides a
+    <para id="x_448">If you are already familiar with quilt, MQ provides a
       similar command set.  There are a few differences in the way
       that it works.</para>
 
-    <para>You will already have noticed that most quilt commands have
+    <para id="x_449">You will already have noticed that most quilt commands have
       MQ counterparts that simply begin with a
       <quote><literal>q</literal></quote>.  The exceptions are quilt's
       <literal>add</literal> and <literal>remove</literal> commands,
--- a/en/ch12-mq-collab.xml	Thu Mar 19 20:54:12 2009 -0700
+++ b/en/ch12-mq-collab.xml	Thu Mar 19 21:18:52 2009 -0700
@@ -4,18 +4,18 @@
   <?dbhtml filename="advanced-uses-of-mercurial-queues.html"?>
   <title>Advanced uses of Mercurial Queues</title>
 
-  <para>While it's easy to pick up straightforward uses of Mercurial
+  <para id="x_15d">While it's easy to pick up straightforward uses of Mercurial
     Queues, use of a little discipline and some of MQ's less
     frequently used capabilities makes it possible to work in
     complicated development environments.</para>
 
-  <para>In this chapter, I will use as an example a technique I have
+  <para id="x_15e">In this chapter, I will use as an example a technique I have
     used to manage the development of an Infiniband device driver for
     the Linux kernel.  The driver in question is large (at least as
     drivers go), with 25,000 lines of code spread across 35 source
     files.  It is maintained by a small team of developers.</para>
 
-  <para>While much of the material in this chapter is specific to
+  <para id="x_15f">While much of the material in this chapter is specific to
     Linux, the same principles apply to any code base for which you're
     not the primary owner, and upon which you need to do a lot of
     development.</para>
@@ -23,23 +23,23 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>The problem of many targets</title>
 
-    <para>The Linux kernel changes rapidly, and has never been
+    <para id="x_160">The Linux kernel changes rapidly, and has never been
       internally stable; developers frequently make drastic changes
       between releases. This means that a version of the driver that
       works well with a particular released version of the kernel will
       not even <emphasis>compile</emphasis> correctly against,
       typically, any other version.</para>
 
-    <para>To maintain a driver, we have to keep a number of distinct
+    <para id="x_161">To maintain a driver, we have to keep a number of distinct
       versions of Linux in mind.</para>
     <itemizedlist>
-      <listitem><para>One target is the main Linux kernel development
+      <listitem><para id="x_162">One target is the main Linux kernel development
 	  tree. Maintenance of the code is in this case partly shared
 	  by other developers in the kernel community, who make
 	  <quote>drive-by</quote> modifications to the driver as they
 	  develop and refine kernel subsystems.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>We also maintain a number of
+      <listitem><para id="x_163">We also maintain a number of
 	  <quote>backports</quote> to older versions of the Linux
 	  kernel, to support the needs of customers who are running
 	  older Linux distributions that do not incorporate our
@@ -47,7 +47,7 @@
 	  is to modify it to work in an older version of its target
 	  environment than the version it was developed for.)</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>Finally, we make software releases on a schedule
+      <listitem><para id="x_164">Finally, we make software releases on a schedule
 	  that is necessarily not aligned with those used by Linux
 	  distributors and kernel developers, so that we can deliver
 	  new features to customers without forcing them to upgrade
@@ -57,11 +57,11 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Tempting approaches that don't work well</title>
 
-      <para>There are two <quote>standard</quote> ways to maintain a
+      <para id="x_165">There are two <quote>standard</quote> ways to maintain a
 	piece of software that has to target many different
 	environments.</para>
 
-      <para>The first is to maintain a number of branches, each
+      <para id="x_166">The first is to maintain a number of branches, each
 	intended for a single target.  The trouble with this approach
 	is that you must maintain iron discipline in the flow of
 	changes between repositories. A new feature or bug fix must
@@ -71,7 +71,7 @@
 	backport change that is applied to a branch where it doesn't
 	belong will probably stop the driver from compiling.</para>
 
-      <para>The second is to maintain a single source tree filled with
+      <para id="x_167">The second is to maintain a single source tree filled with
 	conditional statements that turn chunks of code on or off
 	depending on the intended target.  Because these
 	<quote>ifdefs</quote> are not allowed in the Linux kernel
@@ -80,7 +80,7 @@
 	this fashion rapidly becomes a rat's nest of conditional
 	blocks that are difficult to understand and maintain.</para>
 
-      <para>Neither of these approaches is well suited to a situation
+      <para id="x_168">Neither of these approaches is well suited to a situation
 	where you don't <quote>own</quote> the canonical copy of a
 	source tree.  In the case of a Linux driver that is
 	distributed with the standard kernel, Linus's tree contains
@@ -90,11 +90,11 @@
 	finding out about it until after the changes show up in
 	Linus's tree.</para>
 
-      <para>These approaches have the added weakness of making it
+      <para id="x_169">These approaches have the added weakness of making it
 	difficult to generate well-formed patches to submit
 	upstream.</para>
 
-      <para>In principle, Mercurial Queues seems like a good candidate
+      <para id="x_16a">In principle, Mercurial Queues seems like a good candidate
 	to manage a development scenario such as the above.  While
 	this is indeed the case, MQ contains a few added features that
 	make the job more pleasant.</para>
@@ -104,7 +104,7 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Conditionally applying patches with guards</title>
 
-    <para>Perhaps the best way to maintain sanity with so many targets
+    <para id="x_16b">Perhaps the best way to maintain sanity with so many targets
       is to be able to choose specific patches to apply for a given
       situation.  MQ provides a feature called <quote>guards</quote>
       (which originates with quilt's <literal>guards</literal>
@@ -113,18 +113,18 @@
 
     &interaction.mq.guards.init;
 
-    <para>This gives us a tiny repository that contains two patches
+    <para id="x_16c">This gives us a tiny repository that contains two patches
       that don't have any dependencies on each other, because they
       touch different files.</para>
 
-    <para>The idea behind conditional application is that you can
+    <para id="x_16d">The idea behind conditional application is that you can
       <quote>tag</quote> a patch with a <emphasis>guard</emphasis>,
       which is simply a text string of your choosing, then tell MQ to
       select specific guards to use when applying patches.  MQ will
       then either apply, or skip over, a guarded patch, depending on
       the guards that you have selected.</para>
 
-    <para>A patch can have an arbitrary number of guards; each one is
+    <para id="x_16e">A patch can have an arbitrary number of guards; each one is
       <emphasis>positive</emphasis> (<quote>apply this patch if this
 	guard is selected</quote>) or <emphasis>negative</emphasis>
       (<quote>skip this patch if this guard is selected</quote>).  A
@@ -134,26 +134,26 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Controlling the guards on a patch</title>
 
-    <para>The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qguard</command> command lets
+    <para id="x_16f">The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qguard</command> command lets
       you determine which guards should apply to a patch, or display
       the guards that are already in effect. Without any arguments, it
       displays the guards on the current topmost patch.</para>
 
       &interaction.mq.guards.qguard;
 
-    <para>To set a positive guard on a patch, prefix the name of the
+    <para id="x_170">To set a positive guard on a patch, prefix the name of the
       guard with a <quote><literal>+</literal></quote>.</para>
 
       &interaction.mq.guards.qguard.pos;
 
-    <para>To set a negative guard
+    <para id="x_171">To set a negative guard
       on a patch, prefix the name of the guard with a
       <quote><literal>-</literal></quote>.</para>
 
     &interaction.mq.guards.qguard.neg;
 
     <note>
-      <para>  The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qguard</command> command
+      <para id="x_172">  The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qguard</command> command
 	<emphasis>sets</emphasis> the guards on a patch; it doesn't
 	<emphasis>modify</emphasis> them.  What this means is that if
 	you run <command role="hg-cmd">hg qguard +a +b</command> on a
@@ -162,7 +162,7 @@
 	be set on it afterwards is <literal>+c</literal>.</para>
     </note>
 
-    <para>Mercurial stores guards in the <filename
+    <para id="x_173">Mercurial stores guards in the <filename
 	role="special">series</filename> file; the form in which they
       are stored is easy both to understand and to edit by hand. (In
       other words, you don't have to use the <command
@@ -176,31 +176,31 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Selecting the guards to use</title>
 
-    <para>The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qselect</command> command
+    <para id="x_174">The <command role="hg-ext-mq">qselect</command> command
       determines which guards are active at a given time.  The effect
       of this is to determine which patches MQ will apply the next
       time you run <command role="hg-ext-mq">qpush</command>.  It has
       no other effect; in particular, it doesn't do anything to
       patches that are already applied.</para>
 
-    <para>With no arguments, the <command
+    <para id="x_175">With no arguments, the <command
 	role="hg-ext-mq">qselect</command> command lists the guards
       currently in effect, one per line of output.  Each argument is
       treated as the name of a guard to apply.</para>
 
       &interaction.mq.guards.qselect.foo;
 
-    <para>In case you're interested, the currently selected guards are
+    <para id="x_176">In case you're interested, the currently selected guards are
       stored in the <filename role="special">guards</filename> file.</para>
 
     &interaction.mq.guards.qselect.cat;
 
-    <para>We can see the effect the selected guards have when we run
+    <para id="x_177">We can see the effect the selected guards have when we run
       <command role="hg-ext-mq">qpush</command>.</para>
 
     &interaction.mq.guards.qselect.qpush;
 
-    <para>A guard cannot start with a
+    <para id="x_178">A guard cannot start with a
       <quote><literal>+</literal></quote> or
       <quote><literal>-</literal></quote> character.  The name of a
       guard must not contain white space, but most other characters
@@ -209,12 +209,12 @@
 
     &interaction.mq.guards.qselect.error;
       
-    <para>Changing the selected guards changes the patches that are
+    <para id="x_179">Changing the selected guards changes the patches that are
       applied.</para>
 
     &interaction.mq.guards.qselect.quux;
 
-    <para>You can see in the example below that negative guards take
+    <para id="x_17a">You can see in the example below that negative guards take
       precedence over positive guards.</para>
 
     &interaction.mq.guards.qselect.foobar;
@@ -223,19 +223,19 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>MQ's rules for applying patches</title>
 
-    <para>The rules that MQ uses when deciding whether to apply a
+    <para id="x_17b">The rules that MQ uses when deciding whether to apply a
       patch are as follows.</para>
     <itemizedlist>
-      <listitem><para>A patch that has no guards is always
+      <listitem><para id="x_17c">A patch that has no guards is always
 	  applied.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>If the patch has any negative guard that matches
+      <listitem><para id="x_17d">If the patch has any negative guard that matches
 	  any currently selected guard, the patch is skipped.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>If the patch has any positive guard that matches
+      <listitem><para id="x_17e">If the patch has any positive guard that matches
 	  any currently selected guard, the patch is applied.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>If the patch has positive or negative guards,
+      <listitem><para id="x_17f">If the patch has positive or negative guards,
 	  but none matches any currently selected guard, the patch is
 	  skipped.</para>
       </listitem></itemizedlist>
@@ -244,14 +244,14 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Trimming the work environment</title>
 
-    <para>In working on the device driver I mentioned earlier, I don't
+    <para id="x_180">In working on the device driver I mentioned earlier, I don't
       apply the patches to a normal Linux kernel tree.  Instead, I use
       a repository that contains only a snapshot of the source files
       and headers that are relevant to Infiniband development.  This
       repository is 1% the size of a kernel repository, so it's easier
       to work with.</para>
 
-    <para>I then choose a <quote>base</quote> version on top of which
+    <para id="x_181">I then choose a <quote>base</quote> version on top of which
       the patches are applied.  This is a snapshot of the Linux kernel
       tree as of a revision of my choosing.  When I take the snapshot,
       I record the changeset ID from the kernel repository in the
@@ -260,7 +260,7 @@
       kernel tree, I can apply my patches on top of either my tiny
       repository or a normal kernel tree.</para>
 
-    <para>Normally, the base tree atop which the patches apply should
+    <para id="x_182">Normally, the base tree atop which the patches apply should
       be a snapshot of a very recent upstream tree.  This best
       facilitates the development of patches that can easily be
       submitted upstream with few or no modifications.</para>
@@ -270,17 +270,17 @@
     <title>Dividing up the <filename role="special">series</filename>
       file</title>
 
-    <para>I categorise the patches in the <filename
+    <para id="x_183">I categorise the patches in the <filename
 	role="special">series</filename> file into a number of logical
       groups.  Each section of like patches begins with a block of
       comments that describes the purpose of the patches that
       follow.</para>
 
-    <para>The sequence of patch groups that I maintain follows.  The
+    <para id="x_184">The sequence of patch groups that I maintain follows.  The
       ordering of these groups is important; I'll describe why after I
       introduce the groups.</para>
     <itemizedlist>
-      <listitem><para>The <quote>accepted</quote> group.  Patches that
+      <listitem><para id="x_185">The <quote>accepted</quote> group.  Patches that
 	  the development team has submitted to the maintainer of the
 	  Infiniband subsystem, and which he has accepted, but which
 	  are not present in the snapshot that the tiny repository is
@@ -288,12 +288,12 @@
 	  present only to transform the tree into a similar state as
 	  it is in the upstream maintainer's repository.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>The <quote>rework</quote> group.  Patches that I
+      <listitem><para id="x_186">The <quote>rework</quote> group.  Patches that I
 	  have submitted, but that the upstream maintainer has
 	  requested modifications to before he will accept
 	  them.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>The <quote>pending</quote> group.  Patches that
+      <listitem><para id="x_187">The <quote>pending</quote> group.  Patches that
 	  I have not yet submitted to the upstream maintainer, but
 	  which we have finished working on. These will be <quote>read
 	    only</quote> for a while.  If the upstream maintainer
@@ -302,15 +302,15 @@
 	  modify any, I'll move them to the beginning of the
 	  <quote>rework</quote> group.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>The <quote>in progress</quote> group.  Patches
+      <listitem><para id="x_188">The <quote>in progress</quote> group.  Patches
 	  that are actively being developed, and should not be
 	  submitted anywhere yet.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>The <quote>backport</quote> group.  Patches that
+      <listitem><para id="x_189">The <quote>backport</quote> group.  Patches that
 	  adapt the source tree to older versions of the kernel
 	  tree.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>The <quote>do not ship</quote> group.  Patches
+      <listitem><para id="x_18a">The <quote>do not ship</quote> group.  Patches
 	  that for some reason should never be submitted upstream.
 	  For example, one such patch might change embedded driver
 	  identification strings to make it easier to distinguish, in
@@ -318,7 +318,7 @@
 	  a version shipped by a distribution vendor.</para>
       </listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-    <para>Now to return to the reasons for ordering groups of patches
+    <para id="x_18b">Now to return to the reasons for ordering groups of patches
       in this way.  We would like the lowest patches in the stack to
       be as stable as possible, so that we will not need to rework
       higher patches due to changes in context.  Putting patches that
@@ -326,12 +326,12 @@
 	role="special">series</filename> file serves this
       purpose.</para>
 
-    <para>We would also like the patches that we know we'll need to
+    <para id="x_18c">We would also like the patches that we know we'll need to
       modify to be applied on top of a source tree that resembles the
       upstream tree as closely as possible.  This is why we keep
       accepted patches around for a while.</para>
 
-    <para>The <quote>backport</quote> and <quote>do not ship</quote>
+    <para id="x_18d">The <quote>backport</quote> and <quote>do not ship</quote>
       patches float at the end of the <filename
 	role="special">series</filename> file.  The backport patches
       must be applied on top of all other patches, and the <quote>do
@@ -342,36 +342,36 @@
   <sect1>
     <title>Maintaining the patch series</title>
 
-    <para>In my work, I use a number of guards to control which
+    <para id="x_18e">In my work, I use a number of guards to control which
       patches are to be applied.</para>
 
     <itemizedlist>
-      <listitem><para><quote>Accepted</quote> patches are guarded with
+      <listitem><para id="x_18f"><quote>Accepted</quote> patches are guarded with
 	  <literal>accepted</literal>.  I enable this guard most of
 	  the time.  When I'm applying the patches on top of a tree
 	  where the patches are already present, I can turn this patch
 	  off, and the patches that follow it will apply
 	  cleanly.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>Patches that are <quote>finished</quote>, but
+      <listitem><para id="x_190">Patches that are <quote>finished</quote>, but
 	  not yet submitted, have no guards.  If I'm applying the
 	  patch stack to a copy of the upstream tree, I don't need to
 	  enable any guards in order to get a reasonably safe source
 	  tree.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>Those patches that need reworking before being
+      <listitem><para id="x_191">Those patches that need reworking before being
 	  resubmitted are guarded with
 	  <literal>rework</literal>.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>For those patches that are still under
+      <listitem><para id="x_192">For those patches that are still under
 	  development, I use <literal>devel</literal>.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>A backport patch may have several guards, one
+      <listitem><para id="x_193">A backport patch may have several guards, one
 	  for each version of the kernel to which it applies.  For
 	  example, a patch that backports a piece of code to 2.6.9
 	  will have a <literal>2.6.9</literal> guard.</para>
       </listitem></itemizedlist>
-    <para>This variety of guards gives me considerable flexibility in
+    <para id="x_194">This variety of guards gives me considerable flexibility in
       determining what kind of source tree I want to end up with.  For
       most situations, the selection of appropriate guards is
       automated during the build process, but I can manually tune the
@@ -380,13 +380,13 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>The art of writing backport patches</title>
 
-      <para>Using MQ, writing a backport patch is a simple process.
+      <para id="x_195">Using MQ, writing a backport patch is a simple process.
 	All such a patch has to do is modify a piece of code that uses
 	a kernel feature not present in the older version of the
 	kernel, so that the driver continues to work correctly under
 	that older version.</para>
 
-      <para>A useful goal when writing a good backport patch is to
+      <para id="x_196">A useful goal when writing a good backport patch is to
 	make your code look as if it was written for the older version
 	of the kernel you're targeting.  The less obtrusive the patch,
 	the easier it will be to understand and maintain.  If you're
@@ -399,7 +399,7 @@
 	unconditional changes, and control their application using
 	guards.</para>
 
-      <para>There are two reasons to divide backport patches into a
+      <para id="x_197">There are two reasons to divide backport patches into a
 	distinct group, away from the <quote>regular</quote> patches
 	whose effects they modify. The first is that intermingling the
 	two makes it more difficult to use a tool like the <literal
@@ -419,12 +419,12 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Organising patches in directories</title>
 
-      <para>If you're working on a substantial project with MQ, it's
+      <para id="x_198">If you're working on a substantial project with MQ, it's
 	not difficult to accumulate a large number of patches.  For
 	example, I have one patch repository that contains over 250
 	patches.</para>
 
-      <para>If you can group these patches into separate logical
+      <para id="x_199">If you can group these patches into separate logical
 	categories, you can if you like store them in different
 	directories; MQ has no problems with patch names that contain
 	path separators.</para>
@@ -433,7 +433,7 @@
     <sect2 id="mq-collab:tips:interdiff">
       <title>Viewing the history of a patch</title>
 
-      <para>If you're developing a set of patches over a long time,
+      <para id="x_19a">If you're developing a set of patches over a long time,
 	it's a good idea to maintain them in a repository, as
 	discussed in section <xref linkend="sec:mq:repo"/>.  If you do
 	so, you'll quickly
@@ -445,7 +445,7 @@
 	time stamps and directory names when it updates a
 	patch.</para>
 
-      <para>However, you can use the <literal
+      <para id="x_19b">However, you can use the <literal
 	  role="hg-ext">extdiff</literal> extension, which is bundled
 	with Mercurial, to turn a diff of two versions of a patch into
 	something readable.  To do this, you will need a third-party
@@ -456,14 +456,14 @@
 	of the same diff, it generates a diff that represents the diff
 	from the first to the second version.</para>
 
-      <para>You can enable the <literal
+      <para id="x_19c">You can enable the <literal
 	  role="hg-ext">extdiff</literal> extension in the usual way,
 	by adding a line to the <literal
 	  role="rc-extensions">extensions</literal> section of your
 	<filename role="special">~/.hgrc</filename>.</para>
       <programlisting>[extensions]
 extdiff =</programlisting>
-      <para>The <command>interdiff</command> command expects to be
+      <para id="x_19d">The <command>interdiff</command> command expects to be
 	passed the names of two files, but the <literal
 	  role="hg-ext">extdiff</literal> extension passes the program
 	it runs a pair of directories, each of which can contain an
@@ -475,18 +475,18 @@
 	source code repository that accompanies this book. <!--
 	&example.hg-interdiff; --></para>
 
-      <para>With the <filename role="special">hg-interdiff</filename>
+      <para id="x_19e">With the <filename role="special">hg-interdiff</filename>
 	program in your shell's search path, you can run it as
 	follows, from inside an MQ patch directory:</para>
       <programlisting>hg extdiff -p hg-interdiff -r A:B my-change.patch</programlisting>
-      <para>Since you'll probably want to use this long-winded command
+      <para id="x_19f">Since you'll probably want to use this long-winded command
 	a lot, you can get <literal role="hg-ext">hgext</literal> to
 	make it available as a normal Mercurial command, again by
 	editing your <filename
 	  role="special">~/.hgrc</filename>.</para>
       <programlisting>[extdiff]
 cmd.interdiff = hg-interdiff</programlisting>
-      <para>This directs <literal role="hg-ext">hgext</literal> to
+      <para id="x_1a0">This directs <literal role="hg-ext">hgext</literal> to
 	make an <literal>interdiff</literal> command available, so you
 	can now shorten the previous invocation of <command
 	  role="hg-ext-extdiff">extdiff</command> to something a
@@ -494,7 +494,7 @@
       <programlisting>hg interdiff -r A:B my-change.patch</programlisting>
 
       <note>
-	<para>  The <command>interdiff</command> command works well
+	<para id="x_1a1">  The <command>interdiff</command> command works well
 	  only if the underlying files against which versions of a
 	  patch are generated remain the same.  If you create a patch,
 	  modify the underlying files, and then regenerate the patch,
@@ -502,7 +502,7 @@
 	  output.</para>
       </note>
 
-      <para>The <literal role="hg-ext">extdiff</literal> extension is
+      <para id="x_1a2">The <literal role="hg-ext">extdiff</literal> extension is
 	useful for more than merely improving the presentation of MQ
 	patches.  To read more about it, go to section <xref
 	  linkend="sec:hgext:extdiff"/>.</para>
--- a/en/ch13-hgext.xml	Thu Mar 19 20:54:12 2009 -0700
+++ b/en/ch13-hgext.xml	Thu Mar 19 21:18:52 2009 -0700
@@ -4,24 +4,24 @@
   <?dbhtml filename="adding-functionality-with-extensions.html"?>
   <title>Adding functionality with extensions</title>
 
-  <para>While the core of Mercurial is quite complete from a
+  <para id="x_4fe">While the core of Mercurial is quite complete from a
     functionality standpoint, it's deliberately shorn of fancy
     features.  This approach of preserving simplicity keeps the
     software easy to deal with for both maintainers and users.</para>
 
-  <para>However, Mercurial doesn't box you in with an inflexible
+  <para id="x_4ff">However, Mercurial doesn't box you in with an inflexible
     command set: you can add features to it as
     <emphasis>extensions</emphasis> (sometimes known as
     <emphasis>plugins</emphasis>).  We've already discussed a few of
     these extensions in earlier chapters.</para>
   <itemizedlist>
-    <listitem><para>Section <xref linkend="sec:tour-merge:fetch"/>
+    <listitem><para id="x_500">Section <xref linkend="sec:tour-merge:fetch"/>
 	covers the <literal role="hg-ext">fetch</literal> extension;
 	this combines pulling new changes and merging them with local
 	changes into a single command, <command
 	  role="hg-ext-fetch">fetch</command>.</para>
     </listitem>
-    <listitem><para>In chapter <xref linkend="chap:hook"/>, we covered
+    <listitem><para id="x_501">In chapter <xref linkend="chap:hook"/>, we covered
 	several extensions that are useful for hook-related
 	functionality: <literal role="hg-ext">acl</literal> adds
 	access control lists; <literal
@@ -30,7 +30,7 @@
 	  role="hg-ext">notify</literal> sends notification emails on
 	new changes.</para>
     </listitem>
-    <listitem><para>The Mercurial Queues patch management extension is
+    <listitem><para id="x_502">The Mercurial Queues patch management extension is
 	so invaluable that it merits two chapters and an appendix all
 	to itself. Chapter <xref linkend="chap:mq"/> covers the
 	basics; chapter <xref
@@ -40,12 +40,12 @@
 	command.</para>
     </listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-  <para>In this chapter, we'll cover some of the other extensions that
+  <para id="x_503">In this chapter, we'll cover some of the other extensions that
     are available for Mercurial, and briefly touch on some of the
     machinery you'll need to know about if you want to write an
     extension of your own.</para>
   <itemizedlist>
-    <listitem><para>In section <xref linkend="sec:hgext:inotify"/>,
+    <listitem><para id="x_504">In section <xref linkend="sec:hgext:inotify"/>,
 	we'll discuss the possibility of <emphasis>huge</emphasis>
 	performance improvements using the <literal
 	  role="hg-ext">inotify</literal> extension.</para>
@@ -55,11 +55,11 @@
     <title>Improve performance with the <literal
 	role="hg-ext">inotify</literal> extension</title>
 
-    <para>Are you interested in having some of the most common
+    <para id="x_505">Are you interested in having some of the most common
       Mercurial operations run as much as a hundred times faster?
       Read on!</para>
 
-    <para>Mercurial has great performance under normal circumstances.
+    <para id="x_506">Mercurial has great performance under normal circumstances.
       For example, when you run the <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	status</command> command, Mercurial has to scan almost every
       directory and file in your repository so that it can display
@@ -69,7 +69,7 @@
       machinery to avoid doing an expensive comparison operation on
       files that obviously haven't changed.</para>
 
-    <para>Because obtaining file status is crucial to good
+    <para id="x_507">Because obtaining file status is crucial to good
       performance, the authors of Mercurial have optimised this code
       to within an inch of its life.  However, there's no avoiding the
       fact that when you run <command role="hg-cmd">hg
@@ -79,20 +79,20 @@
       checked.  For a sufficiently large repository, this can take a
       long time.</para>
 
-    <para>To put a number on the magnitude of this effect, I created a
+    <para id="x_508">To put a number on the magnitude of this effect, I created a
       repository containing 150,000 managed files.  I timed <command
 	role="hg-cmd">hg status</command> as taking ten seconds to
       run, even when <emphasis>none</emphasis> of those files had been
       modified.</para>
 
-    <para>Many modern operating systems contain a file notification
+    <para id="x_509">Many modern operating systems contain a file notification
       facility. If a program signs up to an appropriate service, the
       operating system will notify it every time a file of interest is
       created, modified, or deleted.  On Linux systems, the kernel
       component that does this is called
       <literal>inotify</literal>.</para>
 
-    <para>Mercurial's <literal role="hg-ext">inotify</literal>
+    <para id="x_50a">Mercurial's <literal role="hg-ext">inotify</literal>
       extension talks to the kernel's <literal>inotify</literal>
       component to optimise <command role="hg-cmd">hg status</command>
       commands.  The extension has two components.  A daemon sits in
@@ -105,29 +105,29 @@
       with a result instantaneously, avoiding the need to scan every
       directory and file in the repository.</para>
 
-    <para>Recall the ten seconds that I measured plain Mercurial as
+    <para id="x_50b">Recall the ten seconds that I measured plain Mercurial as
       taking to run <command role="hg-cmd">hg status</command> on a
       150,000 file repository.  With the <literal
 	role="hg-ext">inotify</literal> extension enabled, the time
       dropped to 0.1 seconds, a factor of <emphasis>one
 	hundred</emphasis> faster.</para>
 
-    <para>Before we continue, please pay attention to some
+    <para id="x_50c">Before we continue, please pay attention to some
       caveats.</para>
     <itemizedlist>
-      <listitem><para>The <literal role="hg-ext">inotify</literal>
+      <listitem><para id="x_50d">The <literal role="hg-ext">inotify</literal>
 	  extension is Linux-specific.  Because it interfaces directly
 	  to the Linux kernel's <literal>inotify</literal> subsystem,
 	  it does not work on other operating systems.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>It should work on any Linux distribution that
+      <listitem><para id="x_50e">It should work on any Linux distribution that
 	  was released after early 2005.  Older distributions are
 	  likely to have a kernel that lacks
 	  <literal>inotify</literal>, or a version of
 	  <literal>glibc</literal> that does not have the necessary
 	  interfacing support.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>Not all filesystems are suitable for use with
+      <listitem><para id="x_50f">Not all filesystems are suitable for use with
 	  the <literal role="hg-ext">inotify</literal> extension.
 	  Network filesystems such as NFS are a non-starter, for
 	  example, particularly if you're running Mercurial on several
@@ -138,40 +138,40 @@
 	  fine.</para>
       </listitem></itemizedlist>
 
-    <para>The <literal role="hg-ext">inotify</literal> extension is
+    <para id="x_510">The <literal role="hg-ext">inotify</literal> extension is
       not yet shipped with Mercurial as of May 2007, so it's a little
       more involved to set up than other extensions.  But the
       performance improvement is worth it!</para>
 
-    <para>The extension currently comes in two parts: a set of patches
+    <para id="x_511">The extension currently comes in two parts: a set of patches
       to the Mercurial source code, and a library of Python bindings
       to the <literal>inotify</literal> subsystem.</para>
     <note>
-      <para>  There are <emphasis>two</emphasis> Python
+      <para id="x_512">  There are <emphasis>two</emphasis> Python
 	<literal>inotify</literal> binding libraries.  One of them is
 	called <literal>pyinotify</literal>, and is packaged by some
 	Linux distributions as <literal>python-inotify</literal>.
 	This is <emphasis>not</emphasis> the one you'll need, as it is
 	too buggy and inefficient to be practical.</para>
     </note>
-    <para>To get going, it's best to already have a functioning copy
+    <para id="x_513">To get going, it's best to already have a functioning copy
       of Mercurial installed.</para>
     <note>
-      <para>  If you follow the instructions below, you'll be
+      <para id="x_514">  If you follow the instructions below, you'll be
 	<emphasis>replacing</emphasis> and overwriting any existing
 	installation of Mercurial that you might already have, using
 	the latest <quote>bleeding edge</quote> Mercurial code. Don't
 	say you weren't warned!</para>
     </note>
     <orderedlist>
-      <listitem><para>Clone the Python <literal>inotify</literal>
+      <listitem><para id="x_515">Clone the Python <literal>inotify</literal>
 	  binding repository.  Build and install it.</para>
 	<programlisting>hg clone http://hg.kublai.com/python/inotify
 cd inotify
 python setup.py build --force
 sudo python setup.py install --skip-build</programlisting>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>Clone the <filename
+      <listitem><para id="x_516">Clone the <filename
 	    class="directory">crew</filename> Mercurial repository.
 	  Clone the <literal role="hg-ext">inotify</literal> patch
 	  repository so that Mercurial Queues will be able to apply
@@ -181,13 +181,13 @@
 hg clone crew inotify
 hg clone http://hg.kublai.com/mercurial/patches/inotify inotify/.hg/patches</programlisting>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>Make sure that you have the Mercurial Queues
+      <listitem><para id="x_517">Make sure that you have the Mercurial Queues
 	  extension, <literal role="hg-ext">mq</literal>, enabled.  If
 	  you've never used MQ, read section <xref
 	    linkend="sec:mq:start"/> to get started
 	  quickly.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>Go into the <filename
+      <listitem><para id="x_518">Go into the <filename
 	    class="directory">inotify</filename> repo, and apply all
 	  of the <literal role="hg-ext">inotify</literal> patches
 	  using the <option role="hg-ext-mq-cmd-qpush-opt">hg
@@ -196,28 +196,28 @@
 	<programlisting>cd inotify
 hg qpush -a</programlisting>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>  If you get an error message from <command
+      <listitem><para id="x_519">  If you get an error message from <command
 	    role="hg-ext-mq">qpush</command>, you should not continue.
 	  Instead, ask for help.</para>
       </listitem>
-      <listitem><para>Build and install the patched version of
+      <listitem><para id="x_51a">Build and install the patched version of
 	  Mercurial.</para>
 	<programlisting>python setup.py build --force
 sudo python setup.py install --skip-build</programlisting>
       </listitem>
     </orderedlist>
-    <para>Once you've build a suitably patched version of Mercurial,
+    <para id="x_51b">Once you've build a suitably patched version of Mercurial,
       all you need to do to enable the <literal
 	role="hg-ext">inotify</literal> extension is add an entry to
       your <filename role="special">~/.hgrc</filename>.</para>
     <programlisting>[extensions] inotify =</programlisting>
-    <para>When the <literal role="hg-ext">inotify</literal> extension
+    <para id="x_51c">When the <literal role="hg-ext">inotify</literal> extension
       is enabled, Mercurial will automatically and transparently start
       the status daemon the first time you run a command that needs
       status in a repository.  It runs one status daemon per
       repository.</para>
 
-    <para>The status daemon is started silently, and runs in the
+    <para id="x_51d">The status daemon is started silently, and runs in the
       background.  If you look at a list of running processes after
       you've enabled the <literal role="hg-ext">inotify</literal>
       extension and run a few commands in different repositories,
@@ -225,7 +225,7 @@
       around, waiting for updates from the kernel and queries from
       Mercurial.</para>
 
-    <para>The first time you run a Mercurial command in a repository
+    <para id="x_51e">The first time you run a Mercurial command in a repository
       when you have the <literal role="hg-ext">inotify</literal>
       extension enabled, it will run with about the same performance
       as a normal Mercurial command.  This is because the status
@@ -239,14 +239,14 @@
       status operations almost instantaneous on repositories of all
       sizes!</para>
 
-    <para>If you like, you can manually start a status daemon using
+    <para id="x_51f">If you like, you can manually start a status daemon using
       the <command role="hg-ext-inotify">inserve</command> command.
       This gives you slightly finer control over how the daemon ought
       to run.  This command will of course only be available when the
       <literal role="hg-ext">inotify</literal> extension is
       enabled.</para>
 
-    <para>When you're using the <literal
+    <para id="x_520">When you're using the <literal
 	role="hg-ext">inotify</literal> extension, you should notice
       <emphasis>no difference at all</emphasis> in Mercurial's
       behaviour, with the sole exception of status-related commands
@@ -260,24 +260,24 @@
     <title>Flexible diff support with the <literal
 	role="hg-ext">extdiff</literal> extension</title>
 
-    <para>Mercurial's built-in <command role="hg-cmd">hg
+    <para id="x_521">Mercurial's built-in <command role="hg-cmd">hg
 	diff</command> command outputs plaintext unified diffs.</para>
 
     &interaction.extdiff.diff;
 
-    <para>If you would like to use an external tool to display
+    <para id="x_522">If you would like to use an external tool to display
       modifications, you'll want to use the <literal
 	role="hg-ext">extdiff</literal> extension.  This will let you
       use, for example, a graphical diff tool.</para>
 
-    <para>The <literal role="hg-ext">extdiff</literal> extension is
+    <para id="x_523">The <literal role="hg-ext">extdiff</literal> extension is
       bundled with Mercurial, so it's easy to set up.  In the <literal
 	role="rc-extensions">extensions</literal> section of your
       <filename role="special">~/.hgrc</filename>, simply add a
       one-line entry to enable the extension.</para>
     <programlisting>[extensions]
 extdiff =</programlisting>
-    <para>This introduces a command named <command
+    <para id="x_524">This introduces a command named <command
 	role="hg-ext-extdiff">extdiff</command>, which by default uses
       your system's <command>diff</command> command to generate a
       unified diff in the same form as the built-in <command
@@ -285,12 +285,12 @@
     
     &interaction.extdiff.extdiff;
 
-    <para>The result won't be exactly the same as with the built-in
+    <para id="x_525">The result won't be exactly the same as with the built-in
       <command role="hg-cmd">hg diff</command> variations, because the
       output of <command>diff</command> varies from one system to
       another, even when passed the same options.</para>
 
-    <para>As the <quote><literal>making snapshot</literal></quote>
+    <para id="x_526">As the <quote><literal>making snapshot</literal></quote>
       lines of output above imply, the <command
 	role="hg-ext-extdiff">extdiff</command> command works by
       creating two snapshots of your source tree.  The first snapshot
@@ -303,7 +303,7 @@
       directories and files that have changed between the two
       revisions.</para>
 
-    <para>Snapshot directory names have the same base name as your
+    <para id="x_527">Snapshot directory names have the same base name as your
       repository. If your repository path is <filename
 	class="directory">/quux/bar/foo</filename>, then <filename
 	class="directory">foo</filename> will be the name of each
@@ -319,7 +319,7 @@
       that the diff has the snapshot directory names embedded in its
       header.</para>
 
-    <para>The <command role="hg-ext-extdiff">extdiff</command> command
+    <para id="x_528">The <command role="hg-ext-extdiff">extdiff</command> command
       accepts two important options. The <option
 	role="hg-ext-extdiff-cmd-extdiff-opt">hg -p</option> option
       lets you choose a program to view differences with, instead of
@@ -336,7 +336,7 @@
       and arguments to specify the revisions you want, the files you
       want, and so on.</para>
 
-    <para>As an example, here's how to run the normal system
+    <para id="x_529">As an example, here's how to run the normal system
       <command>diff</command> command, getting it to generate context
       diffs (using the <option role="cmd-opt-diff">-c</option> option)
       instead of unified diffs, and five lines of context instead of
@@ -345,11 +345,11 @@
 
       &interaction.extdiff.extdiff-ctx;
 
-    <para>Launching a visual diff tool is just as easy.  Here's how to
+    <para id="x_52a">Launching a visual diff tool is just as easy.  Here's how to
       launch the <command>kdiff3</command> viewer.</para>
     <programlisting>hg extdiff -p kdiff3 -o</programlisting>
 
-    <para>If your diff viewing command can't deal with directories,
+    <para id="x_52b">If your diff viewing command can't deal with directories,
       you can easily work around this with a little scripting.  For an
       example of such scripting in action with the <literal
 	role="hg-ext">mq</literal> extension and the
@@ -359,14 +359,14 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Defining command aliases</title>
 
-      <para>It can be cumbersome to remember the options to both the
+      <para id="x_52c">It can be cumbersome to remember the options to both the
 	<command role="hg-ext-extdiff">extdiff</command> command and
 	the diff viewer you want to use, so the <literal
 	  role="hg-ext">extdiff</literal> extension lets you define
 	<emphasis>new</emphasis> commands that will invoke your diff
 	viewer with exactly the right options.</para>
 
-      <para>All you need to do is edit your <filename
+      <para id="x_52d">All you need to do is edit your <filename
 	  role="special">~/.hgrc</filename>, and add a section named
 	<literal role="rc-extdiff">extdiff</literal>.  Inside this
 	section, you can define multiple commands.  Here's how to add
@@ -376,7 +376,7 @@
 	will run <command>kdiff3</command> for you.</para>
       <programlisting>[extdiff]
 cmd.kdiff3 =</programlisting>
-      <para>If you leave the right hand side of the definition empty,
+      <para id="x_52e">If you leave the right hand side of the definition empty,
 	as above, the <literal role="hg-ext">extdiff</literal>
 	extension uses the name of the command you defined as the name
 	of the external program to run.  But these names don't have to
@@ -386,7 +386,7 @@
       <programlisting>[extdiff]
  cmd.wibble = kdiff3</programlisting>
 
-      <para>You can also specify the default options that you want to
+      <para id="x_52f">You can also specify the default options that you want to
 	invoke your diff viewing program with.  The prefix to use is
 	<quote><literal>opts.</literal></quote>, followed by the name
 	of the command to which the options apply.  This example
@@ -403,14 +403,14 @@
     <title>Cherrypicking changes with the <literal
 	role="hg-ext">transplant</literal> extension</title>
 
-    <para>Need to have a long chat with Brendan about this.</para>
+    <para id="x_530">Need to have a long chat with Brendan about this.</para>
 
   </sect1>
   <sect1 id="sec:hgext:patchbomb">
     <title>Send changes via email with the <literal
 	role="hg-ext">patchbomb</literal> extension</title>
 
-    <para>Many projects have a culture of <quote>change
+    <para id="x_531">Many projects have a culture of <quote>change
 	review</quote>, in which people send their modifications to a
       mailing list for others to read and comment on before they
       commit the final version to a shared repository.  Some projects
@@ -418,7 +418,7 @@
       other people to a repository to which those others don't have
       access.</para>
 
-    <para>Mercurial makes it easy to send changes over email for
+    <para id="x_532">Mercurial makes it easy to send changes over email for
       review or application, via its <literal
 	role="hg-ext">patchbomb</literal> extension.  The extension is
       so named because changes are formatted as patches, and it's usual
@@ -426,17 +426,17 @@
       of changes by email is thus much like <quote>bombing</quote> the
       recipient's inbox, hence <quote>patchbomb</quote>.</para>
 
-    <para>As usual, the basic configuration of the <literal
+    <para id="x_533">As usual, the basic configuration of the <literal
 	role="hg-ext">patchbomb</literal> extension takes just one or
       two lines in your <filename role="special">
 	/.hgrc</filename>.</para>
     <programlisting>[extensions]
 patchbomb =</programlisting>
-    <para>Once you've enabled the extension, you will have a new
+    <para id="x_534">Once you've enabled the extension, you will have a new
       command available, named <command
 	role="hg-ext-patchbomb">email</command>.</para>
 
-    <para>The safest and best way to invoke the <command
+    <para id="x_535">The safest and best way to invoke the <command
 	role="hg-ext-patchbomb">email</command> command is to
       <emphasis>always</emphasis> run it first with the <option
 	role="hg-ext-patchbomb-cmd-email-opt">hg -n</option> option.
@@ -447,12 +447,12 @@
 	role="hg-ext-patchbomb-cmd-email-opt">hg -n</option> option
       removed.</para>
 
-    <para>The <command role="hg-ext-patchbomb">email</command> command
+    <para id="x_536">The <command role="hg-ext-patchbomb">email</command> command
       accepts the same kind of revision syntax as every other
       Mercurial command.  For example, this command will send every
       revision between 7 and <literal>tip</literal>, inclusive.</para>
     <programlisting>hg email -n 7:tip</programlisting>
-    <para>You can also specify a <emphasis>repository</emphasis> to
+    <para id="x_537">You can also specify a <emphasis>repository</emphasis> to
       compare with.  If you provide a repository but no revisions, the
       <command role="hg-ext-patchbomb">email</command> command will
       send all revisions in the local repository that are not present
@@ -461,7 +461,7 @@
 	role="hg-ext-patchbomb-cmd-email-opt">hg -b</option> option),
       this will constrain the revisions sent.</para>
 
-    <para>It's perfectly safe to run the <command
+    <para id="x_538">It's perfectly safe to run the <command
 	role="hg-ext-patchbomb">email</command> command without the
       names of the people you want to send to: if you do this, it will
       just prompt you for those values interactively.  (If you're
@@ -469,12 +469,12 @@
       <literal>readline</literal>-style editing capabilities when
       entering those headers, too, which is useful.)</para>
 
-    <para>When you are sending just one revision, the <command
+    <para id="x_539">When you are sending just one revision, the <command
 	role="hg-ext-patchbomb">email</command> command will by
       default use the first line of the changeset description as the
       subject of the single email message it sends.</para>
 
-    <para>If you send multiple revisions, the <command
+    <para id="x_53a">If you send multiple revisions, the <command
 	role="hg-ext-patchbomb">email</command> command will usually
       send one message per changeset.  It will preface the series with
       an introductory message, in which you should describe the
@@ -483,25 +483,25 @@
     <sect2>
       <title>Changing the behaviour of patchbombs</title>
 
-      <para>Not every project has exactly the same conventions for
+      <para id="x_53b">Not every project has exactly the same conventions for
 	sending changes in email; the <literal
 	  role="hg-ext">patchbomb</literal> extension tries to
 	accommodate a number of variations through command line
 	options.</para>
       <itemizedlist>
-	<listitem><para>You can write a subject for the introductory
+	<listitem><para id="x_53c">You can write a subject for the introductory
 	    message on the command line using the <option
 	      role="hg-ext-patchbomb-cmd-email-opt">hg -s</option>
 	    option.  This takes one argument, the text of the subject
 	    to use.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>To change the email address from which the
+	<listitem><para id="x_53d">To change the email address from which the
 	    messages originate, use the <option
 	      role="hg-ext-patchbomb-cmd-email-opt">hg -f</option>
 	    option.  This takes one argument, the email address to
 	    use.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>The default behaviour is to send unified diffs
+	<listitem><para id="x_53e">The default behaviour is to send unified diffs
 	    (see section <xref linkend="sec:mq:patch"/> for a
 	    description of the
 	    format), one per message.  You can send a binary bundle
@@ -509,13 +509,13 @@
 	      role="hg-ext-patchbomb-cmd-email-opt">hg -b</option>
 	    option.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>Unified diffs are normally prefaced with a
+	<listitem><para id="x_53f">Unified diffs are normally prefaced with a
 	    metadata header.  You can omit this, and send unadorned
 	    diffs, with the <option
 	      role="hg-ext-patchbomb-cmd-email-opt">hg
 	      --plain</option> option.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>Diffs are normally sent <quote>inline</quote>,
+	<listitem><para id="x_540">Diffs are normally sent <quote>inline</quote>,
 	    in the same body part as the description of a patch.  This
 	    makes it easiest for the largest number of readers to
 	    quote and respond to parts of a diff, as some mail clients
@@ -525,14 +525,14 @@
 	      role="hg-ext-patchbomb-cmd-email-opt">hg -a</option>
 	    option.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>Instead of sending mail messages, you can
+	<listitem><para id="x_541">Instead of sending mail messages, you can
 	    write them to an <literal>mbox</literal>-format mail
 	    folder using the <option
 	      role="hg-ext-patchbomb-cmd-email-opt">hg -m</option>
 	    option.  That option takes one argument, the name of the
 	    file to write to.</para>
 	</listitem>
-	<listitem><para>If you would like to add a
+	<listitem><para id="x_542">If you would like to add a
 	    <command>diffstat</command>-format summary to each patch,
 	    and one to the introductory message, use the <option
 	      role="hg-ext-patchbomb-cmd-email-opt">hg -d</option>